Programming Manual (COMMON) [type Q173D - Mitsubishi Electric

Document technical information

Format pdf
Size 3.2 MB
First found Jun 9, 2017

Document content analysis

Language
English
Type
not defined
Concepts
no text concepts found

Persons

Organizations

Places

Transcript

SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
(Please read these instructions before using this equipment.)
Before using this product, please read this manual and the relevant manuals introduced in this manual
carefully and pay full attention to safety to handle the product correctly.
These precautions apply only to this product. Refer to the Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Users manual
for a description of the Motion controller safety precautions.
In this manual, the safety instructions are ranked as "DANGER" and "CAUTION".
DANGER
Indicates that incorrect handling may cause hazardous
conditions, resulting in death or severe injury.
CAUTION
Indicates that incorrect handling may cause hazardous
conditions, resulting in medium or slight personal injury or
physical damage.
CAUTION may also be linked to serious
Depending on circumstances, procedures indicated by
results.
In any case, it is important to follow the directions for usage.
Please save this manual to make it accessible when required and always forward it to the end user.
A-1
For Safe Operations
1. Prevention of electric shocks
DANGER
Never open the front case or terminal covers while the power is ON or the unit is running, as this
may lead to electric shocks.
Never run the unit with the front case or terminal cover removed. The high voltage terminal and
charged sections will be exposed and may lead to electric shocks.
Never open the front case or terminal cover at times other than wiring work or periodic
inspections even if the power is OFF. The insides of the Motion controller and servo amplifier are
charged and may lead to electric shocks.
Completely turn off the externally supplied power used in the system before mounting or
removing the module, performing wiring work, or inspections. Failing to do so may lead to electric
shocks.
When performing wiring work or inspections, turn the power OFF, wait at least ten minutes, and
then check the voltage with a tester, etc. Failing to do so may lead to electric shocks.
Be sure to ground the Motion controller, servo amplifier and servomotor. (Ground resistance :
100 or less) Do not ground commonly with other devices.
The wiring work and inspections must be done by a qualified technician.
Wire the units after installing the Motion controller, servo amplifier and servomotor. Failing to do
so may lead to electric shocks or damage.
Never operate the switches with wet hands, as this may lead to electric shocks.
Do not damage, apply excessive stress, place heavy things on or sandwich the cables, as this
may lead to electric shocks.
Do not touch the Motion controller, servo amplifier or servomotor terminal blocks while the power
is ON, as this may lead to electric shocks.
Do not touch the built-in power supply, built-in grounding or signal wires of the Motion controller
and servo amplifier, as this may lead to electric shocks.
2. For fire prevention
CAUTION
Install the Motion controller, servo amplifier, servomotor and regenerative resistor on
incombustible. Installing them directly or close to combustibles will lead to fire.
If a fault occurs in the Motion controller or servo amplifier, shut the power OFF at the servo
amplifier’s power source. If a large current continues to flow, fire may occur.
When using a regenerative resistor, shut the power OFF with an error signal. The regenerative
resistor may abnormally overheat due to a fault in the regenerative transistor, etc., and may lead
to fire.
Always take heat measures such as flame proofing for the inside of the control panel where the
servo amplifier or regenerative resistor is installed and for the wires used. Failing to do so may
lead to fire.
Do not damage, apply excessive stress, place heavy things on or sandwich the cables, as this
may lead to fire.
A-2
3. For injury prevention
CAUTION
Do not apply a voltage other than that specified in the instruction manual on any terminal.
Doing so may lead to destruction or damage.
Do not mistake the terminal connections, as this may lead to destruction or damage.
Do not mistake the polarity ( + / - ), as this may lead to destruction or damage.
Do not touch the heat radiating fins of controller or servo amplifier, regenerative resistor and
servomotor, etc., while the power is ON and for a short time after the power is turned OFF. In this
timing, these parts become very hot and may lead to burns.
Always turn the power OFF before touching the servomotor shaft or coupled machines, as these
parts may lead to injuries.
Do not go near the machine during test operations or during operations such as teaching.
Doing so may lead to injuries.
4. Various precautions
Strictly observe the following precautions.
Mistaken handling of the unit may lead to faults, injuries or electric shocks.
(1) System structure
CAUTION
Always install a leakage breaker on the Motion controller and servo amplifier power source.
If installation of an electromagnetic contactor for power shut off during an error, etc., is specified in
the instruction manual for the servo amplifier, etc., always install the electromagnetic contactor.
Install the emergency stop circuit externally so that the operation can be stopped immediately and
the power shut off.
Use the Motion controller, servo amplifier, servomotor and regenerative resistor with the correct
combinations listed in the instruction manual. Other combinations may lead to fire or faults.
Use the Motion controller, base unit and motion module with the correct combinations listed in the
instruction manual. Other combinations may lead to faults.
If safety standards (ex., robot safety rules, etc.,) apply to the system using the Motion controller,
servo amplifier and servomotor, make sure that the safety standards are satisfied.
Construct a safety circuit externally of the Motion controller or servo amplifier if the abnormal
operation of the Motion controller or servo amplifier differ from the safety directive operation in the
system.
In systems where coasting of the servomotor will be a problem during the forced stop, emergency
stop, servo OFF or power supply OFF, use dynamic brakes.
Make sure that the system considers the coasting amount even when using dynamic brakes.
In systems where perpendicular shaft dropping may be a problem during the forced stop,
emergency stop, servo OFF or power supply OFF, use both dynamic brakes and electromagnetic
brakes.
A-3
CAUTION
The dynamic brakes must be used only on errors that cause the forced stop, emergency stop, or
servo OFF. These brakes must not be used for normal braking.
The brakes (electromagnetic brakes) assembled into the servomotor are for holding applications,
and must not be used for normal braking.
The system must have a mechanical allowance so that the machine itself can stop even if the
stroke limits switch is passed through at the max. speed.
Use wires and cables that have a wire diameter, heat resistance and bending resistance
compatible with the system.
Use wires and cables within the length of the range described in the instruction manual.
The ratings and characteristics of the parts (other than Motion controller, servo amplifier and
servomotor) used in a system must be compatible with the Motion controller, servo amplifier and
servomotor.
Install a cover on the shaft so that the rotary parts of the servomotor are not touched during
operation.
There may be some cases where holding by the electromagnetic brakes is not possible due to the
life or mechanical structure (when the ball screw and servomotor are connected with a timing belt,
etc.). Install a stopping device to ensure safety on the machine side.
(2) Parameter settings and programming
CAUTION
Set the parameter values to those that are compatible with the Motion controller, servo amplifier,
servomotor and regenerative resistor model and the system application. The protective functions
may not function if the settings are incorrect.
The regenerative resistor model and capacity parameters must be set to values that conform to
the operation mode, servo amplifier and servo power supply module. The protective functions
may not function if the settings are incorrect.
Set the mechanical brake output and dynamic brake output validity parameters to values that are
compatible with the system application. The protective functions may not function if the settings
are incorrect.
Set the stroke limit input validity parameter to a value that is compatible with the system
application. The protective functions may not function if the setting is incorrect.
Set the servomotor encoder type (increment, absolute position type, etc.) parameter to a value
that is compatible with the system application. The protective functions may not function if the
setting is incorrect.
Set the servomotor capacity and type (standard, low-inertia, flat, etc.) parameter to values that
are compatible with the system application. The protective functions may not function if the
settings are incorrect.
Set the servo amplifier capacity and type parameters to values that are compatible with the
system application. The protective functions may not function if the settings are incorrect.
Use the program commands for the program with the conditions specified in the instruction
manual.
A-4
CAUTION
Set the sequence function program capacity setting, device capacity, latch validity range, I/O
assignment setting, and validity of continuous operation during error detection to values that are
compatible with the system application. The protective functions may not function if the settings
are incorrect.
Some devices used in the program have fixed applications, so use these with the conditions
specified in the instruction manual.
The input devices and data registers assigned to the link will hold the data previous to when
communication is terminated by an error, etc. Thus, an error correspondence interlock program
specified in the instruction manual must be used.
Use the interlock program specified in the intelligent function module's instruction manual for the
program corresponding to the intelligent function module.
(3) Transportation and installation
CAUTION
Transport the product with the correct method according to the mass.
Use the servomotor suspension bolts only for the transportation of the servomotor. Do not
transport the servomotor with machine installed on it.
Do not stack products past the limit.
When transporting the Motion controller or servo amplifier, never hold the connected wires or
cables.
When transporting the servomotor, never hold the cables, shaft or detector.
When transporting the Motion controller or servo amplifier, never hold the front case as it may fall
off.
When transporting, installing or removing the Motion controller or servo amplifier, never hold the
edges.
Install the unit according to the instruction manual in a place where the mass can be withstood.
Do not get on or place heavy objects on the product.
Always observe the installation direction.
Keep the designated clearance between the Motion controller or servo amplifier and control panel
inner surface or the Motion controller and servo amplifier, Motion controller or servo amplifier and
other devices.
Do not install or operate Motion controller, servo amplifiers or servomotors that are damaged or
that have missing parts.
Do not block the intake/outtake ports of the Motion controller, servo amplifier and servomotor with
cooling fan.
Do not allow conductive matter such as screw or cutting chips or combustible matter such as oil
enter the Motion controller, servo amplifier or servomotor.
The Motion controller, servo amplifier and servomotor are precision machines, so do not drop or
apply strong impacts on them.
Securely fix the Motion controller, servo amplifier and servomotor to the machine according to
the instruction manual. If the fixing is insufficient, these may come off during operation.
A-5
CAUTION
Always install the servomotor with reduction gears in the designated direction. Failing to do so
may lead to oil leaks.
Store and use the unit in the following environmental conditions.
Environment
Ambient
temperature
Ambient humidity
Storage
temperature
Atmosphere
Altitude
Vibration
Conditions
Motion controller/Servo amplifier
According to each instruction manual.
According to each instruction manual.
According to each instruction manual.
Servomotor
0°C to +40°C (With no freezing)
(32°F to +104°F)
80% RH or less
(With no dew condensation)
-20°C to +65°C
(-4°F to +149°F)
Indoors (where not subject to direct sunlight).
No corrosive gases, flammable gases, oil mist or dust must exist
1000m (3280.84ft.) or less above sea level
According to each instruction manual
When coupling with the synchronous encoder or servomotor shaft end, do not apply impact such
as by hitting with a hammer. Doing so may lead to detector damage.
Do not apply a load larger than the tolerable load onto the synchronous encoder and servomotor
shaft. Doing so may lead to shaft breakage.
When not using the module for a long time, disconnect the power line from the Motion controller
or servo amplifier.
Place the Motion controller and servo amplifier in static electricity preventing vinyl bags and store.
When storing for a long time, please contact with our sales representative.
Also, execute a trial operation.
When fumigants that contain halogen materials such as fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine
are used for disinfecting and protecting wooden packaging from insects, they cause malfunction
when entering our products.
Please take necessary precautions to ensure that remaining materials from fumigant do not
enter our products, or treat packaging with methods other than fumigation (heat method).
Additionally, disinfect and protect wood from insects before packing products.
A-6
(4) Wiring
CAUTION
Correctly and securely wire the wires. Reconfirm the connections for mistakes and the terminal
screws for tightness after wiring. Failing to do so may lead to run away of the servomotor.
After wiring, install the protective covers such as the terminal covers to the original positions.
Do not install a phase advancing capacitor, surge absorber or radio noise filter (option FR-BIF)
on the output side of the servo amplifier.
Correctly connect the output side (terminal U, V, W) and ground. Incorrect connections will lead
the servomotor to operate abnormally.
Do not connect a commercial power supply to the servomotor, as this may lead to trouble.
Do not mistake the direction of the surge absorbing diode installed on the DC relay for the control
signal output of brake signals, etc. Incorrect installation may lead to signals not being output
when trouble occurs or the protective functions not functioning.
Servo amplifier
DOCOM
Control output
signal
Servo amplifier
24VDC
DOCOM
Control output
signal
RA
DICOM
24VDC
RA
DICOM
For the sink output interface
For the source output interface
Do not connect or disconnect the connection cables between each unit, the encoder cable or
PLC expansion cable while the power is ON.
Securely tighten the cable connector fixing screws and fixing mechanisms. Insufficient fixing may
lead to the cables coming off during operation.
Do not bundle the power line or cables.
(5) Trial operation and adjustment
CAUTION
Confirm and adjust the program and each parameter before operation. Unpredictable
movements may occur depending on the machine.
Extreme adjustments and changes may lead to unstable operation, so never make them.
When using the absolute position system function, on starting up, and when the Motion controller
or absolute value motor has been replaced, always perform a home position return.
Before starting test operation, set the parameter speed limit value to the slowest value, and
make sure that operation can be stopped immediately by the forced stop, etc. if a hazardous
state occurs.
A-7
(6) Usage methods
CAUTION
Immediately turn OFF the power if smoke, abnormal sounds or odors are emitted from the
Motion controller, servo amplifier or servomotor.
Always execute a test operation before starting actual operations after the program or
parameters have been changed or after maintenance and inspection.
Do not attempt to disassemble and repair the units excluding a qualified technician whom our
company recognized.
Do not make any modifications to the unit.
Keep the effect or electromagnetic obstacles to a minimum by installing a noise filter or by using
wire shields, etc. Electromagnetic obstacles may affect the electronic devices used near the
Motion controller or servo amplifier.
When using the CE Mark-compliant equipment, refer to the User's manual for the Motion
controllers and refer to the corresponding EMC guideline information for the servo amplifiers,
inverters and other equipment.
Use the units with the following conditions.
Item
Conditions
Input power
According to each instruction manual.
Input frequency
According to each instruction manual.
Tolerable momentary power failure
According to each instruction manual.
(7) Corrective actions for errors
CAUTION
If an error occurs in the self diagnosis of the Motion controller or servo amplifier, confirm the
check details according to the instruction manual, and restore the operation.
If a dangerous state is predicted in case of a power failure or product failure, use a servomotor
with electromagnetic brakes or install a brake mechanism externally.
Use a double circuit construction so that the electromagnetic brake operation circuit can be
operated by emergency stop signals set externally.
Shut off with servo ON signal OFF,
alarm, electromagnetic brake signal.
Servo motor
RA1
Electromagnetic
B
brakes
Shut off with the
emergency stop
signal (EMG).
EMG
24VDC
If an error occurs, remove the cause, secure the safety and then resume operation after alarm
release.
The unit may suddenly resume operation after a power failure is restored, so do not go near the
machine. (Design the machine so that personal safety can be ensured even if the machine
restarts suddenly.)
A-8
(8) Maintenance, inspection and part replacement
CAUTION
Perform the daily and periodic inspections according to the instruction manual.
Perform maintenance and inspection after backing up the program and parameters for the Motion
controller and servo amplifier.
Do not place fingers or hands in the clearance when opening or closing any opening.
Periodically replace consumable parts such as batteries according to the instruction manual.
Do not touch the lead sections such as ICs or the connector contacts.
Before touching the module, always touch grounded metal, etc. to discharge static electricity from
human body. Failure to do so may cause the module to fail or malfunction.
Do not directly touch the module's conductive parts and electronic components.
Touching them could cause an operation failure or give damage to the module.
Do not place the Motion controller or servo amplifier on metal that may cause a power leakage
or wood, plastic or vinyl that may cause static electricity buildup.
Do not perform a megger test (insulation resistance measurement) during inspection.
When replacing the Motion controller or servo amplifier, always set the new module settings
correctly.
When the Motion controller or absolute value motor has been replaced, carry out a home
position return operation using one of the following methods, otherwise position displacement
could occur.
1) After writing the servo data to the Motion controller using programming software, switch on the
power again, then perform a home position return operation.
2) Using the backup function of the programming software, load the data backed up before
replacement.
After maintenance and inspections are completed, confirm that the position detection of the
absolute position detector function is correct.
Do not drop or impact the battery installed to the module.
Doing so may damage the battery, causing battery liquid to leak in the battery. Do not use the
dropped or impacted battery, but dispose of it.
Do not short circuit, charge, overheat, incinerate or disassemble the batteries.
The electrolytic capacitor will generate gas during a fault, so do not place your face near the
Motion controller or servo amplifier.
The electrolytic capacitor and fan will deteriorate. Periodically replace these to prevent secondary
damage from faults. Replacements can be made by our sales representative.
Lock the control panel and prevent access to those who are not certified to handle or install
electric equipment.
Do not burn or break a module and servo amplifier. Doing so may cause a toxic gas.
A-9
(9) About processing of waste
When you discard Motion controller, servo amplifier, a battery (primary battery) and other option
articles, please follow the law of each country (area).
CAUTION
This product is not designed or manufactured to be used in equipment or systems in situations
that can affect or endanger human life.
When considering this product for operation in special applications such as machinery or systems
used in passenger transportation, medical, aerospace, atomic power, electric power, or
submarine repeating applications, please contact your nearest Mitsubishi sales representative.
Although this product was manufactured under conditions of strict quality control, you are strongly
advised to install safety devices to forestall serious accidents when it is used in facilities where a
breakdown in the product is likely to cause a serious accident.
(10) General cautions
All drawings provided in the instruction manual show the state with the covers and safety
partitions removed to explain detailed sections. When operating the product, always return the
covers and partitions to the designated positions, and operate according to the instruction
manual.
A - 10
REVISIONS
The manual number is given on the bottom left of the back cover.
Print Date
Sep., 2007
Sep., 2010
Sep., 2011
Mar., 2012
Sep., 2012
Apr., 2013
Manual Number
Revision
IB(NA)-0300134-A First edition
IB(NA)-0300134-B [Additional model/function]
Software for SV43, Amplifier-less operation function, Q10UD(E)HCPU,
Q13UD(E)HCPU, Q20UD(E)HCPU, Q26UD(E)HCPU, QX40H, QX70H,
QH80H, QX90H, MR-J3- BS
[Additional correction/partial correction]
Safety precautions, About Manuals, Restrictions by the software's
version, Checking serial number and operating system software version,
Servo parameters, Warranty
[Additional
model]
IB(NA)-0300134-C
Q173DCPU-S1, Q172DCPU-S1, Q50UDEHCPU, Q100UDEHCPU,
GX Works2, MR Configurator2
[Additional function]
External input signal (DOG) of servo amplifier, Communication via
PERIPHERAL I/F
[Additional correction/partial correction]
Safety precautions, About Manuals, Restrictions by the software's
version
IB(NA)-0300134-D [Additional model]
Q173DSCPU, Q172DSCPU, MR-J4- B, MR-J4W- B,
[Additional function]
Servo external signal parameters, Software security key, Mark
detection function
[Additional correction/partial correction]
About Manuals, Manual Page Organization, Restrictions by the
software's version, Programming software version, Individual
parameters, Servo parameter change function, Optional data monitor
function, Special relays/Special registers list, System setting errors,
Differences between Motion CPU
[Additional
function]
IB(NA)-0300134-E
Advanced synchronous control, High-speed input request signal setting
[Additional correction/partial correction]
About Manuals, Restrictions by the software's version, Programming
software version, Individual parameters, Limit switch output function,
Protection by password, Mark detection function, Special relays/
Special registers list, Self-diagnosis error, Differences between Motion
CPU
IB(NA)-0300134-F [Additional model]
LJ72MS15, Intelligent function module
[Additional function]
Driver communication function, Connection of SSCNET /H head
module
[Additional correction/partial correction]
About Manuals, Restrictions by the software's version, System data
setting list, Individual parameters, Special relays/Special registers list,
System setting error, Self-diagnosis error, Differences between Motion
CPU
A - 11
Print Date
Nov., 2013
Manual Number
Revision
IB(NA)-0300134-G [Additional correction/partial correction]
Safety precautions, Restrictions by the software's version, System
data setting list, Optional data monitor function, Driver communication
function (SSCNET /H), Special registers list, System setting error,
Self-diagnosis error, Differences between Motion CPU
Japanese Manual Number IB(NA)-0300126
This manual confers no industrial property rights or any rights of any other kind, nor does it confer any patent
licenses. Mitsubishi Electric Corporation cannot be held responsible for any problems involving industrial property
rights which may occur as a result of using the contents noted in this manual.
© 2007 MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC CORPORATION
A - 12
INTRODUCTION
Thank you for choosing the Mitsubishi Motion controller Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU.
Before using the equipment, please read this manual carefully to develop full familiarity with the functions
and performance of the Motion controller you have purchased, so as to ensure correct use.
CONTENTS
Safety Precautions .........................................................................................................................................A- 1
Revisions ........................................................................................................................................................A-11
Contents .........................................................................................................................................................A-13
About Manuals ...............................................................................................................................................A-16
Manual Page Organization ............................................................................................................................A-18
1. OVERVIEW
1- 1 to 1-32
1.1 Overview................................................................................................................................................... 1- 1
1.2 Features ................................................................................................................................................... 1- 3
1.2.1 Features of Motion CPU ................................................................................................................... 1- 3
1.2.2 Basic specifications of Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU.................................................................... 1- 5
1.3 Hardware Configuration ........................................................................................................................... 1-11
1.3.1 Motion system configuration ............................................................................................................. 1-11
1.3.2 Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU System overall configuration .............................................................. 1-14
1.3.3 Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1) System overall configuration ................................................... 1-16
1.3.4 Software packages ............................................................................................................................ 1-17
1.3.5 Restrictions on motion systems ........................................................................................................ 1-19
1.4 Checking Serial Number and Operating System Software Version ....................................................... 1-23
1.4.1 Checking serial number .................................................................................................................... 1-23
1.4.2 Checking operating system software version................................................................................... 1-26
1.5 Restrictions by the Software's Version .................................................................................................... 1-28
1.6 Programming Software Version............................................................................................................... 1-32
2. MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
2- 1 to 2-36
2.1 Multiple CPU System ............................................................................................................................... 2- 1
2.1.1 Overview ............................................................................................................................................ 2- 1
2.1.2 Installation position of CPU module.................................................................................................. 2- 2
2.1.3 Precautions for using I/O modules and intelligent function modules ............................................... 2- 3
2.1.4 Modules subject to installation restrictions ....................................................................................... 2- 4
2.1.5 How to reset the Multiple CPU system ............................................................................................. 2- 6
2.1.6 Operation for CPU module stop error ............................................................................................... 2- 7
2.2 Starting Up the Multiple CPU System ..................................................................................................... 2-10
2.2.1 Startup Flow of the Multiple CPU system ......................................................................................... 2-10
2.3 Communication Between the PLC CPU and the Motion CPU in the Multiple CPU System ................. 2-12
2.3.1 CPU shared memory......................................................................................................................... 2-12
2.3.2 Multiple CPU high speed transmission............................................................................................. 2-15
2.3.3 Multiple CPU high speed refresh function ........................................................................................ 2-30
2.3.4 Clock synchronization between Multiple CPU ................................................................................. 2-34
2.3.5 Multiple CPU synchronous startup ................................................................................................... 2-35
2.3.6 Control instruction from PLC CPU to Motion CPU ........................................................................... 2-36
A - 13
3. COMMON PARAMETERS
3- 1 to 3-28
3.1 System Settings ....................................................................................................................................... 3- 1
3.1.1 System data settings ......................................................................................................................... 3- 2
3.1.2 Common system parameters ........................................................................................................... 3- 5
3.1.3 Individual parameters ........................................................................................................................ 3-11
3.2 I/O Number Assignment. ......................................................................................................................... 3-21
3.2.1 I/O number assignment of each module .......................................................................................... 3-21
3.2.2 I/O number of each CPU modules ................................................................................................... 3-23
3.2.3 I/O number setting ............................................................................................................................. 3-24
3.3 Servo Parameters .................................................................................................................................... 3-25
3.4 Servo External Signal Parameters .......................................................................................................... 3-26
4. AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4- 1 to 4-114
4.1 Limit Switch Output Function ................................................................................................................... 4- 1
4.1.1 Operations ......................................................................................................................................... 4- 1
4.1.2 Limit output setting data .................................................................................................................... 4- 4
4.1.3 Operations (SV22 advanced synchronous control only) ................................................................. 4- 8
4.1.4 Limit output setting data (SV22 advanced synchronous control only) ............................................ 4-10
4.2 Absolute Position System ........................................................................................................................ 4-17
4.2.1 Current value control ......................................................................................................................... 4-19
4.3 High-Speed Reading of Specified Data .................................................................................................. 4-20
4.4 ROM Operation Function ......................................................................................................................... 4-22
4.4.1 Specifications of 7-segment LED/switches ...................................................................................... 4-22
4.4.2 Outline of ROM operation ................................................................................................................. 4-24
4.4.3 Operating procedure of the ROM operation function ....................................................................... 4-29
4.5 Security Function ..................................................................................................................................... 4-31
4.5.1 Protection by password ..................................................................................................................... 4-31
4.5.2 Protection by software security key .................................................................................................. 4-38
4.6 All Clear Function ..................................................................................................................................... 4-43
4.7 Communication Via Network ................................................................................................................... 4-44
4.7.1 Specifications of the communications via network........................................................................... 4-44
4.8 Monitor Function of the Main Cycle ......................................................................................................... 4-45
4.9 Servo Parameter Read/Change Function ............................................................................................... 4-46
4.10 Optional Data Monitor Function ............................................................................................................. 4-48
4.11 SSCNET Control Function ..................................................................................................................... 4-51
4.11.1 Connect/disconnect function of SSCNET communication ............................................................ 4-52
4.11.2 Amplifier-less operation function .................................................................................................... 4-56
4.12 Remote Operation .................................................................................................................................. 4-60
4.12.1 Remote RUN/STOP ........................................................................................................................ 4-60
4.12.2 Remote latch clear .......................................................................................................................... 4-62
4.13 Communication Function via PERIPHERAL I/F ................................................................................... 4-63
4.13.1 Direct connection............................................................................................................................. 4-63
4.13.2 Connection via HUB ........................................................................................................................ 4-66
4.13.3 MC protocol communication ........................................................................................................... 4-72
4.14 Mark Detection Function ........................................................................................................................ 4-79
4.15 High-speed Input Request Signal Setting (SV22 advanced synchronous control only) ..................... 4-91
4.16 Driver Communication Function ............................................................................................................ 4-94
A - 14
4.16.1 Control details.................................................................................................................................. 4-95
4.16.2 Precautions during control .............................................................................................................. 4-96
4.16.3 Servo parameter............................................................................................................................ 4-100
4.17 Intelligent Function Modules Controlled by Motion CPU .................................................................... 4-101
4.18 Connection of SSCNET /H Head Module ......................................................................................... 4-104
4.18.1 System configuration..................................................................................................................... 4-104
4.18.2 SSCNET /H head module parameters ....................................................................................... 4-105
4.18.3 Data operation of intelligent function module by Motion SFC program....................................... 4-113
4.18.4 Data of refresh device ................................................................................................................... 4-113
4.18.5 Precautions when using SSCNET /H head module................................................................... 4-113
APPENDICES
APP- 1 to APP-48
APPENDIX 1 Special Relays/Special Registers ...................................................................................... APP- 1
APPENDIX 1.1 Special relays .............................................................................................................. APP- 1
APPENDIX 1.2 Special registers .................................................................................................... APP- 6
APPENDIX 1.3 Replacement of special relays/special registers ........................................................APP-13
APPENDIX 2 System Setting Errors ........................................................................................................APP-16
APPENDIX 3 Self-diagnosis Error ............................................................................................................APP-19
APPENDIX 4 Differences Between Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU/Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)/
Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU ....................................................................................................APP-32
APPENDIX 4.1 Differences between Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU/Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)/
Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU .............................................................................................APP-32
APPENDIX 4.2 Comparison of devices ................................................................................................APP-36
APPENDIX 4.3 Differences of the operating system software ............................................................APP-45
A - 15
About Manuals
The following manuals are also related to this product.
In necessary, order them by quoting the details in the tables below.
Related Manuals
(1) Motion controller
Manual Number
(Model Code)
Manual Name
Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller User's Manual
This manual explains specifications of the Motion CPU modules, Q172DLX Servo external signal interface
module, Q172DEX Synchronous encoder interface module, Q173DPX Manual pulse generator interface
module, Power supply modules, Servo amplifiers, SSCNET
IB-0300133
(1XB927)
cables and Synchronous encoder, and the
maintenance/inspection for the system, trouble shooting and others.
Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller Programming Manual (COMMON)
This manual explains the Multiple CPU system configuration, performance specifications, common
IB-0300134
(1XB928)
parameters, auxiliary/applied functions, error lists and others.
Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller (SV13/SV22) Programming Manual
(Motion SFC)
This manual explains the functions, programming, debugging, error lists for Motion SFC and others.
Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller (SV13/SV22) Programming Manual
(REAL MODE)
This manual explains the servo parameters, positioning instructions, device lists, error lists and others.
Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller (SV22) Programming Manual
(VIRTUAL MODE)
This manual explains the dedicated instructions to use the synchronous control by virtual main shaft,
mechanical system program create mechanical module, servo parameters, positioning instructions, device
IB-0300135
(1XB929)
IB-0300136
(1XB930)
IB-0300137
(1XB931)
lists, error lists and others.
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU Motion controller (SV22) Programming Manual
(Advanced Synchronous Control)
This manual explains the dedicated instructions to use the synchronous control by synchronous control
IB-0300198
(1XB953)
parameters, device lists, error lists and others.
Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller Programming Manual (Safety Observation)
This manual explains the details, safety parameters, safety sequence program instructions, device lists
IB-0300183
(1XB945)
and error lists and others for safety observation function by Motion controller.
Motion controller Setup Guidance (MT Developer2 Version1)
This manual explains the items related to the setup of the Motion controller programming software
MT Developer2.
A - 16
IB-0300142
( — )
(2) PLC
Manual Number
(Model Code)
Manual Name
QCPU User's Manual (Hardware Design, Maintenance and Inspection)
This manual explains the specifications of the QCPU modules, power supply modules, base units,
extension cables, memory card battery, and the maintenance/inspection for the system, trouble shooting,
SH-080483ENG
(13JR73)
error codes and others.
QnUCPU User's Manual (Function Explanation, Program Fundamentals)
This manual explains the functions, programming methods and devices and others to create programs
SH-080807ENG
(13JZ27)
with the QCPU.
QCPU User's Manual (Multiple CPU System)
This manual explains the Multiple CPU system overview, system configuration, I/O modules,
communication between CPU modules and communication with the I/O modules or intelligent function
SH-080485ENG
(13JR75)
modules.
QnUCPU User's Manual (Communication via Built-in Ethernet Port)
This manual explains functions for the communication via built-in Ethernet port of the CPU module.
MELSEC-Q/L Programming Manual (Common Instruction)
This manual explains how to use the sequence instructions, basic instructions, application instructions and
SH-080811ENG
(13JZ29)
SH-080809ENG
(13JW10)
micro computer program.
MELSEC-Q/L/QnA Programming Manual (PID Control Instructions)
This manual explains the dedicated instructions used to exercise PID control.
MELSEC-Q/L/QnA Programming Manual (SFC)
This manual explains the system configuration, performance specifications, functions, programming,
SH-080040
(13JF59)
SH-080041
(13JF60)
debugging, error codes and others of MELSAP3.
I/O Module Type Building Block User's Manual
This manual explains the specifications of the I/O modules, connector, connector/terminal block
SH-080042
(13JL99)
conversion modules and others.
MELSEC-L SSCNET /H Head Module User's Manual
This manual explains specifications of the head module, procedures before operation, system
configuration, installation, wiring, settings, and troubleshooting.
A - 17
SH-081152ENG
(13JZ78)
(3) Servo amplifier
Manual Number
(Model Code)
Manual Name
SSCNET /H interface MR-J4- B Servo amplifier Instruction Manual
This manual explains the I/O signals, parts names, parameters, start-up procedure and others for
SH-030106
(1CW805)
MR-J4- B Servo amplifier.
SSCNET /H interface Multi-axis AC Servo MR-J4W- B Servo amplifier Instruction Manual
This manual explains the I/O signals, parts names, parameters, start-up procedure and others for Multi-
SH-030105
(1CW806)
axis AC Servo MR-J4W - B Servo amplifier.
SSCNET
interface MR-J3- B Servo amplifier Instruction Manual
This manual explains the I/O signals, parts names, parameters, start-up procedure and others for
SH-030051
(1CW202)
MR-J3- B Servo amplifier.
SSCNET
Manual
interface 2-axis AC Servo Amplifier MR-J3W- B Servo amplifier Instruction
This manual explains the I/O signals, parts names, parameters, start-up procedure and others for 2-axis
AC Servo Amplifier MR-J3W- B Servo amplifier.
SSCNET
Compatible Linear Servo MR-J3- B-RJ004 Instruction Manual
This manual explains the I/O signals, parts names, parameters, start-up procedure and others for Linear
SH-030073
(1CW604)
SH-030054
(1CW943)
Servo MR-J3- B-RJ004 Servo amplifier.
SSCNET Compatible Fully Closed Loop Control MR-J3- B-RJ006 Servo amplifier
Instruction Manual
This manual explains the I/O signals, parts names, parameters, start-up procedure and others for Fully
SH-030056
(1CW304)
Closed Loop Control MR-J3- B-RJ006 Servo amplifier.
SSCNET
Manual
Interface Direct Drive Servo MR-J3- B-RJ080W Servo amplifier Instruction
This manual explains the I/O signals, parts names, parameters, start-up procedure and others for Direct
SH-030079
(1CW601)
Drive Servo MR-J3- B-RJ080W Servo amplifier.
SSCNET
Manual
interface Drive Safety integrated MR-J3- B Safety Servo amplifier Instruction
This manual explains the I/O signals, parts names, parameters, start-up procedure and others for safety
SH-030084
(1CW205)
integrated MR-J3- B Safety Servo amplifier.
Manual Page Organization
The symbols used in this manual are shown below.
Symbol
QDS
QD
Description
Symbol that indicates correspondence to only Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU.
Symbol that indicates correspondence to only Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1).
A - 18
1 OVERVIEW
1. OVERVIEW
1
1.1 Overview
This programming manual describes the common items of each operating system
software, such as the Multiple CPU system of the operating system software packages
"SW7DNC-SV Q " and "SW8DNC-SV Q " for Motion CPU module
(Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU).
In this manual, the following abbreviations are used.
Generic term/Abbreviation
Description
Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU or
Motion CPU (module)
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU/Q173DCPU/Q172DCPU/Q173DCPU-S1/
Q172DCPU-S1 Motion CPU module
Q172DLX/Q172DEX/Q173DPX/
Q173DSXY or Motion module
Q172DLX Servo external signals interface module/
(Note-1)
Q172DEX Synchronous encoder interface module
/
Q173DPX Manual pulse generator interface module/
Q173DSXY Safety signal module
MR-J4(W)- B
Servo amplifier model MR-J4- B/MR-J4W- B
MR-J3(W)- B
Servo amplifier model MR-J3- B/MR-J3W- B
AMP or Servo amplifier
General name for "Servo amplifier model MR-J4- B/MR-J4W- B/MR-J3- B/
MR-J3W- B"
QCPU, PLC CPU or PLC CPU module QnUD(E)(H)CPU/QnUDVCPU
Multiple CPU system or Motion system Abbreviation for "Multiple PLC system of the Q series"
CPUn
Abbreviation for "CPU No.n (n= 1 to 4) of the CPU module for the Multiple CPU
system"
Operating system software
General name for "SW7DNC-SV Q /SW8DNC-SV Q "
SV13
Operating system software for conveyor assembly use (Motion SFC) :
SW8DNC-SV13Q
SV22
Operating system software for automatic machinery use (Motion SFC) :
SW8DNC-SV22Q
SV43
Operating system software for machine tool peripheral use :
SW7DNC-SV43Q
Programming software package
General name for MT Developer2/GX Works2/GX Developer/MR Configurator
MELSOFT MT Works2
Abbreviation for "Motion controller engineering environment MELSOFT
MT Works2"
MT Developer2
Abbreviation for "Motion controller programming software MT Developer2
(Version 1.00A or later)"
GX Works2
Abbreviation for "Programmable controller engineering software
MELSOFT GX Works2 (Version 1.15R or later)"
GX Developer
Abbreviation for "MELSEC PLC programming software package
GX Developer (Version 8.48A or later)"
(Note-2)
MR Configurator
(Note-2)
General name for "MR Configurator/MR Configurator2"
MR Configurator
Abbreviation for "Servo setup software package
MR Configurator (Version C0 or later)"
MR Configurator2
Abbreviation for "Servo setup software package
MR Configurator2 (Version 1.01B or later)"
Manual pulse generator or MR-HDP01 Abbreviation for "Manual pulse generator (MR-HDP01)"
Serial absolute synchronous encoder
or Q171ENC-W8/Q170ENC
Abbreviation for "Serial absolute synchronous encoder (Q171ENC-W8/
Q170ENC)"
1-1
1 OVERVIEW
Generic term/Abbreviation
Description
(Note-3)
SSCNET /H
SSCNET
High speed synchronous network between Motion controller and servo amplifier
(Note-3)
(Note-3)
SSCNET (/H)
General name for SSCNET /H, SSCNET
Absolute position system
General name for "system using the servomotor and servo amplifier for absolute
position"
Battery holder unit
Battery holder unit (Q170DBATC)
Intelligent function module
General name for module that has a function other than input or output such as
A/D converter module and D/A converter module.
(Note-3)
SSCNET /H head module
Abbreviation for "MELSEC-L series SSCNET /H head module (LJ72MS15)"
(Note-1): Q172DEX can be used in SV22.
(Note-2): This software is included in Motion controller engineering environment "MELSOFT MT Works2".
(Note-3): SSCNET: Servo System Controller NETwork
REMARK
For information about each module, design method for program and parameter, refer
to the following manuals relevant to each module.
Item
Reference Manual
Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller
Motion CPU module/Motion unit
User’s Manual
PLC CPU, peripheral devices for sequence program design,
I/O modules and intelligent function module
Operation method for MT Developer2
Help of each software
• Design method for Motion SFC program
• Design method for Motion SFC parameter
• Motion dedicated PLC instruction
Manual relevant to each module
Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller
(SV13/SV22) Programming Manual (Motion SFC)
• Design method for positioning control
program in the real mode
SV13/SV22
• Design method for positioning control
Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller
(SV13/SV22) Programming Manual (REAL MODE)
parameter
• Design method for safety observation
parameter
• Design method for user made safety
Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller
Programming Manual (Safety Observation)
sequence program
SV22
(Virtual mode)
• Design method for mechanical system
program
Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller (SV22)
Programming Manual (VIRTUAL MODE)
SV22
(Advanced
synchronous
• Design method for synchronous control
parameter
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU Motion controller (SV22)
Programming Manual (Advanced Synchronous Control)
control)
1-2
1 OVERVIEW
1.2 Features
The Motion CPU and Multiple CPU system have the following features.
1.2.1 Features of Motion CPU
(1) Q series PLC Multiple CPU system
(a) Load distribution of processing can be performed by controlling the
complicated servo control with Motion CPU and the machine control or
information control with PLC CPU. Therefore, the flexible system
configuration can be realized.
(b) The Motion CPU and PLC CPU are selected flexibly, and the Multiple CPU
system up to 4 CPU modules can be realized.
The Motion CPU module for the number of axis to be used can be selected.
Q173DSCPU
: Up to 32 axes
Q172DSCPU
: Up to 16 axes
Q173DCPU(-S1) : Up to 32 axes
Q172DCPU(-S1) : Up to 8 axes
The PLC CPU module for the program capacity to be used can be selected.
(One or more PLC CPU is necessary with the Multiple CPU system.)
(c) The device data access of the Motion CPU and the Motion SFC program
(SV13/SV22)/Motion program (SV43) start can be executed from PLC CPU
by the Motion dedicated PLC instruction.
(2) High speed operation processing
(a) The minimum operation cycle of the Motion CPU is made 0.22[ms]
(Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU use), and it correspond with high frequency
operation.
(b) High speed PLC control is possible by the universal model QCPU.
(3) Connection between the Motion controller and servo amplifier with
high speed synchronous network by SSCNET (/H)
(a) High speed synchronous network by SSCNET (/H) connect between the
Motion controller and servo amplifier, and batch control the charge of servo
parameter, servo monitor and test operation, etc.
It is also realised reduce the number of wires.
(b) The maximum distance between the Motion CPU and servo amplifier, servo
amplifier and servo amplifier of the SSCNET cable on the same bus was
set to 100(328.08)[m(ft.)] for SSCNET /H, 50(164.04)[m(ft.)] for SSCNET ,
and the flexibility improved at the Motion system design.
1-3
1 OVERVIEW
(4) The operating system software package for your application needs
By installing the operating system software for applications in the internal flash
memory of the Motion CPU, the Motion controller suitable for the machine can be
realized. And, it also can correspond with the function improvement of the
software package.
(a) Conveyor assembly use (SV13)
Offer linear interpolation, circular interpolation, helical interpolation,
constant-speed control, speed control, fixed-pitch feed and etc. by the
dedicated servo instruction. Ideal for use in conveyors and assembly
machines.
(b) Automatic machinery use (SV22)
In addition to the functions (real mode) equivalent to the software package
for conveyor assembly use (SV13), provides synchronous control and offers
electronic cam control. Ideal for use in automatic machinery.
1) Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
Select the operation method from the following methods when installing
the operating system software.
The operation method can be switched by using MT Developer2.
• Virtual mode switching method:
By using the common device (real mode/virtual mode switching
request flag), switching between the positioning control in the real
mode and the synchronous control, electronic cam control by
mechanical support language (virtual mode) is enabled.
• Advanced synchronous control method:
In addition to the positioning control in the real mode, provides
synchronous control by setting the synchronous control parameter
(advanced synchronous control) by using the synchronous control start
signal for each axis.
2) Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
By using the common device (real mode/virtual mode switching request
flag), switching between the positioning control in the real mode and the
synchronous control, electronic cam control by mechanical support
language (virtual mode) is enabled.
(c) Machine tool peripheral use (SV43)
Offer linear interpolation, circular interpolation, helical interpolation,
constantspeed positioning and etc. by the EIA language (G-code). Ideal for
use in machine tool peripheral.
1-4
1 OVERVIEW
1.2.2 Basic specifications of Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU
(1) Module specifications
Item
Q173DSCPU
Internal current consumption
(5VDC) [A]
1.75
Mass [kg]
Q172DSCPU
(Note-1)
1.44
Q173DCPU
Q173DCPU-S1
Q172DCPU
Q172DCPU-S1
1.25
1.30
1.25
1.30
(Note-1)
0.38
Exterior dimensions [mm(inch)]
0.33
120.5 (4.74)(H)
27.4 (1.08)(W)
120.3 (4.74)(D)
98 (3.85)(H)
27.4 (1.08)(W)
119.3 (4.70)(D)
(Note-1): The current consumption (0.2[A]) of manual pulse generator/incremental synchronous encoder connected to the internal I/F
connector is not included.
(2) SV13/SV22 Motion control specifications/performance
specifications
(a) Motion control specifications
Item
Q173DSCPU
Q172DSCPU
Q173DCPU(-S1)
Q172DCPU(-S1)
Up to 32 axes
Up to 16 axes
Up to 32 axes
Up to 8 axes
SV13
0.22ms/ 1 to 4 axes
0.44ms/ 5 to 10 axes
0.88ms/ 11 to 24 axes
1.77ms/25 to 32 axes
0.22ms/ 1 to 4 axes
0.44ms/ 5 to 10 axes
0.88ms/ 11 to 16 axes
0.44ms/ 1 to 6 axes
0.88ms/ 7 to 18 axes
1.77ms/19 to 32 axes
0.44ms/ 1 to 6 axes
0.88ms/ 7 to 8 axes
SV22
0.44ms/ 1 to 6 axes
0.88ms/ 7 to 16 axes
1.77ms/17 to 32 axes
0.44ms/ 1 to 6 axes
0.88ms/ 7 to 16 axes
0.44ms/ 1 to 4 axes
0.88ms/ 5 to 12 axes
1.77ms/13 to 28 axes
3.55ms/29 to 32 axes
0.44ms/ 1 to 4 axes
0.88ms/ 5 to 8 axes
Number of control axes
Operation cycle
(default)
Interpolation functions
Control modes
Acceleration/
deceleration control
Compensation
Programming language
Linear interpolation (Up to 4 axes), Circular interpolation (2 axes),
Helical interpolation (3 axes)
PTP(Point to Point) control, Speed control,
Speed-position control, Fixed-pitch feed,
Constant speed control, Position follow-up control,
Speed control with fixed position stop,
Speed switching control,
High-speed oscillation control,
Speed-torque control,
Synchronous control (SV22 (Virtual mode
switching method/Advanced synchronous control
method))
Trapezoidal acceleration/deceleration, S-curve acceleration/deceleration,
Advanced S-curve acceleration/deceleration
Backlash compensation, Electronic gear, Phase compensation (SV22)
Peripheral I/F
Home position return function
Motion SFC, Dedicated instruction,
Mechanical support language (SV22)
Motion SFC, Dedicated instruction,
(Note-1)
Mechanical support language (SV22)
Servo program capacity
Number of positioning points
PTP(Point to Point) control, Speed control,
Speed-position control, Fixed-pitch feed,
Constant speed control, Position follow-up control,
Speed control with fixed position stop,
Speed switching control,
High-speed oscillation control,
Synchronous control (SV22)
16k steps
3200 points (Positioning data can be designated indirectly)
USB/RS-232/Ethernet (Via PLC CPU)
PERIPHERAL I/F (Motion CPU)
USB/RS-232/Ethernet (Via PLC CPU)
(Note-2)
PERIPHERAL I/F (Motion CPU)
Proximity dog type (2 types), Count type (3 types),
Data set type (2 types), Dog cradle type,
Stopper type (2 types), Limit switch combined
type, Scale home position signal detection type,
Dogless home position signal reference type
Proximity dog type (2 types), Count type (3 types),
Data set type (2 types), Dog cradle type,
Stopper type (2 types), Limit switch combined
type, Scale home position signal detection type
Home position return re-try function provided, home position shift function provided
1-5
1 OVERVIEW
Motion control specifications (continued)
Item
Q173DSCPU
Q172DSCPU
JOG operation function
Manual pulse generator
operation function
Synchronous encoder operation
(Note-4)
function
M-code function
Limit switch output
function
Possible to connect 3 modules (Q173DPX use)
Possible to connect 1 module
(Note-3)
(Built-in interface in Motion CPU use)
Possible to connect 3 modules (Q173DPX use)
Possible to connect 12 module (SV22 use)
(Q172DEX + Q173DPX + Built-in interface in
(Note-5)
Motion CPU + Via device
(Note-5), (Note-6)
+ Via servo amplifier
)
Possible to connect 8
Possible to connect 12
modules (SV22 use)
modules (SV22 use)
(Q172DEX + Q173DPX) (Q172DEX + Q173DPX)
SV22
Number of output points 32 points
Watch data: Motion control data/Word device
Virtual mode switching method:
Number of output points 32 points
Advanced synchronous control method:
Number of output points 64 points  2 settings
Output timing compensation
Watch data: Motion control data/Word device
ROM operation function
Multiple CPU synchronous
(Note-5)
control
External input signal
High-speed reading function
(Note-7)
Number of output points 32 points
Watch data: Motion control data/Word device
Provided
Provided
None
Q172DLX, External input signals (FLS/RLS/DOG)
of servo amplifier,
Built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI), Bit device
Q172DLX or External input signals
(FLS/RLS/DOG) of servo amplifier
Provided
(Via built-in interface in Motion CPU,
Via input module,
Via tracking of Q172DEX/Q173DPX)
Provided
(Via input module, Via tracking of
Q172DEX/Q173DPX)
Motion controller forced stop (EMI connector, System setting),
Forced stop terminal of servo amplifier
Forced stop
Number of I/O points
Total 256 points
(Built-in interface in Motion CPU (Input 4 points) +
I/O module + Intelligent function module)
Mark detection
mode setting
Continuous detection mode,
Specified number of detection mode,
Ring buffer mode
Mark detection
signal
Built-in interface in Motion CPU (4 points),
Bit device, DOG/CHANGE signal of Q172DLX
Mark detection
setting
32 settings
Clock function
Total 256 points
(I/O module)
None
Provided
Provided
(Protection by software security key or password)
Security function
All clear function
Provided
(Protection by password)
Provided
Remote operation
Optional data
monitor
function
Q172DCPU(-S1)
M-code output function provided, M-code completion wait function provided
SV13
Mark detection
function
Q173DCPU(-S1)
Provided
SSCNET /H
SSCNET
Digital oscilloscope function
Remote RUN/STOP, Remote latch clear
Up to 6 data/axis
(Communication data: Up to 6 points/axis)
None
Up to 3 data/axis
(Communication data: Up to 3 points/axis)
Motion buffering method
(Real-time waveform can be displayed)
Sampling data: Word 16CH, Bit 16CH
1-6
Motion buffering method
(Real-time waveform can be displayed)
Sampling data: Word 4CH, Bit 8CH
1 OVERVIEW
Motion control specifications (continued)
Item
Absolute position system
Communication
SSCNET
method
communication
Number of
(Note-8)
lines
Driver communication function
(Note-10)
Number of
Motion related
modules
Q172DLX
Q173DSCPU
Q172DSCPU
SSCNET /H, SSCNET
2 lines
(Note-9)
1 line
Q172DCPU(-S1)
SSCNET
(Note-9)
2 lines
1 line
Provided
4 modules usable
Q172DEX
None
2 modules usable
4 modules usable
6 modules usable
4 modules usable
Q173DPX
Number of SSCNET /H head
module connection stations
Q173DCPU(-S1)
Made compatible by setting battery to servo amplifier.
(Possible to select the absolute data method or incremental method for each axis)
Up to 8 stations usable
(Up to 4 stations/line)
3 modules usable
(Note-11)
Up to 4 stations usable
1 module usable
4 modules usable
(Note-11)
Unusable
(Note-1): SV22 virtual mode only
(Note-2): Q173DCPU-S1/Q172DCPU-S1 only
(Note-3): When the manual pulse generator is used via the built-in interface in Motion CPU, the Q173DPX cannot be used.
(Note-4): Any incremental synchronous encoder connected to the built-in interface in Motion CPU will automatically be assigned an
Axis No. one integer greater than the number of encoders connected to any Q172DEX modules and Q173DPX modules.
(Note-5): SV22 advanced synchronous control only
(Note-6): Servo amplifier (MR-J4- B-RJ) only.
(Note-7): This cannot be used in SV22 advanced synchronous control.
(Note-8): The servo amplifiers for SSCNET cannot be used.
(Note-9): SSCNET and SSCNET /H cannot be combined in the same line.
For Q173DSCPU, SSCNET or SSCNET /H can be set every line.
(Note-10): Servo amplifier (MR-J3- B/MR-J4- B-RJ) only.
(Note-11): When using the incremental synchronous encoder (SV22 use), you can use above number of modules.
When connecting the manual pulse generator, you can use only 1 module.
1-7
1 OVERVIEW
(b) Motion SFC Performance Specifications
Item
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
652k bytes
543k bytes
668k bytes
484k bytes
Code total
(Motion SFC chart + Operation control +
Motion SFC program
Transition)
capacity
Text total
(Operation control + Transition)
Number of Motion SFC programs
256 (No.0 to 255)
Motion SFC chart size/program
Motion SFC program
Up to 64k bytes (Included Motion SFC chart comments)
Number of Motion SFC steps/program
Up to 4094 steps
Number of selective branches/branch
255
Number of parallel branches/branch
255
Parallel branch nesting
Up to 4 levels
Number of operation control programs
4096 with F(Once execution type) and FS(Scan execution type)
combined. (F/FS0 to F/FS4095)
Number of transition programs
Operation control
program
(F/FS)
/
Transition program
(G)
4096(G0 to G4095)
Code size/program
Up to approx. 64k bytes (32766 steps)
Number of blocks(line)/program
Up to 8192 blocks (in the case of 4 steps(min)/blocks)
Number of characters/block
Up to 128 (comment included)
Number of operand/block
Up to 64 (operand: constants, word device, bit devices)
( ) nesting/block
Up to 32 levels
Operation control
program
Descriptive
expression
Calculation expression,
bit conditional expression,
branch/repetition processing
Calculation expression/bit conditional expression/
comparison conditional expression
Transition program
Number of multi execute programs
Up to 256
Number of multi active steps
Up to 256 steps/all programs
Normal task
Execute specification
Execute in main cycle of Motion CPU
Execute in fixed cycle
Execute in fixed cycle
(0.22ms, 0.44ms, 0.88ms, 1.77ms, (0.44ms, 0.88ms, 1.77ms, 3.55ms,
7.11ms, 14.2ms)
3.55ms, 7.11ms, 14.2ms)
Event task
Fixed cycle
Executed (Execution
can be
task
External interrupt Execute when input ON is set among interrupt module QI60 (16 points).
masked.)
PLC interrupt
Execute with interrupt instruction (D(P).GINT) from PLC CPU.
NMI task
Execute when input ON is set among interrupt module QI60 (16 points).
Number of I/O points (X/Y)
8192 points
256 points
(Built-in interface in Motion CPU
(Input 4 points) + I/O module +
Intelligent function module)
Number of real I/O points (PX/PY)
Number of devices
(Device In the Motion
CPU only)
(Included the
positioning dedicated
device)
Calculation expression,
bit conditional expression
Internal relays
(M)
Link relays
(B)
8192 points
Annunciators
(F)
2048 points
Special relays
(SM)
Data registers
(D)
Link registers
(W)
Special registers
(SD)
Motion registers
(#)
Coasting timers
(FT)
Multiple CPU area devices
(U \G)
256 points
(I/O module)
12288 points
8192 points
(Note-1)
2256 points
8192 points
8192 points
2256 points
12288 points
1 point (888µs)
Up to 14336 points usable
(Note-2)
(Note-1): 19824 points can be used for SV22 advanced synchronous control.
(Note-2): Usable number of points changes according to the system settings.
1-8
1 OVERVIEW
(3) SV43 Motion control specifications/performance specifications
(a) Motion control specifications
Item
Number of control axes
Operation cycle
(default)
Interpolation functions
Control modes
Q173DCPU(-S1)
Q172DCPU(-S1)
Up to 32 axes
Up to 8 axes
0.44ms/ 1 to 4 axes
0.88ms/ 5 to 12 axes
1.77ms/13 to 28 axes
3.55ms/29 to 32 axes
0.44ms/ 1 to 4 axes
0.88ms/ 5 to 8 axes
Linear interpolation (Up to 4 axes), Circular interpolation (2 axes), Helical interpolation (3 axes)
PTP (Point to Point) control, Constant speed positioning, High-speed oscillation control
Acceleration/deceleration control
Trapezoidal acceleration/deceleration, S-curve acceleration/deceleration
Compensation
Backlash compensation, Electronic gear
Programming language
Dedicated instruction (EIA language)
Motion program capacity
504k bytes
Number of programs
Number of simultaneous start
programs
Number of positioning points
1024
Axis designation program : 32
Control program : 16
Axis designation program : 8
Control program : 16
Approx. 10600 points (Positioning data can be designated indirectly)
USB/RS-232/Ethernet (Via PLC CPU)
(Note-1)
PERIPHERAL I/F (Motion CPU)
Peripheral I/F
Home position return function
Proximity dog type (2 types), Count type (3 types), Data set type (2 types), Dog cradle type, Stopper
type (2 types), Limit switch combined type, Scale home position signal detection type
Home position return re-try function provided, home position shift function provided
JOG operation function
Provided
Manual pulse generator
operation function
Possible to connect 3 modules (Q173DPX use)
M-code function
M-code output function provided, M-code completion wait function provided
Number of output points 32 points
Watch data: Motion control data/Word device
Limit switch output function
Skip function
Provided
Override ratio setting function
Override ratio setting : -100 to 100[%]
ROM operation function
External input signal
High-speed reading function
Provided
Q172DLX or External input signals (FLS/RLS/DOG) of servo amplifier
Provided (Via input module, Via tracking of Q173DPX)
Motion controller forced stop (EMI connector, System setting),
Forced stop terminal of servo amplifier
Forced stop
Number of I/O points
Total 256 points (I/O module)
Clock function
Provided
Security function
Provided (Protection by password)
All clear function
Provided
Remote operation
Remote RUN/STOP, Remote latch clear
Digital oscilloscope function
Absolute position system
SSCNET
communication
Provided
Made compatible by setting battery to servo amplifier.
(Possible to select the absolute data method or incremental method for each axis)
Communication
method
SSCNET
(Note-2)
Number of
lines
2 lines
1 line
Number of
Motion related
modules
Q172DLX
4 modules usable
1 module usable
Q173DPX
1 modules usable
(Note-1): Q173DCPU-S1/Q172DCPU-S1 only
(Note-2): The servo amplifiers for SSCNET cannot be used.
1-9
1 OVERVIEW
(b) Motion program performance specifications
Item
Program capacity
Operation controls
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
Total of program files
504k bytes
Number of programs
Up to 1024 (No. 1 to 1024)
Arithmetic operation
Unary operation, Addition and subtraction operation, Multiplication and
division operation, Remainder operation
Comparison operation
Equal to, Not equal to
Logical shift operation, Logical negation, Logical AND,
Logical OR, Exclusive OR
Logical operation
G-codes
G00, G01, G02, G03, G04, G09, G12, G13, G23, G24, G25, G26, G28,
G30, G32, G43, G44, G49, G53, G54, G55, G56, G57, G58, G59, G61,
G64, G90, G91, G92, G98, G99, G100, G101
Positioning command
M-codes
Output command to data register
Special M-codes
Program control command
Variable
Device variable
Functions
M****
M00, M01, M02, M30, M98, M99, M100
X, Y, M, B, F, D, W, #, U
Trigonometric function
SIN, COS, TAN, ASIN, ACOS, ATAN
Numerical function
ABS, SQR, BIN, LN, EXP, BCD, RND, FIX, FUP, INT, FLT, DFLT, SFLT
Start/end
CALL, CLEAR
Home position return
CHGA
Speed/torque setting
CHGV, CHGT, TL
Motion control
WAITON, WAITOFF, EXEON, EXEOFF
Instructions
CALL, GOSUB, GOSUBE, IF…GOTO,
IF…THEN…ELSE IF...ELSE...END,
WHILE…DO…BREAK...CONTINUE...END
Jump/repetition processing
BMOV, BDMOV, FMOV, BSET, BRST, SET, RST, MULTW, MULTR,
TO, FROM, ON, OFF, IF…THEN…SET/RST/OUT, PB
Data operation
Number of controls
Program calls (GOSUB/GOSUBE)
Up to 8
Program calls (M98)
Up to 8
Internal relays
Number of devices
(Device In the Motion
CPU only)
(Included the
positioning dedicated
device)
\G
(M)
8192 points
Link relays
(B)
8192 points
Annunciators
(F)
2048 points
Special relays
(SM)
2256 points
Data registers
(D)
8192 points
Link registers
(W)
8192 points
Special registers
(SD)
2256 points
Motion registers
(#)
8736 points
Coasting timers
(FT)
Multiple CPU area devices
(U \G)
1 point (888µs)
Up to 14336 points usable
(Note)
(Note): Usable number of points changes according to the system settings.
1 - 10
1 OVERVIEW
1.3 Hardware Configuration
This section describes the Motion controller system configuration, precautions on use
of system, and configured equipments.
1.3.1 Motion system configuration
(1) Equipment configuration in system
(a) Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
Extension of the Q series module
(Note-2)
Power supply module/
QnUD(E)(H)CPU/QnUDVCPU/
I/O module/Intelligent function
module of the Q series
Motion module
(Q172DLX, Q173DPX)
Motion module
(Q172DLX, Q172DEX, Q173DPX)
Main base unit
(Q35DB, Q38DB, Q312DB)
Extension cable
(QC B)
Q6 B extension base unit
(Q63B, Q65B, Q68B, Q612B)
Safety signal module
(Q173DSXY)
Motion CPU module
(Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU)
Forced stop input cable
(Q170DEMICBL M)
Power supply module/
I/O module/Intelligent function
module of the Q series
(Note-1)
M IT S U B I S H I
L IT H IU M
B A T T E R Y
PROGRAMMABLE CONTROLLER
TYPE Q6BAT
RIO cable
(Q173DSXYCBL M)
SSCNET cable
(MR-J3BUS M(-A/-B))
Battery
(Q6BAT)
Servo amplifier
(MR-J3(W)- B)
Servo amplifier
(MR-J4(W)- B)
It is possible to select the best according to the system.
(Note-1): Be sure to install the Battery (Q6BAT).
It is packed together with Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU.
(Note-2): Q172DEX cannot be used in the extension base unit.
Install it to the main base unit.
1 - 11
1 OVERVIEW
(b) Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
Extension of the Q series module
(Note-2)
Power supply module/
QnUD(E)(H)CPU/QnUDVCPU/
I/O module/Intelligent function
module of the Q series
Motion module
(Q172DLX, Q172DEX, Q173DPX)
Motion module
(Q172DLX, Q173DPX)
Main base unit
(Q35DB, Q38DB, Q312DB)
Extension cable
(QC B)
Q6 B extension base unit
(Q63B, Q65B, Q68B, Q612B)
Motion CPU module
(Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1))
Forced stop input cable
(Q170DEMICBL M)
Power supply module/
I/O module/Intelligent function
module of the Q series
(Note-3)
Safety signal module
(Q173DSXY)
(Note-3)
RIO cable
(Q173DSXYCBL M)
(Note-1)
SSCNET cable
(MR-J3BUS M(-A/-B))
Battery holder unit
(Q170DBATC)
(Note-1)
M IT S U B I S H I
L IT H IU M
B A T T E R Y
PROGRAMMABLE CONTROLLER
TYPE Q6BAT
Servo amplifier
(MR-J3(W)- B)
Battery
(Q6BAT)
It is possible to select the best according to the system.
(Note-1): Be sure to install the Battery (Q6BAT) to the Battery holder unit (Q170DBATC).
It is packed together with Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1).
(Note-2): Q172DEX cannot be used in the extension base unit.
Install it to the main base unit.
(Note-3): Q173DCPU-S1/Q172DCPU-S1 only.
1 - 12
1 OVERVIEW
(2) Peripheral device configuration for the Q173D(S)CPU/
Q172D(S)CPU
The following (a)(b)(c) can be used.
(a) USB configuration
(b) RS-232 configuration
(c) Ethernet configuration
PLC CPU module
(QnUD(E)(H)CPU/QnUDVCPU)
PLC CPU module
(QnUD(H)CPU)
Motion CPU module
(Q17 DSCPU/Q17 DCPU-S1)
PLC CPU module
(QnUDE(H)CPU/QnUDVCPU)
USB cable
RS-232 communication cable
(QC30R2)
Ethernet cable (Note-1)
Personal computer
Personal computer
Personal computer
(Note-1): Corresponding Ethernet cables
1) Connecting to Motion CPU module
Part name
Connection type
Connection with HUB
Cable type
Straight cable
Ethernet cable
Direct connection
Crossover cable
Ethernet standard
Specification
10BASE-T
100BASE-TX
10BASE-T
Compliant with Ethernet standards, category 5 or higher.
• Shielded twisted pair cable (STP cable)
100BASE-TX
[Selection criterion of cable]
• Category
: 5 or higher
• Diameter of lead : AWG26 or higher
• Shield
: Copper braid shield and drain wire
Copper braid shield and aluminium layered type shield
2) Connecting to PLC CPU module
Refer to the "QnUCPU User's Manual (Communication via Built-in
Ethernet Port)".
1 - 13
1 OVERVIEW
1.3.2 Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU System overall configuration
Q61P
QnUD
CPU
Panel personal
computer
Q17 DS
CPU
QI60
QX
QY
100/200VAC
Manual pulse
generator
interface module
PLC CPU/
Motion CPU
Synchronous
encoder
interface module
Main base unit
(Q3 DB)
Intelligent
function module
PERIPHERAL I/F
Servo external
signals
interface module
Motion CPU control module
Q6 AD Q172D Q172D Q173D
LX
EX
PX
/
Q6 DA
Manual pulse generator
(MR-HDP01)
P
USB/RS-232/
Ethernet (Note-1)
I/O module/
Intelligent function
module
3/module
Serial absolute synchronous encoder cable
(Q170ENCCBL M)
E
Personal Computer
IBM PC/AT
Battery (Q6BAT)
Serial absolute synchronous encoder
(Q171ENC-W8)
2/module
External input signals
Number of Inputs
FLS
: Upper stroke limit
RLS
: Lower stroke limit
STOP
: Stop signal
DOG/CHANGE : Proximity dog/Speed-position switching
8 axes/module
Analogue input/output
Forced stop input cable
(Q170DEMICBL M)
Input/output (Up to 256 points)
EMI forced stop input (24VDC)
External input signals
Extension base unit
(Q6 B)
Power supply
module
Interrupt signals (16 points)
P
Extension
cable
(QC B) UP to 7 extensions
Line 2
SSCNET (/H)
(CN2)
Manual pulse generator/
Incremental synchronous encoder
1/module
Upper stroke limit
Lower stroke limit
STOP signal
Proximity dog/Speed-position switching
Input signal/Mark detection input signal (4 points)
SSCNET cable
(MR-J3BUS M(-A/-B))
d16
d01
Line 1
SSCNET (/H)
(CN1)
d01
d16
L61P LJ72MS15
M
M
M
M
E
E
E
E
Serial absolute
synchronous
encoder cable
(Q170ENCCBL M-A)
E
Serial absolute synchronous
encoder (Note-2)
(Q171ENC-W8)
MR-J3(W)- B/MR-J4(W)- B model Servo amplifier
Q173DSCPU: 2 lines (Up to 32 axes (Up to 16 axes/line))
Q172DSCPU: 1 line (Up to 16axes)
External input signals of servo amplifier
Proximity dog/Speed-position switching
Upper stroke limit
Lower stroke limit
L61P LJ72MS15
I/O module/
Intelligent function
module
I/O module/
Intelligent function
module
MELSEC-L series SSCNET /H head module
(LJ72MS15)
Q173DSCPU: 2 lines (Up to 8 stations (Up to 4 stations/line))
Q172DSCPU: 1 line (Up to 4 stations)
(Note-1): QnUDE(H)CPU/QnUDVCPU only
(Note-2): MR-J4- B-RJ only
1 - 14
1 OVERVIEW
CAUTION
Construct a safety circuit externally of the Motion controller or servo amplifier if the abnormal
operation of the Motion controller or servo amplifier differ from the safety directive operation in
the system.
The ratings and characteristics of the parts (other than Motion controller, servo amplifier and
servomotor) used in a system must be compatible with the Motion controller, servo amplifier and
servomotor.
Set the parameter values to those that are compatible with the Motion controller, servo amplifier,
servomotor and regenerative resistor model and the system application. The protective functions
may not function if the settings are incorrect.
1 - 15
1 OVERVIEW
1.3.3 Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1) System overall configuration
Q61P
QnUD
CPU
Q17 D
CPU
QI60
QX
/
QY
Manual pulse
generator
interface module
(Note-1)
Synchronous
encoder
interface module
PLC CPU/
Motion CPU
Main base unit
PERIPHERAL I/F (Q3 DB)
Panel personal
computer
Servo external
signals
interface module
Motion CPU control module
Q6 AD Q172D Q172D Q173D
PX
/
LX
EX
Q6 DA
I/O module/
Intelligent function module
100/200VAC
P
USB/RS-232/
Ethernet (Note-2)
3/module
Serial absolute synchronous encoder cable
(Q170ENCCBL M)
E
Personal Computer
IBM PC/AT
Battery holder unit
Q170DBATC
Forced stop input cable
(Q170DEMICBL M)
EMI forced stop input (24VDC)
Manual pulse generator
(MR-HDP01)
Serial absolute synchronous encoder
(Q170ENC)
2/module
External input signals
Number of Inputs
FLS
: Upper stroke limit
RLS
: Lower stroke limit
STOP
: Stop signal
DOG/CHANGE : Proximity dog/Speed-position switching
8 axes/module
Analogue input/output
Input/output (Up to 256 points)
Interrupt signals (16 points)
Power supply
module
Extension base unit
(Q6 B)
Extension
cable
(QC B) UP to 7 extensions
SSCNET cable
(MR-J3BUS M(-A/-B))
Line 2 SSCNET
Line 1 SSCNET
d01
(CN2)
(CN1)
d16
d01
d16
M
M
M
M
E
E
E
E
MR-J3(W)- B model Servo amplifier
Q173DCPU(-S1): 2 lines (Up to 32 axes (Up to 16 axes/line))
Q172DCPU(-S1): 1 line (Up to 8 axes)
External input signals of servo amplifier
Proximity dog/Speed-position switching
Upper stroke limit
Lower stroke limit
(Note-1): Q173DCPU-S1/Q172DCPU-S1 only
(Note-2): QnUDE(H)CPU/QnUDVCPU only
CAUTION
Construct a safety circuit externally of the Motion controller or servo amplifier if the abnormal
operation of the Motion controller or servo amplifier differ from the safety directive operation in
the system.
The ratings and characteristics of the parts (other than Motion controller, servo amplifier and
servomotor) used in a system must be compatible with the Motion controller, servo amplifier and
servomotor.
Set the parameter values to those that are compatible with the Motion controller, servo amplifier,
servomotor and regenerative resistor model and the system application. The protective functions
may not function if the settings are incorrect.
1 - 16
1 OVERVIEW
1.3.4 Software packages
(1) Operating system software
Application
Q173DSCPU
(Note-1)
Software package
Q172DSCPU
(Note-1)
Q173DCPU(-S1)
Q172DCPU(-S1)
Conveyor assembly use SV13
SW8DNC-SV13QJ
SW8DNC-SV13QL
SW8DNC-SV13QB
SW8DNC-SV13QD
Automatic machinery use SV22
SW8DNC-SV22QJ
SW8DNC-SV22QL
SW8DNC-SV22QA
SW8DNC-SV22QC
—
—
SW7DNC-SV43QA
SW7DNC-SV43QC
Machine tool peripheral use SV43
(Note-1): The operating system software (SV22 (Virtual mode switching method)) is installed
at the time of product purchases.
(2) Operating system software type/version
(a) Confirmation method in the operating system (CD)
1)
2)
3)
1) Operating system software type
2) Operating system software version
3) Serial number
Example) When using Q173DCPU, SV22 and version 00B.
1) SW8DNC-SV22QA
2) 00B
(b) Confirmation method in MT Developer2
The operating system software type and version of connected CPU can be
confirmed on the following screens.
1) Installation screen
2) CPU information screen displayed by menu bar [Help] [CPU
Information]
(OS software)
S
V
2
2
A or B : Q173DCPU(-S1)
C or D : Q172DCPU(-S1)
J or L : Q173DSCPU
Q172DSCPU
Q
A
V
E
R
3
0
0
B
OS version
3: Motion SFC compatibility
. : Motion SFC not compatibility
(3) Programming software packages
(a) Motion controller engineering environment
Part name
Model name
MELSOFT MT Works2
(Note-1)
)
(MT Developer2
SW1DNC-MTW2-E
(Note-1): This software is included in Motion controller engineering environment "MELSOFT MT Works2".
1 - 17
1 OVERVIEW
(4) Related software packages
(a) PLC software package
Model name
Software package
GX Works2
SW1DNC-GXW2-E
GX Developer
SW8D5C-GPPW-E
(b) Servo set up software package
Model name
Software package
MR Configurator2
SW1DNC-MRC2-E
MR Configurator
MRZJW3-SETUP221E
(Note-1)
(Note-1): Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU is not supported.
POINTS
When the operation of Windows is unclear in the operation of this software, refer
R
to the manual of Windows or guide-book from the other supplier.
R
1 - 18
1 OVERVIEW
1.3.5 Restrictions on motion systems
(1) Combination of Multiple CPU system
(a) Motion CPU module cannot be used as standalone module.
Be sure to install the universal model PLC CPU module to CPU No.1.
For Universal model PLC CPU module, "Multiple CPU high speed
transmission function" must be set in the Multiple CPU settings.
(b) Only Multiple CPU high speed main base unit (Q35DB/Q38DB/Q312DB)
can be used.
(c) The combination of Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU/Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1) and Q173HCPU(-T)/Q172HCPU(-T)/Q173CPUN(-T)/
Q172CPUN(-T) cannot be used.
The combination of Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU/Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1) can be used.
(d) Up to four modules of universal model PLC CPU modules/Motion CPU
modules can be installed from the CPU slot (the slot on the right side of
power supply module) to slot 2 of the main base unit. CPU modules called
as CPU No.1 to CPU No.4 from the left sequentially.
There is no restriction on the installation order of CPU No.2 to No.4.
For CPU module except CPU No.1, an empty slot can be reserved for
addition of CPU module. An empty slot can be set between CPU modules.
However, the installation condition when combining with the High
performance PLC CPU module/Process CPU module/PC CPU module/
C controller module is different depending on the specification of CPU
modules, refer to the Manuals of each CPU modules.
(e) It takes about 10 seconds to startup (state that can be controlled) of Motion
CPU. Make a Multiple CPU synchronous startup setting suitable for the
system.
(f) Execute the automatic refresh of the Motion CPU modules and universal
model PLC CPU modules by using the automatic refresh of Multiple CPU
high speed transmission area setting.
When the High performance PLC CPU module/Process CPU module/PC
CPU module/C controller module is installed in the combination of Multiple
CPU system, the Motion CPU module cannot be execute the automatic
refresh with these modules.
(g) Use the Motion dedicated PLC instructions that starts by "D(P).". The Motion
dedicated PLC instructions that starts by "S(P)." cannot be used. When the
High performance PLC CPU module/Process CPU module/PC CPU
module/C controller module is installed in the combination of Multiple CPU
system, the Motion dedicated PLC instruction from these modules cannot be
executed.
1 - 19
1 OVERVIEW
(2) Motion modules
(Note-1)
(a) Installation position of Q172DEX
and Q173DSXY is only the main base
unit.
It cannot be used on the extension base unit.
(b) Q172DLX/Q173DPX can be installed on any of the main base unit/
extension base unit.
(Note-1)
/Q173DPX cannot be installed in CPU slot and I/O
(c) Q172DLX/Q172DEX
slot 0 to 2 of the main base unit. Wrong installation might damage the main
base unit.
(d) Q173DSXY cannot be used in Q173DCPU/Q172DCPU.
(e) Q172EX(-S1/-S2/-S3)/Q172LX/Q173PX(-S1) for Q173HCPU(-T)/
Q172HCPU(-T)/Q173CPUN(-T)/Q172CPUN(-T)/Q173CPU/Q172CPU
cannot be used.
(f) Be sure to use the Motion CPU as the control CPU of Motion modules
(Note-1)
(Q172DLX, Q172DEX
, Q173DPX, etc.) for Motion CPU. They will not
operate correctly if PLC CPU is set and installed as the control CPU by
mistake. Motion CPU is treated as a 32-point intelligent module by PLC CPU
of other CPU.
(g) Q173DSXY is managed with PLC CPU.
The Motion CPU to connect Q173DSXY is only CPU No.2 in the Multiple
CPU system. Q173DSXY cannot be used for the CPU No. 3 or 4.
(Note-1): Q172DEX can be used in SV22. It cannot be used in SV13/SV43.
1 - 20
1 OVERVIEW
(3) Other restrictions
(a) Motion CPU module cannot be set as the control CPU of intelligent function
module (excluding some modules) or Graphic Operation Terminal(GOT).
(b) Be sure to use the battery.
(c) There are following methods to execute the forced stop input.
• Use a EMI connector of Motion CPU module
• Use a device set in the forced stop input setting of system setting
(d) Forced stop input for EMI connector of Motion CPU module cannot be
invalidated by the parameter.
When the device set in the forced stop input setting is used without use of
EMI connector of Motion CPU module, apply 24VDC voltage on EMI
connector and invalidate the forced stop input of EMI connector.
(e) Be sure to use the cable for forced stop input (sold separately). The forced
stop cannot be released without using it.
(f) Set "SSCNET /H" or "SSCNET " for every line in the SSCNET setting of
system setting to communicate with the servo amplifiers.
MR-J4(W)- B can be used by setting "SSCNET /H", and MR-J3(W)- B
can be used by setting "SSCNET ". QDS
(g) There are the following restrictions when "SSCCNET " is set as
communication method.
When the operation cycle is 0.2[ms], set the system setting and the axis
select rotary switch of servo amplifier to "0 to 3".
If the axis select rotary switch of servo amplifier is set to "4 to F", the servo
amplifiers are not recognized. QDS
When the operation cycle is 0.4[ms], set the system setting and the axis
select rotary switch of servo amplifier to "0 to 7".
If the axis select rotary switch of servo amplifier is set to "8 to F", the servo
amplifiers are not recognized.
There is no restriction when "SSCNET /H" is set in the SSCNET setting.
(Note): The setting of axis select rotary switch differs according to the servo
amplifier. Refer to the "Servo amplifier Instruction Manual" for details.
(h) Maximum number of control axes of servo amplifier is shown below.
• Operation cycle is 0.2[ms]: 4 axes per line
• Operation cycle is 0.4[ms]: 8 axes per line
There is no restriction when "SSCNET /H" is set in the SSCNET setting.
QDS
(i) When the operation cycle is "default setting", the operation cycle is set
depending on the number of axes used. However, when "SSCNET " is set
in the SSCNET communication setting and the number of axes used of
servo amplifier is 9 axes or more per line, the operation cycle of 0.8 [ms] or
more is set. (Refer to Section 1.2.2.) QDS
1 - 21
1 OVERVIEW
(j) MR-J4W3- B (Software version "A2" or before) and MR-J3W- B does not
support operation cycle 0.2 [ms]. Set 0.4[ms] or more as operation cycle to
use MR-J4W3- B (Software version "A2" or before) and MR-J3W- B.
QDS
MR-J4W3- B (Software version "A3" or later) supports operation cycle 0.2
[ms]. However, when using operation cycle 0.2 [ms], some functions are
restricted. Refer to the "Servo amplifier Instruction Manual" for details.
(k) If there is an axis which is not set at least 1 axis by system setting in
applicable servo amplifier at MR-J4W- B use, all axes connected to
applicable servo amplifier and subsequent servo amplifiers cannot be
connected. Set "Not used" to the applicable axis with a dip switch for the
axis which is not used by MR-J4W- B. QDS
(l) It is impossible to mount the main base unit by DIN rail when using the
Motion CPU module.
Doing so could result in vibration that may cause erroneous operation.
(m) The module name displayed by "System monitor" - "Product information list"
of GX Works2/GX Developer is different depending on the function version
of Motion modules (Q172DLX, Q172DEX, Q173DPX).
(Note): Even if the function version "C" is displayed, it does not correspond
to the online module change.
Model display
Module name
Function version "B"
Function version "C"
Q172DLX
Q172LX
Q172DLX
Q172DEX
MOTION-UNIT
Q172DEX
Q173DPX
MOTION-UNIT
Q173DPX
(n) Use the Graphic Operation Terminal (GOT) that supports Motion CPU
(Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU).
(Refer to the "GOT1000 Series Connection Manual (Mitsubishi Products)".)
1 - 22
1 OVERVIEW
1.4 Checking Serial Number and Operating System Software Version
Checking for the serial number of Motion CPU module and Motion module, and the
operating system software version are shown below.
1.4.1 Checking serial number
(1) Motion CPU module (Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU)
(a) Rating plate
The rating plate is situated on the side face of the Motion CPU module.
(b) Front of Motion CPU module
The serial number is printed in the projection parts forward of the lower side
of Motion CPU module.
Q173DSCPU
CD
AB E
789
CD
AB E
F01
45
23 6
45
23 6
F01
789
1
SW
2
MITSUBISHI
STOP RUN
PASSED
MOTION CONTROLLER
MODEL
PERIPHERAL I/F
EMI
Q173DSCPU
SERIAL
C
UL
80M1
US LISTED
IND. CONT.EQ.
5VDC
N2X234999
1.75A
Serial number
KCC-REI-MEKTC510A792G61
DATE:2011-11
EXT.I/F
CN1
Rating plate
MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC CORPORATION
MADE IN JAPAN
CN2
See Q173DSCPU Instruction manual.
PULL
FRONT
RIO
Serial number
N2X234999
(c) System monitor (product information list)
The serial number can be checked on the system monitor screen in
GX Works2/GX Developer. (Refer to Section 1.4.2.)
1 - 23
1 OVERVIEW
(2) Motion CPU module (Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1))
(a) Rating plate
The rating plate is situated on the side face of the Motion CPU module.
(b) Front of Motion CPU module
The serial number is printed in the projection parts forward of the lower side
of Motion CPU module.
Q173DCPU-S1
CD
AB E
789
CD
AB E
F01
45
23 6
45
23 6
F01
789
1
SW
2
STOP RUN
CAUTION
PERIPHERAL I/F
EMI
MITSUBISHI
MOTION CONTROLLER PASSED
Q173DCPU-S1
MODEL
0026924699D0
SERIAL
C
UL
M16349999
80M1
US LISTED
5VDC 1.30A
Rating plate
Serial number
IND. CONT. EQ.
MADE IN JAPAN
MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC CORPORATION
CN1
See Q173DCPU-S1 Instru ction manua l.
DATE:2011-06
CN2
KCC-REI-MEK-TC510A692051
Serial number
FRONT
BAT
RIO
M16349999
(c) System monitor (product information list)
The serial number can be checked on the system monitor screen in
GX Works2/GX Developer. (Refer to Section 1.4.2.)
REMARK
The serial number display was corresponded from the Motion CPU modules
manufactured in early October 2007.
1 - 24
1 OVERVIEW
(3) Motion module (Q172DLX/Q172DEX/Q173DPX/Q173DSXY)
(a) Rating plate
The rating plate is situated on the side face of the Motion module.
(b) Front of Motion module
The serial No. is printed in the projection parts forward of the lower side of
Motion module.
Q172DLX
MITSUBISHI
PASSED
MOTION I/F UNIT
MODEL Q172DLX
24VDC 0.16A
5VDC 0.06A
SERIAL
C16054999
DATE 2011-06
80M1 IND. CONT. EQ.
UL US LISTED
C
MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC CORPORATION
MADE IN JAPAN
BC370C224H01
Se e Q1 72DLX I nstruction man ual .
CTRL
KCC-REI-MEKTC510A646G51
Q172DLX
Serial number
C16054999
REMARK
The serial number display was corresponded from the Motion modules
manufactured in early April 2008.
1 - 25
Rating plate
Serial number
1 OVERVIEW
1.4.2 Checking operating system software version
Ver.!
The operating system software version can be checked on the system monitor screen
in GX Works2/GX Developer.
Select [Product Information List] button on the system monitor screen displayed on
[Diagnostics] – [System monitor] of GX Works2/GX Developer.
Serial number of
Motion CPU module
Operating system software version
<Screen: GX Works2>
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
1 - 26
1 OVERVIEW
REMARK
(1) "Serial number of Motion CPU module" and "Operating system software
version" on the system monitor (Product Information List) screen of
GX Works2/GX Developer was corresponded from the Motion CPU modules
manufactured in early October 2007.
(2) The operating system software version can also be checked on the system
monitor screen in CD-ROM of operating system software or MT Developer2.
(Refer to Section 1.3.4.)
1 - 27
1 OVERVIEW
1.5 Restrictions by the Software's Version
There are restrictions in the function that can be used by the version of the operating
system software and programming software.
The combination of each version and a function is shown in Table1.1.
Table 1.1 Restrictions by the Software's Version
Operating system software version
Function
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
(Note-1), (Note-2)
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
SV13/SV22
SV13/SV22
SV43
Checking Motion controller's serial number and operating
system software version in GX Developer
—
00D
—
Advanced S-curve acceleration/deceleration
(Except constant-speed control (CPSTART) of servo
program.)
—
00H
Direct drive servo
MR-J3- B-RJ080W
—
00H
00B
00B
Servo amplifier display servo error code (#8008+20n)
—
00H
0.44ms fixed-cycle event task
—
00H
444μs coasting timer (SD720, SD721)
—
00H
Synchronous encoder current value monitor in real mode
—
00H
Display of the past ten times history in current value history
monitor
—
00H
Amplifier-less operation
—
00H
Servo instruction (Home position return (ZERO), high
speed oscillation (OSC)) and manual pulse generator
operation in mixed function of virtual mode/real mode
—
00H
Advanced S-curve acceleration/deceleration in constantspeed control (CPSTART) of servo program.
—
00K
External input signal (DOG) of servo amplifier in home
position return of count type and speed/position switching
control
—
00G
00B
Communication via PERIPHERAL I/F
—
00H
00C
Motion SFC operation control instruction
Type conversion (DFLT, SFLT)
—
00L
—
Vision system dedicated function (MVOPEN, MVLOAD,
MVTRG, MVPST, MVIN, MVFIN, MVCLOSE, MVCOM)
—
00L
Home position return of scale home position signal
detection type
—
00L
00C
Real time display function in digital oscilloscope function
—
00N
Not support
1 - 28
00B
00C
1 OVERVIEW
Programming software version
MELSOFT MT Works2 (MT Developer2)
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
Section of reference
MR Configurator2
MR Configurator
—
—
Section 1.4
—
—
(Note-4)
SV13/SV22
SV13/SV22
SV43
—
—
—
1.39R
1.06G
1.39R
1.06G
1.06G
1.01B
C2
—
—
—
—
—
(Note-4), (Note-5)
1.39R
1.06G
—
—
(Note-3)
—
—
—
—
1.39R
1.06G
—
—
—
—
APPENDIX 1.2
—
—
(Note-5)
—
—
Section 4.2
—
—
—
Section 4.11
1.39R
1.09K
—
—
(Note-5)
1.39R
1.09K
—
—
(Note-4)
1.39R
1.15R
Not support
—
—
1.39R
1.15R
Not support
—
—
Section 4.13
1.39R
1.15R
—
—
—
(Note-3)
1.39R
1.15R
—
—
(Note-3)
1.39R
1.15R
Not support
—
—
(Note-4)
1.39R
1.17T
Not support
—
—
Not support
—: There is no restriction by the version.
(Note-1): SV13/SV22 is the completely same version.
(Note-2): The operating system software version can be confirmed in the operating system software (CD-ROM), MT Developer2 or
GX Works2/GX Developer. (Refer to Section 1.3, 1.4.)
(Note-3): Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller (SV13/SV22) Programming Manual (Motion SFC)
(Note-4): Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller (SV13/SV22) Programming Manual (REAL MODE)
(Note-5): Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller (SV22) Programming Manual (VIRTUAL MODE)
(Note-6): Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller Programming Manual (Safety Observation)
(Note-7): Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU Motion controller (SV22) Programming Manual (Advanced Synchronous Control)
1 - 29
1 OVERVIEW
Table 1.1 Restrictions by the Software's Version (continued)
Operating system software version
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
Function
(Note-1), (Note-2)
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
SV13/SV22
SV13/SV22
Rapid stop deceleration time setting error invalid function
—
00S
Vision system dedicated function (MVOUT)
—
00S
Motion SFC operation control instruction
Program control (IF - ELSE - IEND, SELECT -CASE SEND, FOR -NEXT, BREAK)
—
00R
Display format depending on the error setting data
information of motion error history device (#8640 to #8735)
—
00S
Product information list device (#8736 to #8751)
—
00S
Safety observation function
—
00S
Feed current value update command (M3212+20n) valid in
speed control ( )
00B
Not support
External forced stop input ON latch (SM506)
00B
00S
Operation method (SD560)
00B
Not support
Advanced synchronous control
00B
Not support
Limit switch output function expansion
00B
Not support
Driver communication function (SSCNET )
00C
Not support
Intelligent function module support
00C
Not support
SSCNET /H head module connection
00C
Not support
Cam auto-generation (CAMMK) easy stroke ratio cam
00C
Not support
Acceleration/deceleration time change function
00C
Not support
Home position return of dogless home position signal
reference type
00C
Not support
Setting range expansion of backlash compensation
amount
00C
Not support
Multiple CPU synchronous control
00C
Not support
Cam axis length per cycle change during synchronous
control
00C
Not support
—
00L
00D
Not support
Servo driver VC series
manufactured by Nikki Denso Co., Ltd.
SSCNET
SSCNET /H
Inverter FR-A700 series
—
—
Synchronous encoder via servo amplifier
00D
Not support
Driver communication function (SSCNET /H)
00D
Not support
1 - 30
SV43
1 OVERVIEW
Programming software version
MELSOFT MT Works2 (MT Developer2)
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
SV13/SV22
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
SV13/SV22
MR Configurator2
MR Configurator
Section of reference
SV43
—
—
—
—
(Note-4)
1.39R
1.39R
—
—
(Note-3)
1.39R
1.39R
—
—
(Note-3)
—
—
—
—
(Note-3)
—
—
—
—
(Note-4), (Note-5)
1.39R
1.39R
—
—
(Note-6)
—
Not support
—
—
(Note-4)
—
—
—
—
APPENDIX 1.1
—
Not support
—
—
APPENDIX 1.2
1.47Z
Not support
—
—
(Note-7)
1.47Z
Not support
—
—
Section 4.1.3
Section 4.1.4
—
Not support
—
—
Section 4.16
1.56J
Not support
—
—
Section 4.17
1.56J
Not support
—
—
Section 4.18
1.56J
Not support
—
—
(Note-3)
1.56J
Not support
—
—
(Note-4)
1.56J
Not support
—
—
(Note-4)
1.56J
Not support
—
—
(Note-4)
1.56J
Not support
—
—
(Note-7)
1.56J
Not support
—
—
(Note-7)
1.34L
1.15R
—
—
(Note-4)
1.56J
Not support
—
—
(Note-4)
1.34L
1.15R
—
—
(Note-4)
1.68W
Not support
—
Not support
(Note-7)
1.68W
Not support
—
Not support
Section 4.16
—: There is no restriction by the version.
(Note-1): SV13/SV22 is the completely same version.
(Note-2): The operating system software version can be confirmed in the operating system software (CD-ROM), MT Developer2 or
GX Works2/GX Developer. (Refer to Section 1.3, 1.4.)
(Note-3): Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller (SV13/SV22) Programming Manual (Motion SFC)
(Note-4): Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller (SV13/SV22) Programming Manual (REAL MODE)
(Note-5): Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller (SV22) Programming Manual (VIRTUAL MODE)
(Note-6): Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller Programming Manual (Safety Observation)
(Note-7): Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU Motion controller (SV22) Programming Manual (Advanced Synchronous Control)
1 - 31
1 OVERVIEW
1.6 Programming Software Version
The programming software versions that support Motion CPU are shown below.
Motion CPU
MELSOFT MT Works2 (MT Developer2)
SV13/SV22
Q173DSCPU
1.39R
Q172DSCPU
1.39R
Q173DCPU-S1
1.00A
Q172DCPU-S1
1.00A
SV43
(Note-1)
(Note-1)
(Note-2)
(Note-2)
1.03D
1.03D
(Note-3)
(Note-3)
MR Configurator2
MR Configurator
1.10L
Not support
1.10L
Not support
1.00A
C0
1.00A
C0
Q173DCPU
1.00A
1.03D
1.00A
C0
Q172DCPU
1.00A
1.03D
1.00A
C0
(Note-4)
(Note-4)
(Note-4)
(Note-4)
(Note-1): Use version 1.47Z or later to use advanced synchronous control method.
(Note-2): Use version 1.12N or later to communicate via PERIPHERAL I/F.
(Note-3): Use version 1.23Z or later to communicate via PERIPHERAL I/F.
(Note-4): Use version C1 or later to use MR Configurator combination with MT Developer2.
1 - 32
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
2. MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
2.1 Multiple CPU System
2.1.1 Overview
(1) What is Multiple CPU system ?
A Multiple CPU system is a system in which more than one PLC CPU module
and Motion CPU module (up to 4 modules) are mounted on several main base
unit in order to control the I/O modules and intelligent function modules.
Each Motion CPU controls the servo amplifiers connected by SSCNET cable.
(2) System configuration based on load distribution
(a) By distributing such tasks as servo control, machine control and information
control among multiple processors, the flexible system configuration can be
realized.
(b) You can increase the number of control axes by using a multiple Motion
CPU modules.
It is possible to control up to 96 axes by using the three CPU modules
(Q173DSCPU/Q173DCPU(-S1)).
(c) By distributing the high-load processing performed on a single PLC CPU
over several CPU modules, it is possible to reduce the overall system PLC
scan time.
(3) Communication between CPUs in the Multiple CPU system
(a) Since device data of other CPUs can be automatically read by the automatic
refresh function, the self CPU can also use them as those of self CPU.
(Note): When the High performance PLC CPU module/Process CPU
module/PC CPU module/C controller module is mounted in the
combination of Multiple CPU system, the Motion dedicated PLC
instruction from these modules cannot be executed.
(b) Motion dedicated PLC instructions can be used to access device data from
the PLC CPU to Motion CPU and start Motion SFC program (SV13/SV22)/
Motion program (SV43).
2-1
2
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
2.1.2 Installation position of CPU module
Up to four PLC CPUs and Motion CPUs can be installed from the CPU slot (the right
side slot of the power supply module) to slots 2 of the main base unit.
The Motion CPU module cannot be installed in the CPU slot.
The PLC CPU module must be installed in the CPU slot (CPU No.1) in the Multiple
CPU system.
There is no restriction on the installation order for CPU modules (CPU No.2 to 4).
The combination of Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU and Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1) can be used.
(Note): Refer to the manual for each CPU module when the High performance PLC
CPU module, Process CPU module, PC CPU module and C controller module
is mounted in the combination of Multiple CPU.
Table 2.1 Example for CPU module installation
Number
of CPUs
Installation position of CPU module
CPU
Power
supply
QnUD
CPU
0
1
2
Q17 D(S)
CPU
2
——
Power
supply
CPU
No.1
CPU
No.2
CPU
No.3
CPU
No.4
CPU
0
1
2
QnUD
CPU
CPU
Q17 D(S) QnUD
CPU
CPU
Power
supply
0
QnUD
CPU
——
1
2
Q17 D(S) Q17 D(S)
CPU
CPU
3
——
CPU
No.1
CPU
Power
supply
QnUD
CPU
CPU
No.2
CPU
No.3
0
1
Q17 D(S) QnUD
CPU
CPU
CPU
No.4
CPU
No.1
2
CPU
CPU
empty
Power
supply
QnUD
CPU
CPU
No.2
CPU
No.3
CPU
No.4
0
1
2
Q17 D(S) Q17 D(S) QnUD
CPU
CPU
CPU
CPU
QnUD
CPU
Power
supply
0
1
2
Q17 D(S) Q17 D(S) Q17 D(S)
CPU
CPU
CPU
4
CPU
No.1
CPU
No.2
CPU
No.3
CPU
No.4
CPU
No.1
CPU
No.2
CPU
No.3
CPU
No.4
CPU
CPU
No.1
CPU
No.2
CPU
No.3
0
1
2
CPU
No.4
: Slot number
An empty slot can be reserved for future addition of a CPU module.
Set the number of CPU modules including empty slots in the Multiple CPU setting, and
set the type of the slots to be emptied to "PLC (Empty)" in the CPU setting.
(Example 1)
CPU
Power
supply
QnUD
CPU
CPU
No.1
(Example 2)
0
1
CPU
empty
Q17 D(S)
CPU
CPU
No.2
CPU
No.3
2
CPU
Power
supply
CPU
No.4
QnUD
CPU
CPU
No.1
(Example 3)
0
1
2
CPU
empty
Q17 D(S)
CPU
CPU
empty
CPU
No.2
CPU
No.3
CPU
No.4
2-2
CPU
Power
supply
QnUD
CPU
CPU
No.1
0
1
2
CPU
empty
CPU
empty
Q17 D(S)
CPU
CPU
No.2
CPU
No.3
CPU
No.4
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
2.1.3 Precautions for using I/O modules and intelligent function modules
(1) Modules controllable by the Motion CPU
Modules controllable by the Motion CPU are shown below.
• Motion modules (Q172DLX, Q172DEX, Q173DPX)
• I/O modules (QX , QX - , QY , QY - , QH , QX Y )
(Note-1)
• Intelligent function module
• Interrupt module (QI60)
(Note-1): Refer to Section 4.17 for corresponding intelligent function module.
(2) Compatibility with the Multiple CPU system
The intelligent function modules of function version "B" or later support the
Multiple CPU system. Be sure to use the PLC CPU as a control CPU for the
intelligent function modules (network modules etc.) that cannot be controlled by
the Motion CPU.
(3) Access range from non-controlled CPU
(a) The Motion CPU can access only the modules controlled by the self CPU. It
cannot access the modules controlled by other CPUs.
(b) Access range from non-controlled PLC CPU for the modules controlled by
the Motion CPU are shown below.
Table 2.2 Access range to non-controlled module
I/O setting outside of the group (Set by PLC CPU)
Access target
Disabled (Not checked)
Enabled (Checked)
Input (X)
Output (Y)
Buffer memory
Read
Write
: Accessible
: Inaccessible
REMARK
• The function version of an intelligent function module can be checked on the rated
plate of the intelligent function module or in the GX Works2/GX Developer system
monitor product information list.
• Refer to the "Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller User's Manual" for
the model name which can be controlled by the Motion CPU.
2-3
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
2.1.4 Modules subject to installation restrictions
(1) Modules subject to install restrictions for the Motion CPU are sown below. Use
within the restrictions listed below.
(a) SV13/SV22
Description
Servo external signals
interface module
Model name
Q172DLX
Maximum installable modules per CPU
Q173DSCPU
Q172DSCPU
4 modules
2 modules
Serial absolute synchronous
(Note-2)
Q172DEX
interface module
Manual pulse generator
interface module
Q173DPX
(Note-1)
QX
QX -
Output module
QY
QY -
Input/output composite
module
QH
QX Y
(Note-3)
(Note-2)
4 modules
1 module
6 modules
4 modules
4 modules
3 modules
Manual pulse
generator only use
Input module
Intelligent
function
module
Incremental serial
encoder use
Q173DCPU(-S1) Q172DCPU(-S1)
1 module
Total 256 points
Total 256 points
(Note-5)
Analogue input Q6 AD
module
Q6 ADAnalogue
output module
Q6 DA
Q6 DA-
General
Interrupt module
(Note-4)
—
QI60
1 module
(Note-1): When the Manual pulse generator and the serial encoder are used at the same time with the SV22, the Q173DPX installed in the
slot of the smallest number is used for manual pulse generator input.
(Note-2): SV22 only.
(Note-3): A maximum of 4 intelligent function modules can be used.
(Note-4): Refer to Section 4.17 for corresponding intelligent function module.
(Note-5): Number of I/O points is total of "Built-in interface in Motion CPU (Input 4 points) + I/O module + intelligent function module".
2-4
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
(b) SV43
Description
Servo external signals
interface module
Q172DLX
Manual pulse generator
interface module
Q173DPX
Input module
QX
QX -
Output module
QY
QY -
Input/output
composite module
QH
QX Y
Intelligent
function
module
(Note-1)
Maximum installable modules per CPU
Model name
Manual pulse
generator only use
Q173DCPU(-S1)
Q172DCPU(-S1)
4 modules
1 module
1 module
1 module
Total 256 points
Analogue input Q6 AD
Q6 ADmodule
Analogue
output module
Q6 DA
Q6 DA-
(Note-1): A maximum of 4 intelligent function modules can be used.
(2) A total of eight base units including one main base unit and seven extension base
units can be used. However, the usable slots (number of modules) are limited to
64 per system including empty slots. If a module is installed in slot 65 or
subsequent slot, an error (SP. UNIT LAY ERROR) will occur. Make sure all
modules are installed in slots 1 to 64. (Even when the total number of slots
provided by the main base unit and extension base units exceeds 65 (such as
when six 12-slot base units are used), an error does not occur as long as the
modules are installed within slots 1 to 64.)
POINT
(1) Q172DLX/Q172DEX/Q173DPX cannot be installed in CPU slot and I/O slot 0
to 2 of the main base unit. Wrong installation might damage the main base
unit.
(2) Q172DEX can be installed in the main base unit only. It cannot be used in the
extension base unit.
2-5
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
2.1.5 How to reset the Multiple CPU system
The entire Multiple CPU system can be reset by resetting CPU No.1.
The CPU modules of No.2 to No.4, I/O modules and intelligent function modules will be
reset when PLC CPU No.1 is reset.
If a stop error occurs in any of the CPUs on the Multiple CPU system, either reset CPU
No.1 or restart the Multiple CPU system (power supply ON OFF ON) for recovery.
(Recovery is not allowed by resetting the error-stopped CPU modules other than CPU
No.1.)
POINT
(1) It is not possible to reset the CPU modules of No.2 to No.4 individually in the
Multiple CPU system.
If an attempt to reset any of those PLC CPU modules during operation of the
Multiple CPU system, a "MULTI CPU DOWN (error code: 7000)" error will
occur for the other CPUs, and the entire Multiple CPU system will be halted.
However, depending on the timing in which any of PLC CPU modules other
than No.1 has been reset, an error other than the "MULTI CPU DOWN" may
halt the other PLC CPUs/Motion CPUs.
(2) A "MULTI CPU DOWN (error code: 7000)" error will occur regardless of the
operation mode (All stop by stop error of CPU "n"/continue) set at the "Multiple
CPU setting" screen when any of PLC CPU modules of No.2 to No.4 is reset.
(Refer to Section 2.1.6.)
2-6
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
2.1.6 Operation for CPU module stop error
The entire system will behaves differently depending whether a stop error occurs in
CPU No.1 or any of CPU No.2 to No.4 in the Multiple CPU system.
(1) When a stop error occurs at CPU No.1
(a) A "MULTI CPU DOWN (error code: 7000)" error occurs at the other CPUs
and the Multiple CPU system will be halted when a stop error occurs at the
(Note-1)
PLC CPU No.1.
(b) The following procedure to restore the system is shown below.
1) Confirm the error cause with the PLC diagnostics on GX Works2/
GX Developer.
2) Remove the error cause.
3) Either reset the PLC CPU No.1 or restart the power to the Multiple CPU
system (power ON OFF ON).
All CPUs on the entire Multiple CPU system will be reset and the system will
be restored when PLC CPU No. 1 is reset or the Multiple CPU system is
reapplied.
(2) When a stop error occurs at CPU other than No.1
Whether the entire system is halted or not is determined by the Multiple CPU
setting's "Operating Mode" setting when a stop error occurs in a PLC CPU
module/Motion CPU module other than CPU No.1.
The default is set for all CPUs to be stopped with a stop error.
When you do not want to stop all CPUs at occurrence of a stop error in a PLC
CPU module/Motion CPU module, remove the check mark that corresponds to
the CPU No. so that its error will not stop all CPUs. (See arrow A.)
A
(a) When a stop error occurs in the CPU module for which "All station stop by
stop error of CPU 'n' " has been set, a "MULTI CPU DOWN (error code:
7000)" error occurs for the other PLC CPU module/Motion CPU modules
(Note-1)
and the Multiple CPU system will be halted.
2-7
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
(b) When a stop error occurs in the CPU module for which " All station stop by
stop error of CPU 'n' " has not been set, a "MULTI EXE. ERROR (error
code: 7020)" error occurs in all other CPUs but operations will continue.
POINT
(Note-1): When a stop error occurs, a "MULTI CPU DOWN (error code : 7000)" will
occur at the CPU on which the error was detected.
Depending on the timing of error detection, a "MULTI CPU DOWN" error
may be detected in a CPU of "MULTI CPU DOWN" status, not the first
CPU on which a stop error occurs.
Because of this, CPU No. different from the one of initial error CPU may
be stored in the error data's common information category.
To restore the system, remove the error cause on the CPU that is
stopped by an error other than "MULTI CPU DOWN".
In the screen below, the cause of the CPU No.2 error that did not cause
the "MULTI CPU DOWN" error is to be removed.
The stop error can be checked on the PLC diagnostics screen in
GX Works2/GX Developer.
<Screen: GX Works2>
(c) Observe the following procedures to restore the system.
1) Confirm the error-detected CPU No. and error cause with the PLC
diagnostics on GX Works2/GX Developer.
2) If the error code occurred in Motion CPU 10000 to 10999, confirm the
error cause with monitor of MT Developer2.
3) Remove the error cause.
4) Either reset the PLC CPU No.1 or restart the power to the Multiple CPU
system (power ON OFF ON).
All CPUs on the entire Multiple CPU system will be reset and the system will
be restored when PLC CPU No.1 is reset or the power to the Multiple CPU
system is reapplied.
2-8
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
(3) Operation at a Motion CPU error
Operations at a Motion CPU error are shown below.
Category
Type of error
System setting error
Operation
Operation
Does not operate from the
beginning (does not run).
WDT error
Varies depending on the error.
Self-diagnosis error
Stops at a CPU DOWN error.
disable errors
Remark
• All actual output PY points turn OFF.
No effect on other CPUs.
• All actual output PY points turn OFF.
Other CPUs may also stop depending on
the parameter setting.
Operation corresponding to
Other CPU DOWN error
STOP (M2000 OFF). Depends
on the "Operation mode upon
• All actual output PY points turn OFF.
CPU stop error" setting.
Self-diagnosis error
Motion SFC error
Operation
continuous
enable errors
Operation continues when the
continuous error occurred.
(Note-1)
Minor error
Major error
Processing stops for each
Servo error
program or axis instead of the
Servo program setting
(Note-1)
error
/
Motion CPU stopping all the
processing.
program may continue depending on the
type of error).
• Actual output PY retains output.
• No effect on other CPUs.
Motion program setting
error
• Only the applicable program stops (the
(Note-2)
(Note-1): SV13/SV22 use.
(Note-2): SV43 use.
2-9
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
2.2 Starting Up the Multiple CPU System
This section describes a standard procedure to start up the Multiple CPU system.
2.2.1 Startup Flow of the Multiple CPU system
START
Definition of functions with Multiple CPU
system
Control and function executed in each
CPU module are defined.
Application and assignment of device
Refer to Section 2.3
When automatic refresh of the CPU
shared memory is performed, the
number of refresh points is continuously
obtained.
Selection of module
Select the module to achieve the
function with the Multiple CPU system.
Refer to the "Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU
Motion controller User's Manual"
PLC CPU
Motion CPU
Installation of module
Install the selected module on the main
base unit and extension base unit.
Start-up of GX Works2/GX Developer
Refer to the "Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU
Motion controller User's Manual"
Refer to the GX Works2/GX Developer Manual.
Start-up GX Works2 (Ver.1.15R or later)
/GX Developer (Ver. 8.48A or later).
Creation of parameters, etc.
Create the parameter such as Multiple
CPU setting and control CPU setting,
and the sequence program.
Connection of PC to the PLC CPU
module of CPU No. 1
PLC CPU
Connect the PC that started GX Works2
/GX Developer to the PLC CPU module
of CPU No. 1 with the RS-232/USB/
Ethernet cable.
Multiple CPU system power ON
Turn ON the power of Multiple CPU
system in the following state of PLC
CPU module of CPU No.1.
RUN/STOP/RESET switch : STOP
Write of parameter and program
Write parameter and sequence program
in the PLC CPU of CPU No. 1.
For PLC CPU other than CPU No. 1,
select the applicable PLC CPU by
specifying the connection.
1)
2 - 10
Create the parameters for CPU No. 1 to 4 and
sequence programs.
Refer to the "QnUCPU User's Manual" (Function
Explanation/Program Fundamentals)".
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
1)
Start-up of MT Developer2
Refer to the help for operation of MT Developer2.
Start-up MT Developer2.
Creation of system settings and
program, etc.
Motion CPU
Create the system settings, servo data
and Motion SFC program (SV13/SV22)
/Motion program (SV43).
Refer to Section 3.1 for system settings.
Refer to the Programming Manual of each
operating system software for details of program.
Write to the Motion CPU
Write the system settings, servo data
and Motion SFC program (SV13/SV22)
/Motion program (SV43).
Switch setting for all CPUs
PLC CPU
Motion CPU
Set RUN/STOP/RESET switch of PLC
CPU modules and RUN/STOP switch of
Motion CPU modules in CPU No.1 to 4
to RUN.
Reset PLC CPU module of CPU No.1
Set RUN/STOP/RESET switch of PLC
CPU module in CPU No.1 to RESET
to reset the entire system.
PLC CPU
Status check in all CPU modules
Check if all CPUs of the Multiple CPU
system are RUN status/error by
resetting the CPU module of CPU No. 1.
Check and correction of errors
PLC CPU
Motion CPU
An error is checked with the PC
diagnosis function of GX Works2/
GX Developer and monitor of
MT Developer2 for correction.
Debug of each CPU module
Multiple CPU system is debugged for
each PLC CPU/Motion CPU.
Actual operation
Check in the automatic operation.
END
(Note): Installation of the operating system software is required to the Motion CPU module before start of
the Multiple CPU system.
Refer to Chapter 5 of the "Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller User's Manual" for
installation of the Motion CPU operating system software.
2 - 11
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
2.3 Communication Between the PLC CPU and the Motion CPU in the Multiple CPU System
2.3.1 CPU shared memory
(1) Structure of CPU shared memory
The CPU shared memory is memory provided for each CPU module and by
which data are written or read between CPU modules of the Multiple CPU
system.
The CPU shared memory consists of four areas.
• Self CPU operation information area
• System area
• User setting area
• Multiple CPU high speed transmission area
The CPU shared memory configuration and the availability of the communication
from the self CPU using the CPU shared memory by program are shown below.
Self CPU
Write
Read
CPU shared memory
(0H)
0
to
to
(1FFH)
511
(200H)
512
to
to
(7FFH) 2047
(800H) 2048
to
(FFFH)
(1000H)
to
(270FH)
(2710H)
to
4095
4096
to
9999
10000
to
up to
(5F0FH) 24335
to
Self CPU operation
information area
Other CPU
Write
Read
(Note-2)
(Note-2)
(Note-2)
System area
User setting area
(Note-1)
(Note-2)
(Note-2)
(Note-3)
(Note-3)
(Note-3)
Unusable
Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area
(Variable size in 0 to
14k[points]: 1k words in unit)
Multiple CPU
high speed
bus
: Communication allowed
: Communication not allowed
REMARK
(Note-1): Use the MULTW instruction to write to the user setting area of the self
CPU in the Motion CPU.
Use the S. TO instruction to write to the user setting area of the self CPU in
the PLC CPU.
(Note-2): Use the MULTR instruction to read the shared memory of self CPU and
other CPU in the Motion CPU.
Use the FROM instruction/Multiple CPU area device (U \G ) to read the
shared memory of the Motion CPU from the PLC CPU.
(Note-3): Refer to Section 2.3.2(1) for the access method of Multiple CPU high
speed transmission area.
2 - 12
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
(a) Self CPU operation information area (0H to 1FFH)
1) The following information of self CPU is stored as the Multiple CPU
system
Table 2.3 Table of self CPU operation information areas
CPU shared
memory
address
0H
1H
2H
3H
4H
5H
6H to 10H
Name
Description
Detail
(Note)
The area to confirm if information is stored in the self CPU's
operation information area (1H to 1FH) or not.
Information availability
• 0: Information not stored in the self CPU's operation information
Information availability
area.
flag
• 1: Information stored in the self CPU's operation information
area.
An error No. identified during diagnosis is stored in BIN.
Diagnostic error
Diagnostic error number
The year and month that the error number was stored in the CPU
shared memory's 1H address is stored with two digits of the BCD
code.
The date and time that the error number was stored in the CPU
Time the diagnostic error Time the diagnostic error
shared memory's 1H address is stored with two digits of the BCD
occurred
occurred
code.
The minutes and seconds that the error number was stored in the
CPU shared memory's 1H address is stored with two digits of the
BCD code.
Stores an identification code to determine what error information
Error information
Error information
has been stored in the common error information and individual
identification code
identification code
error information.
The common information corresponding to the error number
Common error information Common error information
identified during diagnosis is stored.
Corresponding
special register
—
SD0
SD1
SD2
SD3
SD4
SD5 to SD15
1CH
Individual error
information
Empty
Individual error
information
—
Cannot be used
1DH
1EH
Switch status
Empty
CPU switch status
—
Stores the CPU module switch status.
Cannot be used
SD200
—
1FH
CPU operation status
CPU operation status
Stores the CPU module's operation status.
SD203
11H to 1BH
The individual information corresponding to the error number
identified during diagnostic is stored.
SD16 to SD26
—
(Note): Refer to the corresponding special register for details.
2) The self CPU operation information area is refreshed every time the
applicable register has been changed in the main cycle.
3) Other PLC CPU can use FROM instruction to read data from the self
CPU operation information area.
However, because there is a delay in data updating, use the read data
for monitoring purposes only.
(b) System area
The area used by the operating systems (OS) of the PLC CPU/Motion CPU.
(c) User setting area
The area for communication between CPU modules in the Multiple CPU
system by MULTR/MULTW instruction of Motion CPU.
(PLC CPU use FROM/S.TO instruction or Multiple CPU area devices to
communicate between CPU modules.)
Refer to the Programming Manual of operating system software for
MULTR/MULTW instruction.
2 - 13
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
(d) Multiple CPU high speed transmission area
The area corresponding to the Multiple CPU high speed main base unit
(Q3 DB) and Multiple CPU high speed transmission that uses the drive
system controllers including PLC CPU and Motion CPU.
The image chart of Multiple CPU high speed transmission area is shown
below.
Refer to Section 2.3.2(1) for access to the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area of self CPU and other CPU.
CPU No.2
CPU No.3
CPU No.4
CPU No.1
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Transmission)
CPU No.1
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Reception)
CPU No.1
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Reception)
CPU No.1
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Reception)
CPU No.2
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Reception)
CPU No.2
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Transmission)
CPU No.2
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Reception)
CPU No.2
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Reception)
CPU No.3
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Reception)
CPU No.3
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Reception)
CPU No.3
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Transmission)
CPU No.3
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Reception)
CPU No.4
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Reception)
CPU No.4
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Reception)
CPU No.4
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Reception)
CPU No.4
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area
(Transmission)
CPU No.1
(Note-2)
U3E0\G10000
to
U3E0\G
(Note-1)
U3E1\G10000
to
U3E1\G
(Note-1)
U3E2\G10000
to
U3E2\G
(Note-2)
(Note-1)
U3E3\G10000
to
U3E3\G
(Note-2)
(Note-2)
(Note-1)
(Note-1) : The final device is "10000+(A 1024-B-1)".
A : Data transmission size of each CPU (1k words in unit)
B : Size used in the automatic refresh of each CPU.
Refer to Section "2.3.2 Multiple CPU high speed transmission"
for the size setting of A and B.
(Note-2) : Transmission area to write/read in the self CPU.
Reception area from the other CPU can be read only.
It is updated every 0.88ms.
2 - 14
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
2.3.2 Multiple CPU high speed transmission
(1) Multiple CPU high speed transmission
Multiple CPU high speed transmission is a function for fixed cycle data
transmission between Multiple CPUs (Multiple CPU high speed transmission
cycle is 0.88[ms].).
Secure data transmission is possible without effecting the PLC CPU scan time or
Motion CPU main cycle because the data transmission and execution of
sequence program and Motion SFC program/Motion program can be executed
with parallel processing.
High speed response between multiple CPUs is realized by synchronizing the
Multiple CPU high speed transmission cycle with Motion CPU operation cycle.
The following methods of data transmission exist between Multiple CPUs for
Multiple CPU high speed transmission.
• Use the Multiple CPU area device
Set the Multiple CPU high speed transmission area by setting the Multiple CPU
area device (U \G ) in the program.
• Automatic refresh method
Refresh the internal devices of each CPU by automatic refresh via "Multiple
CPU high speed transmission area".
(a) Multiple CPU area device method
CPU No.1 (PLC CPU)
CPU No.2 (Motion CPU)
SM400
U3E0\
MOV W0 G10000
U3E0\
G10010.1
1)
U3E0\G10000
2)
U3E0\
G10110.5
END
4)
U3E0\G10100
CPU No.1
transmitting
data
5)
Motion SFC program
G0
U3E0\G10010.1
G1
U3E0\G10110.5
F0
W0=U3E0\G10000
F1
W1=U3E0\G10100
U3E0\G10010
CPU No.1
transmitting
data
U3E0\
MOV W1 G10100
3)
U3E0\G10000
U3E0\G10010
SM400
CPU shared memory
(User setting area (Note-1))
CPU shared memory
(User setting area (Note-1))
Sequence program
U3E0\G10100
6)
U3E0\G10110
U3E0\G10110
Multiple CPU high speed
transmission in 0.88ms cycle
1), 4) : Write data in the user setting area (Note-1) by the instruction that uses the Multiple CPU area device.
3), 6) : Read data from the user setting area (Note-1) by the instruction that uses the Multiple CPU area device.
2), 5) : Transmit the contents of user setting area (Note-1) to the other CPU with by Multiple CPU high speed transmission in 0.88ms cycle.
Note-1: The area composed in the Multiple CPU high speed transmission area.
(Refer to Section "(3) Memory configuration of Multiple CPU high speed transmission area".)
2 - 15
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
1) Access to Multiple CPU high speed transmission area
a) SV13/SV22
• Description of Multiple CPU area device
Word device : U
\G
CPU shared memory address (Decimal) (10000 to up to 24335)
First I/O number of CPU module
CPU No.
CPU No.1 CPU No.2 CPU No.3 CPU No.4
First I/O number 3E0(H)
3E1(H)
3E2(H)
3E3(H)
Bit device
:U
\G
.
Bit specification (0 to F : Hexadecimal)
CPU shared memory address (Decimal) (10000 to up to 24335)
First I/O number CPU module
CPU No.
CPU No.1 CPU No.2 CPU No.3 CPU No.4
3E1(H)
3E2(H)
3E3(H)
First I/O number 3E0(H)
(Example)
• Multiple CPU high speed transmission memory address of CPU
No.2: 10002
U3E1\G10002
• Bit 14 of CPU No.3 Multiple CPU high speed transmission
memory address 10200
U3E2\G10200.E
• Example of access in the program
<Motion SFC program>
• Store K12345678 to the Multiple CPU high speed transmission
memory 10200,10201 of self CPU (CPU No.2).
U3E1\G10200L = K12345678
• Turn on bit 12 of the Multiple CPU high speed transmission
memory 10301 of self CPU (CPU No.3)
SET U3E2\G10301.C
<Servo program>
• Program which executes the positioning for Axis 1 to position set
in the Multiple CPU high speed transmission memory 10400,
10401 of CPU No.1 at the speed set in the 10402, 10403 of CPU
No.1, and uses bit 1 of CPU No.1 Multiple CPU high speed
transmission memory 10404 of CPU No.1 as a cancel signal.
ABS-1
Axis
Speed
Cancel
1,
2 - 16
U3E0\G10400
U3E0\G10402
U3E0\G10404.1
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
b) SV43
• Description of Multiple CPU area device
Word device : # Q
\
CPU shared memory address (Decimal) (0 to up to 14335)(Note)
CPU No.
CPU No.
Set value
Bit device
:#Q
\
CPU No.1 CPU No.2 CPU No.3 CPU No.4
0
1
2
3
.
Bit specification (0 to F : Hexadecimal)
CPU shared memory address (Decimal) (0 to up to 14335)(Note)
CPU No.
CPU No.
Set value
CPU No.1 CPU No.2 CPU No.3 CPU No.4
0
1
2
3
(Note): Write the value that attracted 10000 from specified CPU
shared memory address.
(Accessible memory address : 10000 to 24335)
(Example)
• Multiple CPU high speed transmission memory address of CPU
No.2: 10002
#Q1\2
• Bit 14 of CPU No.3 Multiple CPU high speed transmission
memory address 10200
#Q2\200.E
• Example of access in the program
<Motion program>
• Store K12345678 to the Multiple CPU high speed transmission
memory 10200,10201 of self CPU (CPU No.2).
#Q1\200:L = K12345678;
• Turn on bit 12 of the Multiple CPU high speed transmission
memory 10301 of self CPU (CPU No.3)
SET #Q2\301.C;
• Program which executes the positioning for Axis X to position set
in the Multiple CPU high speed transmission memory 10400,
10401 of CPU No.1 at the speed set in the 10402, 10403 of CPU
No.1, and uses bit 1 of CPU No.1 Multiple CPU high speed
transmission memory 10404 of CPU No.1 as a skip signal.
G32 X#Q0\400:L F#Q0\402:L SKIP #Q\404.1;
POINT
This method can be used to access only the Multiple CPU high speed transmission
area of CPU shared memory. It cannot be used to access the CPU shared memory
(0 to 4095).
2 - 17
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
(b) Example of using automatic refresh method
CPU No.1 (PLC CPU)
CPU No.2 (Motion CPU)
Sequence program
Device memory
SM400
CPU shared memory
CPU shared memory
(Automatic refresh area (Note-1))
(Automatic refresh area (Note-1))
Device memory
INC D0
Y0
1)
D0
Refresh at the
timing of END
processing
SM400
CPU No.1
transmitting
data
3)
2)
CPU No.1
transmitting
data
INC D1
D2000
Refresh at the
timing of Motion
CPU main cycle
Y0
Multiple CPU high speed
transmission in 0.88ms cycle
END
Parameter
Parameter
CPU No.1 to CPU No.2
Transmit D0
CPU No.1 to CPU No.2
Receive D2000
1) Transmit the content of D0 to the automatic refresh area (Note-1) at the time of END processing by parameter setting.
2) Transmit the content of automatic refresh area (Note-1) to the other CPU by Multiple CPU high speed transmission at 0.88ms cycle.
3) Read the content of automatic refresh area (Note-1) at the time of Motion CPU main cycle and transmit it to D2000 by parameter setting.
Note-1: The area composed in the Multiple CPU high speed transmission area.
(Refer to Section "(3) Memory configuration of Multiple CPU high speed transmission area".)
(2) System configuration
Multiple CPU high speed transmission can be used only between CPU modules
for the Multiple CPU high speed transmission installed in the Multiple CPU high
speed main base unit (Q3 DB).
The system configuration specification is shown in Table 2.4.
Table 2.4 System configuration to use Multiple CPU high speed
transmission
Object
Base unit
Restrictions
Multiple CPU high speed main base unit (Q3 DB) is used.
QnUD(E)(H)CPU/QnUDVCPU is used for CPU No.1.
CPU module
Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU and QnUD(E) (H)CPU/QnUDVCPU are
used for CPU No.2 to CPU No.4
"MULTI EXE. ERROR (error code: 7011) will occur if the power supply of Multiple
CPU system is turned on without matching the system configuration shown in
Table 2.4.
2 - 18
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
(3) Memory configuration of Multiple CPU high speed transmission
area
Memory configuration of Multiple CPU high speed transmission area is shown
below.
1)
Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area
[Variable in 0 to
14k[points] (Note-1)]
2)
3)
4)
5)
CPU No.1 send area
CPU No.2 send area
6)
7)
User setting area
Automatic refresh area
CPU No.3 send area
CPU No.4 send area
(Note-1): Multiple CPU high speed transmission area;
14k[points]: Maximum value when constituted with two CPUs
13k[points]: Maximum value when constituted with three CPUs
12k[points]: Maximum value when constituted with four CPUs
Table 2.5 Description of area
No.
Name
Description
Size
Setting range
Setting unit
0 to 14k
1k
0 to 14k
1k
0 to 14k
2
0 to 14k
2
• Area for data transmission between each CPU module
1)
Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area
in the Multiple CPU system.
• The area up to 14k [points] is divided between each
CPU module that constitutes the Multiple CPU system.
2)
3)
4)
• Area to store the send data of each CPU module.
CPU No. n send area
(n=1 to 4)
5)
• Sends the data stored in the send area of self CPU to
the other CPUs.
• Other CPU send area stores the data received from the
other CPUs.
• Area for data communication with other CPUs using
the Multiple CPU area device.
6)
User setting area
• Can be accessed by the user program using the
Multiple CPU area device.
• Refer to Section 2.3.2 (1) for details of this area.
• Area for communicating device data with other CPUs
7)
Automatic refresh
area
by the communication using the automatic refresh.
• Access by user program is disabled.
• Refer to Section "(4)(b) Automatic refresh setting" for
details of this area.
2 - 19
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
(4) Parameter setting
The parameter setting list for use with the Multiple CPU high speed transmission
is shown in Table 2.6.
Table 2.6 Multiple CPU high speed transmission parameter list
Name
Description
Multiple CPU high
Set the size of the Multiple CPU high speed
speed transmission
transmission area allocated in each CPU module
area setting
which composes the Multiple CPU system.
Automatic refresh
setting
Set the range to execute the data transmission by
Target CPU
All CPUs
the automatic refresh function among the user area
in the Multiple CPU high speed transmission area.
(a) Multiple CPU high speed transmission area setting
Multiple CPU high speed transmission area setting screen and setting range
are shown below.
2 - 20
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
Table 2.7 Parameter setting items of Multiple CPU high speed transmission area setting
Item
CPU
Setting description
Setting/display value
CPU No. corresponding to displayed parameters. CPU No.1 to No.4
Set the number of points of data that each CPU
module sends.
Default value assigned to each CPU is shown
below.
CPU specific
send range
Number of
CPUs
Default value of CPU specific
send range [points]
CPU
No.1
CPU
No.2
CPU
No.3
CPU
No.4
—
2
7k
7k
—
3
7k
3k
3k
—
4
3k
3k
3k
3k
Range: 0 to 14k [points]
Unit: 1k [point]
(Points: Word in units)
Restriction
Consistency
check
—
—
• Set the total of all CPUs to be
the following points or lower.
When constituted with two
CPUs: 14k [points]
When constituted with three
CPUs: 13k [points]
When constituted with four
CPUs: 12k [points]
Provided
Automatic
refresh
Used when communicating with the other CPU
using the automatic refresh.
Number of points that is set by the "automatic
refresh setting" is displayed.
Do not exceed the number of
Range: 0 to 14336 [points]
points of the CPU specific send
Unit: 2 [points]
range.
—
User setting
area
Used when communicating with the other CPU
using the program.
The value where the "number of points set in the
automatic refresh" is subtracted from the "CPU
specific send range setting" is displayed.
Range: 0 to 14336 [points]
Unit: 2 [points]
—
2 - 21
—
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
POINT
Selecting "Advanced setting" enables the ability to change the number of points
from 1k to 2k in the system area used for Motion dedicated PLC instructions.
Changing the number of points in the system area to 2k increases the number of
Motion dedicated PLC instructions that can be executed concurrently in a scan.
The screen where "Advanced setting" is selected is shown below.
Refer to the "Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller (SV13/SV22)
Programming Manual (Motion SFC)" for the Motion dedicated PLC instruction.
System area is
displayed by selecting
"Advanced settings".
Item
Setting description
Setting/display value
(Points: Word in units)
CPU specific Set the number of points of data
send range
that each CPU module sends.
Range: 0 to 14k [points]
Unit: 1k [points]
Set the number of points for a
system area to be assigned for
System area each CPU module.
(Default value of system area
size is 1k [point].)
Range: 1k/2k [points]
Total
Display the total of number of
points of the self CPU send area
Range: 1 to 16k [points]
and the system area that are
Unit: 1k [points]
assigned to the each CPU
module.
2 - 22
Restriction
Data size
consistency
check
• Set the total of all CPUs to
be the following points or
lower.
When constituted with two
CPUs: 14k [points]
When constituted with
three CPUs: 13k [points]
When constituted with four
CPUs: 12k [points]
Provided
—
Provided
Set the total of all CPUs to
16.0k points or lower.
—
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
(b) Automatic refresh setting
Setting for use of the automatic refresh function in the Multiple CPU high
speed transmission area.
Up to 32 setting ranges can be set for each CPU module.
Automatic refresh setting screen and setting range are shown below.
Table 2.8 Parameter setting items of automatic refresh setting
Item
Setting description
Setting range
CPU
selection
Select the CPU module for editing of the
CPU specific send range setting.
Setting No.
The setting No. for transmission of each
CPU module is displayed. Automatic refresh
1 to 32
is executed between devices set to the
same setting No. for all CPUs that constitute
the Multiple CPU system.
CPU No.1 to No.4
Restriction
• CPU No. which exceeds the
number of CPU modules cannot
be selected.
—
Points
Set the number of points for data
communication.
• Setting which exceeds the
number of points of the self CPU
send area allocated to each CPU
Range: 2 to 14336 [points]
module (CPU specific send
Unit: 2 [points]
range) cannot be set.
• Bit device can be specified in
units of 32 points (2 words) only.
Start
Specifies the device which performs the
data communication (automatic refresh).
Specifies the device sent by the self CPU
when the "Send source CPU selection" is
the self CPU, and specifies the device
received by the self CPU when the CPU
specific send range setting is the other
CPU.
Usable device ( X, Y, M, B,
• Bit device can be specified in
D, W, #, SM, SD)
units of 16 points (1 word) only.
Note) Set "blank" when
• Device number cannot be
automatic refresh is
duplicated.
not executed.
2 - 23
Data size
consistency
check
—
—
Provided
None
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
POINT
The processing performance of automatic refresh improves when devices are
transmitted in 2 word sets. Therefore, it is recommended to set the start device as 2
word unit by inputting an even device number.
1) Operation example of automatic refresh
a) 2 CPU modules (1 PLC CPU, 1 Motion CPU) use
• Parameter setting
The setting example of automatic refresh is shown below.
• CPU No.1 (PLC CPU) (GX Works2/GX Developer) <Screen: GX Works2>
Set the device transmitted to CPU No.2.
Set the device received from CPU No.2.
• CPU No.2 (Motion CPU) (MT Developer2)
Set the device received from CPU No.1.
Set the device transmitted to CPU No.1.
(Note) : The operation example of automatic refresh is shown on the next page.
2 - 24
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
• Operation example
The example of operating automatic refresh is shown below.
PLC CPU (CPU No.1)
Motion CPU (CPU No.2)
Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area
CPU No.1
transmitting data
M2399
M2400
Automatic
refresh area
M3039
M3040
M3199
EN
g
sin
es
oc
pr
M3839
M3840
U3E1\G10000
D0
EN
roce
Dp
CPU No.1
receiving data
g
ssin
Axis status
Automatic
refresh area
CPU No.2
transmitting data
Transfer
in 0.88ms
cycle
M2399
M2400
U3E1\G10000
CPU No.2
receiving data
Automatic
refresh area
Data register
Transfer
in 0.88ms
cycle
ng
D
EN
M3200
si
es
roc
p
D
Internal relay
M0
U3E0\G10000
M3039
Ma
in
c
M3040
ycl
e
M3199
M3200
cy
cle
U3E0\G10000
M0
M3839
M
ai
n
Internal relay
Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area
M3840
Automatic
refresh area
M8191
Main
Data register
cycle
D0
Axis monitor
device
D639
D639
D640
D640
D703
D704
D8191
2 - 25
Axis command
signal
Control change
register
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
b) 3 CPU modules (1 PLC CPU, 2 Motion CPUs) use
• Parameter setting
The setting example of automatic refresh is shown below.
• CPU No.1 (PLC CPU) (GX Works2/GX Developer) <Screen: GX Works2>
Set the device transmitted to CPU No.2 and No.3.
• CPU No.2 (Motion CPU) (MT Developer2)
Set the device received from CPU No.1.
Set "blank" not
to refresh the
device of CPU
No.3.
Set the device received from CPU No.2.
Set the device transmitted to CPU No.1 and No.3.
Set the device received from CPU No.3.
Set the device received from CPU No.3.
Set "blank" not
to refresh the
device of CPU
No.3.
2 - 26
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
• CPU No.3 (Motion CPU) (MT Developer2)
Set the device received from CPU No.1.
Set "blank" not
to refresh the
device of CPU
No.2.
Set the device received from CPU No.2.
Set "blank" not
to refresh the
device of CPU
No.2.
Set the device transmitted to CPU No.1 and No.2.
(Note): The operation example of automatic refresh is
shown on the next page.
2 - 27
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
• Operation example
The example of operating automatic refresh is shown below.
Internal relay
PLC CPU (CPU No.1)
Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area
M0
Motion CPU (CPU No.2)
Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area
U3E0\G10000
U3E0\G10000
CPU No.1
transmitting data
M1999
M2000
CPU No.1
receiving data
M1999
M2000
Transfer
in 0.88ms
cycle
END proseccng
M3055
Ma
M3056
Automatic
refresh area
M3071
M3072
g
sin
essing
END proc
es
oc
D
U3E2\G10000
M3839
Automatic
refresh area
Main
cycle
D0
Automatic
refresh area
D639
Command
device
M3840
M8191
Data register
D0
D639
D640
Monitor
device
Command
device
D758
U3E2\G10000
CPU No.3
receiving data
EN
Data register
Automatic
refresh area
CPU No.2
transmitting data
Transfer
in 0.88ms
cycle
M3071
D757
pr
oc
es
sin
g
M7840
U3E1\G10000
CPU No.2
receiving data
Monitor
device
M3056
le
Ma
in
cyc
le
essing
pr
M7839
U3E1\G10000
essing
END proc
D
M7072
END proc
EN
M7071
yc
cle
cy
M7055
in
c
in
Ma
M6000
ng
ssi
M5999
M3055
M3072
ce
pro
M3840
M7056
Automatic
refresh area
D
EN
M3839
Internal relay
M0
CPU No.3
receiving data
Transfer
in 0.88ms
cycle
D8191
Automatic
refresh area
D640
D757
D758
D999
D
EN
pr
e
oc
ss
g
in
Motion CPU (CPU No.3)
Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area
Internal relay (Note-1)
M0
U3E0\G10000
D1000
CPU No.1
receiving data
D1639
D1640
M1999
M2000
D1757
D1758
Transfer
in 0.88ms
cycle
M3055
Monitor
device
M3056
Automatic
refresh area
Ma i
n cy
cle
M3071
M3072
M3839
(Note-1) : Internal relay of CPU No.3;
When 4000 is allocated in the Motion device as offset.
(Note-2) : Data register of CPU No.3;
When 1000 is allocated in the Motion device as offset.
Command
device
M3840
U3E1\G10000
M8191
M
CPU No.2
receiving data
a in
cle
cy
Automatic
refresh area
2 - 28
cycle
D757
D758
cy
cle
CPU No.3
transmitting data
D640
Main
U3E2\G10000
D0
D639
Ma
in
Automatic
refresh area
Data register (Note-2)
D8191
Monitor
device
Command
device
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
POINT
Set the following operation for automatic refresh setting using GX Works2/
GX Developer.
1) Select tab "Multiple CPU high speed transmission area setting".
2) Set "Use Multiple CPU high speed transmission".
1)
2)
<Screen: GX Works2>
(c) Data size consistency check
Whether the Multiple CPU setting parameters are the same for all CPUs or
not is automatically checked. A "PARAMETER ERROR (error code: 3012,
3015) " will occur if they do not match.
(5) Precautions
(a) Assurance of data sent between CPUs
Due to the timing of data sent from the self CPU and automatic refresh in
any of the other CPUs, old data and new data may become mixed (data
separation).
The following shows the methods for avoiding data separation at
communications by automatic refresh.
1) Data consistency for 32 bit data
Transfer data with automatic refresh method is in units of 32 bits. Since
automatic refresh is set in units of 32 bits, 32-bit data does not separate.
• For word data
2 words data can be prevented from separating by using an even
number to set the first number of each device in automatic refresh
setting.
2) Data consistency for data exceeding 32 bits
In automatic refresh method, data is read in descending order of the
setting number in automatic refresh setting parameter.
Transfer data separation can be avoided by using a transfer number
lower than the transfer data as an interlock device.
2 - 29
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
2.3.3 Multiple CPU high speed refresh function
This function is used to update the data between internal devices of Motion CPU and
the Multiple CPU high speed transmission area. This occurs every operation cycle as
defined in the device setting of automatic refresh in the self CPU.
Classification
Item
Setting No.
Display
CPU
Description
Setting/display value
Setting No. which executes high speed
refresh is displayed.
CPU No. set in the automatic refresh setting
is automatically displayed by setting devices.
Self CPU : Refresh from the internal device
of Motion CPU to Multiple CPU
high speed transmission area.
Other CPU : Refresh form the Multiple CPU
high speed transmission area to
internal device of Motion CPU.
1 to 128
(Up to 128)
Restriction
CPU No. 1 to No.4
• The start device number must be a
multiple of 16 for the bit device.
• Do not set a device not setting also
set in the automatic refresh.
Device
Set the device No. of Motion CPU to execute Usable device : D, W, #, • No. of "start device + number of
points" cannot exceed setting range
setting
the high speed refreshes.
SD, M, X, Y, B, SM
of each setting No. in automatic
User setting
refresh setting.
• Do not overlap the device No.
between setting No..
Set the number of points to refresh data of
Range: 2 to 256 [points] • Sets the total of all CPUs to 256
Points
each data in word unit.
(Note-1)
Unit: 2 points
points or lower.
(Note) Refresh is not executed when not set.
Refresh cycle Operation cycle (fixed)
—
—
(Note-1) : Point in word unit.
(1) Application example of Multiple CPU high speed refresh function
Multiple CPU high speed refresh function is used as in the following applications.
1) Read the data such as the real current value and synchronous encoder
current value with PLC CPU at high speed.
2) Exchange the FIN waiting signal at high speed.
2 - 30
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
(2) Operation example of Multiple CPU high speed refresh function
(a) Parameter setting
The automatic refresh setting of Multiple CPU high speed refresh is shown
below.
• CPU No.1 (PLC CPU) (GX Works2/GX Developer) <Screen: GX Works2>
Set the device transmitted to CPU No.2.
Set the device received from CPU No.2.
• CPU No.2 (Motion CPU) (MT Developer2)
Set the device received from CPU No.1.
Set the device transmitted to CPU No.1.
Set the device to executed the Multiple CPU high speed refresh.
(Note) : The operating example of Multiple CPU high speed refresh function is shown in "(b) Operation example".
2 - 31
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
POINT
Set the following operation for automatic refresh setting using GX Works2/
GX Developer.
1) Select tab "Multiple CPU high speed transmission area setting".
2) Set "Use Multiple CPU high speed transmission".
1)
2)
<Screen: GX Works2>
2 - 32
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
(b) Operation example
The example of operating Multiple CPU high speed refresh function is
shown below.
PLC CPU (CPU No.1)
Motion CPU (CPU No.2)
Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area
Internal relay
M0
Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area
U3E0\G10000
M2400
Automatic
refresh area
Op
er
at
ion
M
g
sin
U3E1\G10000
es
oc
pr
CPU No.2
transmitting data
CPU No.2
receiving data
sin
M2496
cy
cle
ain
Axis
status
M3039
M3040
cy
cle
M3199
M3200
M3295
M3296
Axis command
signal
M3839
g
M3839
M2495
le
U3E1\G10000
D
EN
D
EN
es
oc
pr
Automatic
refresh area
Op
e
c rat
cy ycle ion
c
M3199
M2399
M2400
ain
M3040
Transfer
in 0.88ms
cycle
M
M3039
M3200
CPU No.1
receiving data
CPU No.1
transmitting data
M2399
Internal relay
M0
U3E0\G10000
M3840
M3840
Op
er
Data register
D0
Automatic
refresh area
D
EN
ce
p ro
Transfer
in 0.88ms
cycle
Automatic
refresh area
Op
er
Op
er
g
ssin
M8191
atio
n
atio
n
cyc
le
Data register
D0
D2,D3 1 axis monitor
device
D12,D13
cyc
le
D19
D20
D22,D23 2 axis monitor
device
D32,D33
atio
n
cyc
le
Ma
in c
ycle
Op
e ra
tio n
cyc
le
D39
D40
D42,D43 3 axis monitor
device
D52,D53
D59
D60
D62,D63 4 axis monitor
device
D72, D73
D79
D80
5 to 32 axis
monitor
device
D639
D639
D640
D640 Control change
register
D703
D704
D8191
• The statuses of M2400 to M2495 for 1 axis to 4 axes among each axis
status M2400 to M3039 in automatic refresh are updated to Multiple CPU
high speed transmission area every operation cycle.
• The command signals of M3200 to M3295 for 1 axis to 4 axes among each
axis command signals M3200 to M3839 in automatic refresh are updated
from Multiple CPU high speed transmission area to positioning dedicated
device every operation cycle.
• The real current value for 1 axis to 4 axes and M-code among each axis
monitor devices D0 to D639 in automatic refresh are updated to Multiple
CPU high speed transmission area every operation cycle.
2 - 33
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
2.3.4 Clock synchronization between Multiple CPU
The clock of each CPU is synchronized with the clock of CPU No. 1.
The clock data used for synchronization in a Multiple CPU system can be edited.
(1) Setting of clock data
Set the clock of CPU No.1. The Motion CPU module operates automatically by
the clock of CPU No.1.
POINT
The clock data of CPU No.1 is automatically set even if the clocks of CPU No. 2 to
4 are set independently.
(2) Synchronization of clock data
All clocks are synchronized with CPU No.1 immediately after turning
ON/resetting power and every 1-second interval thereafter.
(3) Information of clock
The clock data that CPU No. 1 transmits is year, month, day, day of week, hour,
minute and second.
(4) Error
Since CPU No.1 sets the clock data at 1-second intervals, an error of up to 1
second may occur to the clock of CPU No.2 to 4.
2 - 34
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
2.3.5 Multiple CPU synchronous startup
Multiple CPU synchronous startup function synchronizes the startups of CPU No.1 to
CPU No.4. (It takes about ten seconds to startup for Motion CPU.)
Since this function monitors the startup of each CPU module, when other CPU is
accessed by a user program, an interlock program which checks the CPU module
startup is unnecessary.
With the Multiple CPU synchronous startup function, the startup is synchronized with
the slowest CPU module to startup; therefore, the system startup may be slow.
POINT
Multiple CPU synchronous startup function is for accessing each CPU module in a
Multiple CPU system without needing an interlock.
This function is not for starting an operation simultaneously among CPU modules
after startup.
(1) Multiple CPU synchronous startup setting
To use the Multiple CPU synchronous startup function, check No.1 to No.4 of
target CPU in Multiple CPU settings in system setting of MT Developer2. (Set it
in the Multiple CPU setting of PLC parameter setting of GX Works2/
GX Developer for PLC CPU.)
"Set Sync. startup setting of CPU " is set for No.1 to 4 at default.
Set the same Multiple CPU synchronous startup for all CPUs that constitute the
Multiple CPU system.
The self-diagnosis error "PARAMETER ERROR (error code: 3015)" will occur if
all CPU modules that constitute the Multiple CPU system do not have the same
setting.
When this function is not used (each CPU startup without synchronization),
startup of each CPU module can be confirmed by using special relays SM220 to
SM223 (CPU No.1 to 4 READY complete flag).
2 - 35
2 MULTIPLE CPU SYSTEM
2.3.6 Control instruction from PLC CPU to Motion CPU
Control can be instructed from the PLC CPU to the Motion CPU using the Motion
dedicated PLC instructions listed in the table below.
Refer to the "Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller (SV13/SV22)
Programming Manual (Motion SFC)" for the details of each instruction.
(Control may not be instructed from one Motion CPU to another Motion CPU.)
Description
Instruction name
SV13/SV22
Start request of the Motion SFC
D(P).SFCS
program (Program No. may be
specified.)
D(P).SVST
D(P).CHGA
D(P).CHGAS
QDS
Ver.!
SV43
Start request of the Motion program
(Control program)
Start request of the specified servo
Start request of the specified Motion
program
program (Axis designation program)
Current value change request of the
Home position return request of the
specified axis
specified axis
Current value change request of the
Unusable
specified command generation axis
D(P).CHGV
Speed change request of the specified axis
D(P).CHGVS
Speed change request of the
QDS
Ver.!
Unusable
specified command generation axis
D(P).CHGT
Torque control value change request of the specified axis
D(P).CHGT2
Torque control value individual
QDS
D(P).GINT
D(P).DDWR
D(P).DDRD
Unusable
change request of the specified axis
Execute request of an event task to
Unusable
the other CPU (Motion CPU)
Write device data of the self CPU (PLC CPU) to the device of other CPU
(Motion CPU)
Read device data of other CPU (Motion CPU) to the device of self CPU
(PLC CPU)
For example, by using the D(P).SFCS instruction of Motion dedicated PLC instruction,
the Motion SFC of the Motion CPU can be started from the PLC CPU.
<Example>
PLC CPU
Motion CPU
Start request
Motion SFC
D(P). SFCS instruction
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
2 - 36
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
3. COMMON PARAMETERS
3.1 System Settings
In the Multiple CPU system, the common system parameters and individual
parameters are set for each CPU and written to each CPU.
(1) The base settings, Multiple CPU settings and Motion slot settings are set in the
common system parameter setting.
(2) The following are set in the individual parameter setting.
• System basic setting
• SSCNET setting QDS
• CPU name setting
• Built-in Ethernet port setting
• CPU setting
• Manual pulse generator/synchronous encoder setting QDS
• Servo amplifier setting
• High-speed read setting
• Optional data monitor setting
• Mark detection setting QDS
(3) The data setting and correction can be performed in dialog form using
MT Developer2.
3-1
3
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
3.1.1 System data settings
Table 3.1 lists the system data items to be set.
Table 3.1 System data setting list
Item
Common system parameters
Base setting
Main base: 8 slots
Extension base
Stage 1 to 7: Nothing/2/3/5/8/10/12 slots
Stage 1 to 7:Nothing
No. of CPU
2/3/4 modules
2 modules
Set whether or not to stop the entire
Stop all CPUs upon error
system when a CPU stop error
in CPU Nos. 1 to 4
occurs in each CPU.
System area 1 to 2k points
1
Automatic
refresh
setting
Point: 2 to 14336 points
Start: Set target device for automatic refresh.
None
Multiple CPU synchronous
startup setting
Set/do not set CPU No. 1 to 4 as the
synchronized startup.
(The setting range varies depending on the
number of Multiple CPUs.)
Set CPU No. 1 to 4 as
Refer to Section 2.3.5.
the synchronized startup.
Module arrangement
Within the main base and extension base
slots
None
Individual module
Varies depending on the module.
Varies depending on the Set detailed items for each module
module.
controlled by the self CPU.
Operation cycle
0.2ms QDS /0.4ms/0.8ms/1.7ms/3.5ms/7.1ms/
14.2ms QD /Default setting
Default setting
Refer to Section 2.3.2.
Install the modules controlled by the
self CPU in the main base and/or
extension base(s).
Set the operation cycle of motion
control.
M2000 is turned on by switching from STOP
M2000 is turned on by
to RUN./M2000 is turned on by switching from
switching from STOP to
Operation at STOP to RUN
STOP to RUN and setting 1 in the set
RUN.
register.
Set the condition in which the PLC
ready flag (M2000) turns on.
Error setting on servo
warning QDS
Output error/Not output error
Output error
Set whether or not to output error to
motion error history or self-diagnosis
error on servo warning.
Perform battery check/Not perform battery
check
Perform battery check
Set whether or not to check the
battery of Motion CPU.
Nothing/X (PX) (0 to 1FFF)/M (0 to 8191)
Nothing
Set the bit device to use forced stop
in the program.
However, the forced stop input by
EMI terminal of Motion CPU module
cannot be invalidated using
parameter setting.
Latch range
M (0 to 8191)/B (0 to 1FFF)/F (0 to 2047)/
D (0 to 8191)/W (0 to 1FFF)
None
Set the latch range of device
memory.
Communication type
SSCNET /H / SSCNET
SSCNET /H
Set the communication type for
every line.
Label
Up to 10 characters
None
Comment
Up to 64 characters
None
Forced stop
QDS
(Note-1)
Input format
Built-in
Ethernet port
setting
Set the total number of Multiple
CPUs including PLC CPU(s).
Varies depending on the
number of CPUs.
System basic
setting
Error check
CPU name
setting
Remark
Set the number of slots in the main
base or extension base.
CPU specific
0 to 14k points
send range
Multiple CPU Multiple CPU
setting
high speed
transmission
area setting
SSCNET
setting QDS
Initial value
5/8/12 slots
Stop/do not stop all CPUs upon an error in
Error operation mode at the CPU No. 1 to 4.
stop of CPU
(The setting range varies depending on the
number of Multiple CPUs.)
Motion slot
setting
Individual parameters
Setting range
Main base
Decimal/Hexadecimal
Decimal
Decimal
: 0.0.0.1 to 223.255.255.254
Hexadecimal : 00.00.00.01 to DF.FF.FF.FE
192.168.3.39
Decimal
: 192.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.252
Hexadecimal : C0.00.00.01 to FF.FF.FF.FC
None
Decimal
: 0.0.0.1 to 223.255.255.254
Hexadecimal : 00.00.00.01 to DF.FF.FF.FE
None
Communication data code
Binary code/ASCII code
Binary code
Enable online change
(MC protocol)
Enable online change/Disable online change
Disable online change
IP address
IP address
Subnet mask
setting
pattern
Default router
IP address
Open setting
—
None
3-2
Set the label (name application) and
comment of Motion CPU.
Refer to Section 4.13.
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
Table 3.1 System data setting list (Continued)
Item
Setting range
Set self CPU/other CPU/CPU (empty) for
slots 0/1/2. (The setting range varies
depending on the number of Multiple CPUs
installed.)
Self CPU installation
position setting
Input setting
QDS
First input No.
High-speed read setting
(Note-2)
CPU setting
Input signal detection
direction QDS
Multiple CPU synchronous
(Note-3)
control setting
QDS
Ver.!
Status device setting
Individual parameters
Manual pulse
generator/
incremental
synchronous
encoder
setting QDS
Amplifier
information
Used/Unused
Unused
Valid on leading edge (Normal open)/
Valid on trailing edge (Normal close)
Valid on leading edge
(Normal open)
Set device to "Synchronous controlling",
"Status for each CPU", and "Error status for
each CPU and axis".
Bit device : X, Y, M, B, F
Word device : D, W, #, U \G
Set the input signal of built-in
interface in Motion CPU (DI)/mark
detection input signal.
Set the Multiple CPU synchronous
control setting in each CPU.
None
Not used
Differential output type/
Voltage output/open collector type
Differential output type
<Communication type "SSCNET /H" use>
MR-J4(W)-B(-RJ)/VC (Nikki Denso)
MR-J4(W)-B(-RJ)
Q173DSCPU: Up to 2 lines, 32 axes
Q172DSCPU: Up to 1 line, 16 axes
None
Up to 32 characters
None
Invalid/ABS/INC
Invalid
Input filter setting
Nothing/0.8ms/1.7ms/2.6ms/3.5ms
3.5ms
Allowable travel during
Power-Off
<Communication type "SSCNET " use>
0 to 8191 revolution
10
INC/ABS
INC
Amplifier type
MR-J3(W)-B/MR-J3-B(S) Fully closed/
MR-J3(W)-B Linear/MR-J3(W)-B DD motor/
FR-A700/VC (Nikki Denso)
MR-J3(W)-B
Axis No.
Q173DCPU(-S1): Up to 2 lines, 32 axes
Q172DCPU(-S1): Up to 1 line, 8 axes
None
Axis name
(SV43)
Q173DCPU(-S1): X/Y/Z/U/V/W/A/B/CX/CY/
CZ/CU/CV/CW/CA/CB/DX/
DY/DZ/DU/DV/DW/DA/DB/
None
EX/EY/EZ/EU/EV/EW/EA/
EB
Q172DCPU(-S1): X/Y/Z/U/V/W/A/B/C
Axis No.
Axis
information
Axis label
Ver.!
(Note-4)
Ver.!
External signal input setting Amplifier input invalid/Amplifier input valid
Input filter setting
Allowable travel during
Power-Off
ABS/INC setting
Set the installation position of the
self CPU in the main base.
Independent CPU/master CPU/slave CPU for
Independent CPU
self CPU.
Standard
ABS/INC setting
QD
Unused
0000
<Communication type "SSCNET /H" use>
Standard/Fully closed/Linear/DD motor
External synchronous
(Note-3)
encoder input
Amplifier
setting
Used/Unused
Remark
Set the manual pulse generator/
synchronous encoder of built-in
interface in Motion CPU.
<Communication type "SSCNET " use>
MR-J3(W)-B/MR-J3-B(S) Fully closed/
MR-J3(W)-B
MR-J3(W)-B Linear/MR-J3(W)-B DD motor/
FR-A700/VC (Nikki Denso)
Amplifier
operation
mode
Amplifier
setting
QDS
Amplifier
model
None
0000 to 0FF0 (in units 16 points)
CPU built-in Manual pulse
generator/incremental
Used/Not used
synchronous encoder (INC)
Input type setting
Initial value
(Note-4)
Ver.!
Set the model name, axis No. and
other details for the servo amplifiers.
Amplifier input invalid
Nothing/0.8ms/1.7ms/2.6ms/3.5ms
3.5ms
0 to 8191 revolution
10
INC/ABS
INC
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
3-3
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
Table 3.1 System data setting list (Continued)
Item
Setting range
Pulse/synchronous encoder
I/F module
PLC input module
Either of one input module and built-in
None
interface in Motion CPU QDS
Input module: Up to 8 points
Built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI):
Up to 4 points
High-speed
reading data
(Note-2)
Individual parameters
Initial value
Either of Q172DEX and Q173DPX.
Q172DEX: Up to 2 points
Q173DPX: Up to 3 points
Remark
Refer to Section 4.3.
<Communication type "SSCNET /H" use>
Set 1 to 6 for each axis.
Optional data monitor setting
<Communication type "SSCNET " use>
Set 1 to 3 for each axis.
QDS
None
Refer to Section 4.10.
Set 1 to 32.
None
Refer to Section 4.14.
Set 1 to 32.
None
Refer to Section 4.15.
Set module 1 to 4 for each line.
Q173DSCPU: 2 lines (Up to 8 modules)
Q172DSCPU: 1 line (Up to 4 modules)
None
Refer to Section 4.18
Q173DSCPU: Up to 32 axes
Q172DSCPU: Up to 16 axes
Set 1 to 3 for each axis.
Q173DCPU(-S1): Up to 32 axes
Q172DCPU(-S1): Up to 8 axes
Optional data monitor setting
QD
Mark detection setting QDS
(Note-3)
High-speed input request signal
QDS
Ver.!
Head module
QDS
Ver.!
(Note-1): The forced stop can also be executed by the EMI forced stop terminal of Motion CPU module or forced stop terminal of
servo amplifier besides the forced stop input setting.
(Note-2): This cannot be set in SV22 advanced synchronous control. QDS
(Note-3): This can be set only in SV22 advanced synchronous control. QDS
(Note-4): This can be set only when "VC (Nikki Denso)" is selected in amplifier model.
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
3-4
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
3.1.2 Common system parameters
(1) Parameters for operating the Multiple CPU system
In the Multiple CPU system, the common system parameters and individual
parameter for each CPU are set and written into each CPU. Regarding the
Motion CPU, the items in System Settings related to the entire Multiple CPU
system must be identical to the parameter settings in the PLC CPU.
PLC CPU
parameters
PLC CPU
parameters
Motion CPU
parameters
Motion CPU
parameters
Common system
parameters
Common system
parameters
Common system
parameters
Common system
parameters
Individual
parameter
Individual
parameter
Individual
parameter
Individual
parameter
Power supply
Parameter write
QnUD
CPU
QnUD
CPU
3-5
Q173D(S) Q172D(S)
CPU
CPU
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
(2) Parameters common throughout the Multiple CPU system
In the Motion CPU, during initialization the parameters in the table below are
verified against the parameters in the PLC CPU of CPU No. 1. Unmatched
parameters generate a PARAMETER ERROR (error code: 3012, 3015), so the
parameters show below must be set identically between Motion CPUs and the
PLC CPU of CPU No.1. (If the system settings are changed in a Motion CPU, it is
necessary to reset. Therefore, the parameters are checked only during
initialization.)
The parameter No. of unmatched parameter is set in the error individual
information (SD16) by this error occurrence.
The parameters of the other CPUs via "Multiple CPU parameter utilization" can
be used in MT Developer2/GX Works2/GX Developer. The common parameters
must be set for each Motion CPU.
Table of Parameters cross-Multiple CPU system
Type of parameter
Name in Motion CPU
Name in PLC CPU
No. of CPU
Operating mode
System area
Multiple
CPU
settings
0E00H
Operating mode
Operation mode for CPU
stop error
0E01H
CPU specific
send range
Points of CPU specific
send range
E008H
Refer to Section 2.3.2.
System area
System area size
E008H
Refer to Section 2.3.2.
This parameter can be
set when "Advanced
setting" is selected.
E009H
Refer to Section 2.3.2.
(Automatic refresh using
Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area)
Multiple CPU
high speed
transmission
area setting
Automatic
Points of automatic
refresh setting refresh
Motion slot setting
Multiple CPU synchronous
startup setting
Synchronize Multiple CPU
startup or not
E00BH
Refer to Section 2.3.5.
Detailed settings Control PLC
Control CPU No.
0406H
Verify module only set in
the system settings in the
Motion CPU side.
0401H
Not verified if base
settings are omitted in
the PLC CPU side.
I/O
assignment
Base setting
Remark
Number of CPUs
Automatic
refresh setting
Multiple CPU synchronous
startup setting
Parameter
number
No. of PLC
CPU specific
send range
Multiple CPU
Multiple
high speed
CPU setting
transmission
area setting
Verification item
Total number of bases
Basic setting
Slots
3-6
Base No.
Base
Number of base
slots
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
(a) Multiple CPU settings
Set the following items identically in Multiple CPU Settings (Motion CPU) in
MT Developer2 and in Multiple CPU Settings (PLC CPU) in GX Works2/
GX Developer.
• Number of CPU modules (Included CPU empty slots)
• Operation mode when a CPU stop error occurred
• Multiple CPU high speed transmission area setting (Must be set the same
for all CPUs)
• Multiple CPU synchronous startup setting
Multiple CPU Settings (Motion CPU) in MT Developer2
Number of CPU
modules
Error operation mode
at the stop of CPU
Multiple CPU high
speed transmission
area setting
Multiple CPU
synchronous startup
setting
Multiple PLC Setting (PLC CPU setting) in GX Works2/GX Developer
<Screen: GX Works2>
Select tab "Multiple
CPU high speed
transmission area
setting"
Set "Use multiple
CPU high speed
transmission".
3-7
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
(b) Motion slot settings
Set the modules controlled by the self CPU by the Motion Slot Settings
(Motion CPU) in MT Developer2. In GX Works2/GX Developer, set the slot
for Motion CPU control as the CPU number of Motion CPU in I/O
Assignment Settings (PLC CPU).
Motion Slot Setting (Motion CPU) in MT Developer2
Control CPU No.
I/O Assignment Setting (PLC CPU setting) in GX Works2/GX Developer
<Screen: GX Works2>
(Note): Motion slot setting items are different depending on the operating system software.
3-8
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
(c) Base settings
Set the total number of bases and number of slots in each base identically
between Base Settings (Motion CPU) in MT Developer2 and I/O Assignment
Settings (PLC CPU) in GX Works2/GX Developer. In GX Works2/
GX Developer, the detailed settings may be omitted by setting the base
mode "Auto".
Base Settings (Motion CPU) in MT Developer2
Total number of bases
and number of slots in
each base
I/O Assignment Settings (PLC CPU setting) in GX Works2/GX Developer
<Screen: GX Works2>
(Note) : Only the Motion CPU
may be set without
setting the PLC CPU.
3-9
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
POINT
GOT is recognized as an intelligent function modules "16 points 10 slots" on the
base (number of extension bases and slot No. are set in the GOT parameter.) for
bus connection with GOT.
Set the one extension base (16 points 10 slots) for connection with GOT, then set
"10 slots" as number of extension bases for connection with GOT in the Basic
Setting (base setting) of MT Developer2.
<Example>
When the "2nd stage" of extension base is set as connection with GOT.
(Set "10 Slots/GOT(Bus connection)" as "2nd stage" of extension base in
the base setting.)
3 - 10
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
3.1.3 Individual parameters
(1) System basic setting
The following explains each item to be set in system basic setting.
(a) Operation cycle
1) Set the of motion operation cycle (cycles at which a position command is
computed and sent to the servo amplifier).
The setting range is 0.2ms QDS /0.4ms/0.8ms/1.7ms/3.5ms/7.1ms/
14.2ms QD /Default setting.
2) The default value is "Default Setting". When "Default Setting" is selected,
the operation cycle is set according to the table below based on the
number of axes for servo amplifier set in the System Settings.
Operating
system
SV13
SV22
SV43
Number of axes
Operation cycle
Actual operation
setting
cycle
—
0.2 ms
0.222...ms
1 to 6 axes
0.4 ms
0.444...ms
11 to 24 axes
7 to 18 axes
0.8 ms
0.888...ms
25 to 32 axes
19 to 32 axes
1.7 ms
1.777...ms
1 to 6 axes
1 to 4 axes
0.4 ms
0.444...ms
7 to 16 axes
5 to 12 axes
0.8 ms
0.888...ms
17 to 32 axes
13 to 28 axes
1.7 ms
1.777...ms
—
29 to 32 axes
3.5 ms
3.555...ms
—
1 to 4 axes
0.4 ms
0.444...ms
Q173DSCPU/
Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DSCPU
Q172DCPU(-S1)/
1 to 4 axes
5 to 10 axes
—
5 to 12 axes
0.8 ms
0.888...ms
—
13 to 28 axes
1.7 ms
1.777...ms
—
29 to 32 axes
3.5 ms
3.555...ms
3 - 11
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
3) If the duration of motion operation has exceeded the operation cycle, the
operation cycle over flag (M2054) turns ON. Even when "Automatic
setting" is selected, the duration of motion operation may exceed the
operation cycle depending on the control conditions. The actual duration
of motion operation (unit: s) is stored in SD522, and the current setting
of operation cycle (unit: s) is stored in SD523. Monitor these special
registers and adjust the set value of operation cycle so that the actual
duration of motion operation will not exceed the set operation cycle. (A
WDT or other error may occur in the Motion CPU.)
(b) Operation at STOP to RUN
Set the condition in which the PLC ready flag (M2000) turns ON. Select the
following either.
1) M2000 turns ON by switching from STOP to RUN. (Default)
Condition in which the M2000 turns from OFF to ON.
• Move the RUN/STOP switch from STOP to RUN.
• Turn ON the Multiple CPU system's power supply with the RUN/STOP
switch set to RUN.
Condition in which the M2000 turns from ON to OFF
• Move the RUN/STOP switch from RUN to STOP.
2) M2000 turns ON by switching from STOP to RUN and by setting "1" in
the setting register.
Condition in which the M2000 turns from OFF to ON
• Set "1" in the setting register (D704) of the PLC ready flag or turn ON
the PLC ready flag (M3072) with the RUN/STOP switch set to RUN.
(The Motion CPU detects the change from "0" to "1" in the lowest bit of
D704.)
Condition in which the M2000 turns from ON to OFF
• Set "0" in the setting register (D704) of the PLC ready flag or turn OFF
the PLC ready flag (M3072) with the RUN/STOP switch set to RUN.
(The Motion CPU detects the change from "1" to "0" in the lowest bit of
D704.)
• Move the RUN/STOP switch from RUN to STOP.
(c) Forced stop
Set the bit device used for executing a forced stop in which all servoamplifier axes are stopped immediately in the program.
Either X (PX) or M can be specified. No default value has been set. The set
bit device is designated as contact B and performs the following control in
response to ON/OFF of the device.
• Bit device is turned OFF …Forced stop input is ON (forced stop)
• Bit device is turned ON …..Forced stop input is OFF (forced stop is
released.)
The forced stop input by EMI terminal of Motion CPU module cannot be
invalidated using parameter setting.
3 - 12
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
(d) Error setting on servo warning QDS
Set whether or not to output error on servo warning.
Device No.
M2039
D8+20n
(Note-1)
#8008+20n
#8640+12n
#8641+12n
#8642+12n
#8643+12n
#8644+12n
#8645+12n
#8646+12n
#8647+12n
#8648+12n
(Note-1)
(Note-2)
Signal name
Servo error code
Servo amplifier display servo error code
Error Motion SFC program No.
Error type
(Note-2)
Error program No.
Error block No./Motion SFC list/
Line No./Axis No.
(Note-2)
(Note-2)
(Note-2)
(Note-2)
(Note-2)
Not output error
Motion error detection flag
(Note-2)
(Note-2)
Error setting on servo warning
Output error
Error code
Motion
error
history
Error occurrence time
(Year/month)
Error occurrence time
(Day/hour)
Error occurrence time
(Minute/second)
Error setting data information
(Note-2)
#8650+12n
(Note-2)
#8651+12n
Error setting data
SM0
Diagnostic error
SM1
Self-diagnostic error
SD0
Diagnostic errors
SD1
Clock time for diagnostic error occurrence
SD2
SD3
SD4
Error information categories
SD5 to SD15
Error common information
SD16 to SD26
Error individual information
: Device is updated on servo warning.
: Device is not updated on servo warning.
(Note-1): "n" in the device No. indicates the numerical value (axis No.1 to 32 : n= 0 to 31) which correspond
to axis No.
(Note-2): "n" in the device No. indicates the numerical value (n=0 to 7) which correspond to motion error
history.
(e) Error check QDS
Set whether or not to check the battery of Motion CPU. The default value is
set to "Perform battery check". If "Perform battery check" is not set, a selfdiagnosis error (error code: 1600) will not occur and the 7-segment LED
"BT1" or "BT2" is not also displayed. And, a detection of motion error
detection flag (M2039) and update of motion error history are restricted.
However, the devices (SM51, SM52, SM58, SM59) for detection of battery
level turn ON/OFF.
3 - 13
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
POINT
(1) Use this setting to restrict the output of battery error in the incremental system
configuration using ROM operation.
(2) The battery is necessary to use the absolute position system or latch data. Be
sure to set "Perform battery check".
(f) Latch range
Set the following latching ranges for M, B, F, D and W, respectively.
• Latch (1): It is possible clear using the remote operation (Latch clear(1),
Latch clear (1)(2)).
• Latch (2): It is possible clear using the remote operation (Latch clear (1)(2)).
(2) SSCNET setting
QDS
The following explains item to be set in SSCNET setting.
(a) Communication type
Set the communication type to communicate with the servo amplifier for
every line.
• SSCNET /H : MR-J4(W)- B
• SSCNET
: MR-J3(W)- B
3 - 14
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
(3) CPU setting
The following explains item to be set in CPU setting.
• SV22 advanced synchronous control use
• SV13/SV22 virtual mode use
(a) Self CPU installation position setting
Set the installation position of the self CPU installed to the main base.
• Self CPU
: Set the self CPU.
• Other CPU : Set the other CPU.
• CPU (Empty) : Set as empty slot.
(b) Input setting QDS
Set to use the input signal.
There are two kinds of applications of the input and mark detection for the
Built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI).
The same signal can be used simultaneously by the input and mark
detection.
Input setting
Used
Unused
Input signal
Mark detection
Usable as the real input device Usable as the real input device (PX) or
(PX)
mark detection signal (DI)
Unusable
Usable as the mark detection signal (DI)
1) First input No.
Set the first input No. of real input device (PX).
The case of "real input device (PX): units of 16 points" is as follows.
• Real input (PX): 4 points + Dummy (Unusable: Fixed at 0) 12 points
(Example) When the first input No. is set to 0(H).
• PX0 to PX3 (Real input), PX4 to PXF (Unusable: Fixed at 0)
2) High-speed read setting
Set to use the built-in interface in Motion CPU as input signal in the highspeed reading function.
• Used : Use built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI).
• Unused : Not use built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI).
Refer to Section 4.3 for the High-speed reading function.
(Note): This cannot be set in SV22 advanced synchronous control.
QDS
3 - 15
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
(c) Input signal detection direction QDS
Set the detection direction of mark detection signal when the built-in
interface in Motion CPU (DI) is used in the mark detection function.
• Valid on leading edge : Mark detection is executed by turning OFF to ON
the mark detection signal.
• Valid on trailing edge : Mark detection is executed by turning ON to OFF
the mark detection signal.
Refer to Section 4.14 for the mark detection function.
(d) Multiple CPU synchronous control setting QDS Ver.!
When setting self CPU, set the master CPU and slave CPU that constitute
the multiple CPU synchronous control system.
(Note): This can be set only in SV22 advanced synchronous control.
• Independent CPU : Operate as independent CPU
• Master CPU
: Operate as master CPU
• Slave CPU
: Operate as slave CPU
1) Status device setting
When setting the master CPU and slave CPU, set the status devices to
monitor the information of other CPUs. The following items are set with
word device (D, W, #, U \G), or bit device (X, Y, M, B, F).
Item
Multiple CPU synchronous control
setting
Master CPU
Slave CPU
Synchronous controlling
Status for each CPU
Error status for each CPU and axis
Master CPU input axis
Transfer information
Error information
: Settable
: Unsettable
Refer to "Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU Motion controller (SV22) Programming
Manual (Advanced Synchronous Control)" for Multiple CPU synchronous
control.
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
3 - 16
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
(4) Individual module settings
The setting items for each module are shown below.
(a) Setting items for each Motion module
Module
name
Item
DOG signal contact
QDS
Q172DLX
Servo
external
signals
module
(Note-1)
External signal setting
QD
Setting range
Number of usable modules
Q173DSCPU Q172DSCPU Q173DCPU(-S1) Q172DCPU(-S1)
Normal open/Normal close
(Set the DOG signal for 8 Normal open
points.)
Set the number of axes for
which the 8 axes input is
used.
DOG signal detection Valid on leading edge/
direction QD
Valid on trailing edge
I/O response time
setting
Initial value
0.4/0.6/1 ms
(DOG/CHANGE response
time)
Synchronous encoder
Used/Unused
setting
Unused
4
2
4
1
Valid on
leading edge
0.4 ms
Unused
Q171ENC-W8 (4194304
Q171ENC-W8
Synchronous encoder
[PLS])/Q171ENC-W8
(Note-2)
selection
(4194304
(262144[PLS])/ MR-HENC
QDS
[PLS])
(16384[PLS])
Q172DEX
Synchronous encoder
Q170ENC/MR-HENC
Q170ENC
Synchronous
selection QD
encoder
Normal open/Normal close
input module TREN signal contact
(Set the TREN signal for 2 Normal open
(Note-3)
QDS
points.)
Q173DPX
Manual
pulse
generator
input module
I/O response time
setting
0.4/0.6/1 ms
(TREN response time)
0.4 ms
High-speed read
(Note-4)
setting
Used/Unused
Unused
Manual pulse
generator setting
(SV13/SV43)
Used only
Manual pulse
generator/
Used/Unused
Synchronous encoder
setting (SV22)
6 (SV22)
4 (SV22)
Used
P
Used
I/O response time
setting
0.4/0.6/1 ms
(TREN response time)
0.4 ms
High-speed read
(Note-4)
setting
Used/Unused
Unused
1 (SV13)
4 (SV22)
1 (SV13/SV43) 1 (SV13/SV43)
4 (SV22)
3 (SV22)
(Note-1): Set the external signals used in each axis in the servo external signal parameter of servo data setting when using
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU. (Refer to Section 3.4.) QDS
(Note-2): Select the encoder resolution of Q171ENC-W8 from 4194304[PLS] or 262144[PLS] depending on the synchronous encoder
selection setting.
(Note-3): This can be set only in SV22 advanced synchronous control. QDS
(Note-4): This cannot be set in SV22 advanced synchronous control. QDS
3 - 17
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
(b) Setting items for each PLC module
Number of usable modules
Module name
I/O
module
Item
Setting range
First I/O No.
0000 to 0FF0 (in units of 16
points)
Point
16/32/48/64/128/256
High-speed read
Input module
Used/Unused
(Note-4)
setting
QX /
I/O response time
QX setting
1/5/10/20/70 ms
(setting for high-speed
(0.1/0.2/0.4/0.6/1 ms)
input module in
parentheses)
Output
module
QY /
QY Input/Output
composite
module
QH /
QX Y
First I/O No.
0000 to 0FF0 (in units of 16
points)
Point
16/32/48/64/128/256
First I/O No.
0000 to 0FF0 (in units of 16
points)
Point
16/32/48/64/128/256
I/O response time
setting
1/5/10/20/70 ms
High-speed read
(Note-4)
setting
Used/Unused
First I/O No.
Input range
Analogue
input module
Q6 AD /
Temperature drift
Q6 ADcompensation
Resolution mode
Intelligent
function
module
(Note-1)
Analogue
output
module
Q6 DA /
Q6 DA-
Initial value
Used/None
Total 256 points
(Note-3)
or less
Total 256 points
or less
16
Unused
10 ms
(0.2 ms)
0000
16
0000
16
10 ms
0000
4 to 20mA
Used
Normal/High
Normal
Normal (A/D conversion)/
Normal
Operation mode
Offset gain setting
(A/D conversion)
0000 to 0FF0 (in units of 16
First I/O No.
0000
points)
4 to 20mA/0 to 20mA/1 to 5V/
4 to 20mA
Output range
0 to 5V/-10 to 10V/User range
HOLD/CLEAR function CLEAR only
CLEAR
Normal (Asynchronous)/
Normal
Output mode
Synchronous output
(Asynchronous)
Resolution mode
Normal/High
Normal
Normal (D/A conversion)/
Normal
Operation mode
Offset gain setting
(D/A conversion)
3 - 18
Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)
0000
Unused
0000 to 0FF0 (in units of 16
points)
4 to 20mA/0 to 20mA/1 to 5V/
0 to 5V/-10 to 10V/0 to 10V/
User range
Q173DSCPU/
Q172DSCPU
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
Setting items for each PLC module (Continues)
Number of usable modules
Module name
Intelligent
General
function (Note-2)
module
(Note-1)
QDS
Interrupt module
QI60
Ver.!
Item
Setting range
First I/O No.
0000 to 0FF0 (in units of 16
points)
Points
16 points/32 points/48 points/
64 points/128 points/
256 points/
Switch
setting
Input format Binary/Decimal/Hexadecimal
Switch 1 to 5 0000 to FFFF
Initial value
Q173DSCPU/
Q172DSCPU
Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)
Total 256 points
(Note-3)
or less
—
0000
16 points
Hexadecimal
0000
Error time output mode Clear/Maintain
Clear
I/O response time
setting
0.2 ms
0.1/0.2/0.4/0.6/1 ms
1 (SV13/SV22)
(Note-1): A maximum of 4 intelligent function modules can be used.
(Note-2): Refer to Section 4.17 for corresponding intelligent function module.
(Note-3): Number of I/O points is total of "Built-in interface in Motion CPU (Input 4 points) + I/O module +
intelligent function module". QDS
(Note-4): This cannot be set in SV22 advanced synchronous control. QDS
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
3 - 19
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
(5) External signal input
Servo external signal (Upper stroke limit/Lower stroke limit/Stop signal/Proximity
dog) can be selected for every axis from the following methods.
(a) Q172DLX Servo external signals interface module use
• Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
Select "Q172DLX signal" for every axis with signal type in the servo
external signal parameter of servo data setting, and set the module No.
and signal No.
• Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DSCPU(-S1)
Set the servo external signals interface module (Q172DLX) in the Motion
Slot Setting of the System Setting, and then set axis No. in the External
signal setting of the Detailed Setting.
(b) Servo amplifier input device use (Servo amplifier use only)
• Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
Set "Amplifier input" for every axis with signal type in the servo external
signal parameter of servo data setting.
• Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DSCPU(-S1)
Set "Amplifier input valid" as the external signal input setting in the
"Amplifier setting" of system setting.
1) There are following restrictions to use.
• Stop signal (STOP) cannot be used.
• When the Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DSCPU(-S1) is used, count type
home position return or speed/position switching control cannot be
used depending on the operating system software's version. (Refer to
Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.)
• The variation for ON/OFF timing of the external input signal (DOG) of
servo amplifier may occur according to the input filter setting value of
external signal input setting.
Review the input filter setting value compatible with the applications.
Use the Q172DLX or built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI) QDS to
execute the high-accuracy control.
2) The correspondence of external signal and input device is shown below.
External signals
Input device (CN3)
Upper stroke limit (FLS)
DI1
Lower stroke limit (RLS)
DI2
Proximity dog (DOG)
DI3
(Note)
(Note): Refer to the "Servo Amplifier Instruction Manual" for pin configurations.
3) Set the external signal setting in the "Input Filter Setting".
(Note): The setting value set by "Input Filter Setting" of system setting is
valid even if the input filter setting is set by servo parameter
"Input filter setting (PD11)".
(c) Input device use QDS
Select "Bit device" for every axis with signal type in the servo external signal
parameter of servo data setting, and set the device No.
3 - 20
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
3.2 I/O Number Assignment
In the Multiple CPU system, I/O numbers are used for interactive transmission
between the Motion CPU and I/O modules and intelligent function modules, or
between PLC CPU and Motion CPU.
3.2.1 I/O number assignment of each module
The Multiple CPU system is different from the Single CPU system in the position (slot) of
I/O number "0H" for PLC CPU.
However, I/O number of control module can be assigned independently for each CPU for
Motion CPU.
(1) Position of I/O number "0H"
(a) The number of slots set with the Multiple CPU settings are occupied by the
PLC CPU/Motion CPU on the Multiple CPU system.
(b) I/O modules and intelligent function modules are installed from the right of the
slots occupied by PLC CPU/Motion CPU.
(c) I/O number of Motion CPU control module can be assigned independently for
each CPU.
The I/O number of PLC CPU control module for an I/O module or intelligent
function module mounted to the next slot to those occupied by CPU modules
is set as "0H" and consecutive numbers are then allocated sequentially to the
right.
(d) Notation of I/O number
• Receiving of ON/OFF data by Motion CPU is deemed input (PX), while
outputting of ON/OFF data from Motion CPU is deemed output (PY).
• I/O number is expressed in hexadecimal.
REMARK
1) If the number of CPU modules installed on the main base unit is less than the
number set at the "Multiple CPU setting", set the open slot(s) to "PLC (Empty)".
Refer to Section 2.1.2 for the "PLC (Empty)" setting.
2) The I/O numbers for the Multiple CPU system can be confirmed with the system
monitor of GX Works2/GX Developer.
3 - 21
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
(2) I/O number assignment of Motion CPU control module
Mitsubishi recommends that I/O No. assignment be set as consecutive No. that
are common throughout all CPUs.
However, the I/O number of input modules, output modules, input/output
composite modules, and intelligent function modules controlled with the Motion
CPU can also be set with no relation to the I/O number of PLC CPU.
(I/O number of the Motion CPU control modules is indicated as PX/PY.)
I/O number of the Motion CPU control modules cannot be assigned by I/O
assignment settings of PLC CPU.
Power supply
module
I/O assignment
0
1
2
3
4
5
Q03UD
CPU
Q173D(S)
CPU
QX41
QY41P
QX41
QY41P
PX0 to PX1F PY20 to PX3F X40 to X5F
CPU No. 1
CPU No. 2
(X0 to X1F)
(Y20 to Y3F)
CPU No. 2
control
module
CPU No. 2
control
module
CPU No. 1
control
module
Y60 to Y7F
CPU No. 1
control
module
(3) Setting of the Motion CPU control modules by the PLC CPU
Follow the table below when Motion CPU control modules are set in I/O
Assignment Settings of the PLC CPU. (The PLC CPU handles the Q172DLX,
Q172DEX and Q173DPX as intelligent function modules having 32 occupied
points.) Type and number of points may be left unset.
Module name
Input module
Type
QX H
Hi, Input
Hi, Input/Interrupt
Output module
Output
Input/Output composite
module
I/O Mix
(Note-1)
Remarks
Input
QX -S1
Intelligent
function
module
Number of points
Analogue input
module
Analogue output
module
Intelligent
Selected according to
• For the control CPU, set the
the module.
CPU that corresponds to
the Motion CPU (required).
• Type and number of points
may be left unset.
General
Interrupt module (QI60)
Interrupt
16 points
Intelligent
32 points
Q172DLX
Q172DEX
Q173DPX
(Note-1): Refer to Section 4.17 for corresponding intelligent function module.
POINT
(1) Set the I/O device of the Motion CPU within the range from PX/PY000 to
PX/PYFFF. Set the number of real I/O points within 256 points. (I/O No. may
not be consecutive.)
(2) As for the Motion CPU, the Q172DLX, Q172DEX, Q173DPX and QI60 are not
included in the number of real I/O points.
3 - 22
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
3.2.2 I/O number of each CPU modules
In the Multiple CPU system, I/O numbers are assigned to each CPU module to specify
installed CPU modules.
The I/O number for each CPU module is fixed to the corresponding slot and cannot be
changed.
The I/O number allocated to each CPU module in the Multiple CPU system is shown
below.
CPU module
installation position
CPU slot
Slot 0
Slot 1
Slot 2
First I/O number
3E00H
3E10H
3E20H
3E30H
The I/O number of PLC CPU/Motion CPU are used in the following cases.
• When writing data to the CPU shared memory of self CPU using the S. TO instruction.
• When reading data from the CPU shared memory of other CPU using the FROM
instruction.
• When reading data from the CPU shared memory of other CPU using an intelligent
function module device (U \G )
• When reading device data directly from the Motion CPU from the PLC CPU using the
"D(P).DDRD" instruction.
• When writing device data directly to the Motion CPU from the PLC CPU using the
"D(P).DDWR" instruction.
Refer to Section 2.3.6 or the "Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller
(SV13/SV22) Programming Manual (Motion SFC)" for the Motion dedicated PLC
instruction.
3 - 23
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
3.2.3 I/O number setting
Set the modules installed in each slot of the main base or extension base and assign
the control CPU of applicable slot as the self CPU in the Motion Slot setting of the
system setting for Motion CPU.
Set the I/O No. of modules controlled with the Motion CPU module.
The following modules must be set the I/O No.
• Input module
• Output module
• Input/Output composite module
(Note-1)
• Intelligent function module
(Note-1): Refer to Section 4.17 for corresponding intelligent function module.
Select the applicable module in the Motion slot setting, and set I/O No. in "First I/O
No." of the Detail setting.
Refer to the help of MT Developer2 for details.
Set "First I/O No."
POINT
I/O No.s cannot be assigned automatically, unlike a PLC CPU for which I/O No. are
assigned automatically if such setting is omitted in the Motion CPU. In the Motion
CPU, be sure to set the first I/O No. in System Settings for each module used.
3 - 24
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
3.3 Servo Parameters
The servo parameters control the data fixed by the specifications of the servo amplifier
and servomotor controlled in the parameter set for each axis and the control of the
servomotor.
The servo parameters are set by the Setup software (MR Configurator ).
Refer to the "Servo amplifier Instruction Manual" for details of the servo parameters.
Refer to the help for handling of MR Configurator .
Servo amplifier Instruction Manual list is shown below.
Servo amplifier type
Instruction manual name
MR-J4- B
SSCNET /H interface MR-J4- B Servo amplifier Instruction Manual (SH-030106)
MR-J4W- B
SSCNET /H interface Multi-axis AC Servo MR-J4W- B Servo amplifier Instruction
Manual (SH-030105)
MR-J3- B
SSCNET
MR-J3W- B
SSCNET interface 2-axis AC Servo Amplifier MR-J3W- B Servo amplifier Instruction
Manual (SH-030073)
MR-J3- B-RJ004
SSCNET
MR-J3- B-RJ006
SSCNET Compatible Fully Closed Loop Control MR-J3- B-RJ006 Servo amplifier
Instruction Manual (SH-030056)
MR-J3- B-RJ080W
SSCNET interface Direct Drive Servo MR-J3- B-RJ080W Servo amplifier Instruction
Manual (SH-030079)
MR-J3- B Safety
SSCNET interface Drive Safety integrated MR-J3- B Safety Servo amplifier Instruction
Manual (SH-030084)
interface MR-J3- B Servo amplifier Instruction Manual (SH-030051)
Compatible Linear Servo MR-J3- B-RJ004 Instruction Manual (SH-030054)
POINTS
When the parameter that should turn on servo amplifier power supply again is
changed, make the Multiple CPU system reset or power supply OFF to ON. And,
once turn OFF the servo amplifier's power supply and then turn ON it again.
3 - 25
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
3.4 Servo External Signal Parameters
QDS
This parameter is used to the servo external signal (Upper stroke limit (FLS), Lower
stroke limit (RLS), Stop signal (STOP), Proximity dog/Speed-position switching
(DOG/CHANGE)) used for each axis.
The setting items for servo external signal are shown below.
Servo external signal parameter list
Setting range
Item
Invalid
Signal type
0: Invalid
Q172DLX module No.
FLS
Q172DLX signal No.
signal Device
Contact
Signal type
RLS
Q172DLX signal No.
signal Device
Contact
Signal type
Q172DLX module No.
STOP Q172DLX signal No.
signal Device
Contact
Signal type
DOG
Q172DLX signal No.
signal
Device
Contact
DI signal
1: Q172DLX signal 2: Amplifier input
Bit device
Default
value
4: Bit device
0: Invalid
1 to 4
—
—
—
—
1 to 8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0: Normal open
1: Normal close
0: Normal open
1: Normal close
—
1: Q172DLX signal 2: Amplifier input
Bit device
—
0: Normal open
1: Normal close
—
4: Bit device
0: Invalid
—
1 to 4
—
—
—
—
1 to 8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0: Normal open
1: Normal close
0: Normal open
1: Normal close
0: Invalid
—
—
Bit device
—
0: Normal open
1: Normal close
—
1: Q172DLX signal
4: Bit device
0: Invalid
1 to 4
—
—
—
1 to 8
—
—
—
—
—
0: Normal open
1: Normal close
0: Invalid
Q172DLX module No./
DI signal name
Amplifier input
—
0: Invalid
Q172DLX module No.
Q172DLX signal
—
1: Q172DLX signal 2: Amplifier input
Bit device
—
0: Normal open
1: Normal close
—
3: DI signal
4: Bit device
0: Invalid
1 to 4
—
—
—
1 to 4
—
1 to 8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Bit device
—
0: Normal open
1: Normal close
—
—
—
(Note-1)
—
—
0: Normal open
1: Normal close
—
(Note-2)
(Note-1): Select "Q172DLX" in the motion slot setting of system setting, and set the contact in the detail setting.
(Note-2): Set the contact in the "CPU setting" of system setting.
(1) Signal type
Set the signal type to use as the servo external signal.
(a) Invalid
The servo external signal is invalid.
(b) Q172DLX signal
The signal (FLS/RLS/STOP/DOG) of Q172DLX is used as the external
signal.
3 - 26
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
(c) Amplifier input
The input signal of servo amplifier is used as the following servo external
signals.
Input signal
Servo external signal
DI1
Upper stroke limit (FLS)
DI2
Lower stroke limit (RLS)
DI3
Proximity dog (DOG)
(d) DI signal
The built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI1 to DI4) is used as the proximity
dog/speed-position switching (DOG/CHANGE)).
Set the DOG signal only.
(e) Bit device
The optional bit device is used as the servo external signal.
(2) Q172DLX module No.
Set the module No. of Q172DLX.
From the Q172DLX installed in the smallest number is set to No.1 to 4.
Set this item when only "Q172DLX signal" is selected with the signal type.
Module No. setting range
1 to 4
(3) Q172DLX signal No.
Set the signal No. of servo external signal.
Set this item when only "Q172DLX signal" is selected with the signal type.
Signal No. setting range
1 to 8
(4) Device
Usable devices are shown below.
Item
Device No. setting range
X0 to X1FFF
Input relay
(Note-1)
Output relay
Y0 to Y1FFF
Internal relay
M0 to M8191
Link relay
B0 to B1FFF
Annunciator
F0 to F2047
Special relay
SM0 to SM1999
Multiple CPU area device
U \G10000.0 to U \G (10000+p-1).F
(Note-2)
(Note-1): The range of "PXn+4 to PXn+F" cannot be used (fixed at 0) for the input device
(PXn+0 to PXn+F) allocated to the built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI).
(n: First input No.)
(Note-2): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area for each CPU.
Refer to Chapter 2 for the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high
speed transmission area.
3 - 27
3 COMMON PARAMETERS
(5) Contact
Set the signal contact used as the servo external signal.
For Q172DLX signal, select "Q172DLX" in the motion slot setting of system
setting, and set this item in the details setting.
For DI signal, set this item in the "CPU setting" of system setting
(a) Normal open
• FLS signal ON
: The upper stroke limit is detected, and "operation of
direction that the feed current value increase" cannot
be executed.
• RLS signal ON : The lower stroke limit is detected, and "operation of
direction that the feed current value decrease" cannot
be executed.
• STOP signal ON : The stop signal is detected, and an operation stops.
• DOG signal ON : The proximity dog/speed-position switching signal is
detected, and the home position return operation and
speed-position control switching is executed.
(b) Normal close
• FLS signal OFF
: The upper stroke limit is detected, and "operation of
direction that the feed current value increase" cannot
be executed.
• RLS signal OFF : The lower stroke limit is detected, and "operation of
direction that the feed current value decrease" cannot
be executed.
• STOP signal OFF : The stop signal is detected, and an operation stops.
• DOG signal OFF : The proximity dog/speed-position switching signal is
detected, and the home position return operation and
speed-position control switching is executed.
3 - 28
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4. AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.1 Limit Switch Output Function
This function is used to output the ON/OFF signal corresponding to the data range of
the watch data set per output device.
Motion control data or optional word data can be used as watch data. (Refer to Section
"4.1.2 Limit output setting data" for details.) A maximum output device for 32 points can
be set regardless of the number of axes.
POINT
For SV22 advanced synchronous control, specifications are different from those of
the conventional limit switch output function and a maximum output device of 64
points can be set. (Refer to Section 4.1.3 and Section 4.1.4 for details.) QDS
4
4.1.1 Operations
(1) ON output to an output device is made while the watch data value is in the ON
output region set with (ON Value) and (OFF Value) in the limit switch output
function.
(a) (ON Value), (OFF Value) and watch data value are handled as signed data.
ON output region where an ON output is made to the output device is
governed by the magnitude relationship between (ON Value) and (OFF
Value) as indicated below.
Relationship between (ON Value) and
ON output region
(OFF Value)
(ON Value)  (watch data value) < (OFF Value)
(ON Value) < (OFF Value)
(ON Value)  (watch data value)
(ON Value) > (OFF Value)
(Watch data value) < (OFF Value)
(ON Value) = (OFF Value)
Output OFF in whole region
1) (ON Value) < (OFF Value)
ON
Output device
OFF
OFF
OFF Value
ON section setting
ON Value
Watch data value
(ON Value) < (Watch data value) < (OFF Value)
4-1
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
2) (ON Value) > (OFF Value)
ON
ON
Output device
OFF
OFF Value
ON section setting
ON Value
Watch data value
(ON Value) < (Watch data value)
(Watch data value) < (OFF Value)
3) (ON Value) = (OFF Value)
Output device
OFF in whole region
ON section setting
ON Value
OFF Value
Watch data value
(b) The limit switch outputs are controlled based on each watch data during the
PCPU READY complete status (SM500: ON) by the PLC ready flag (M2000)
from OFF to ON.
When the PCPU READY complete flag (SM500) turns OFF by turning the
PLC ready flag (M2000) from ON to OFF, all points turn OFF. When (ON
Value) and (OFF Value) are specified with word devices, the word device
contents are input to the internal area when the PLC ready flag (M2000) turns
from OFF to ON.
After that, the word device contents are input per motion operation cycle, and
limit switch outputs are controlled.
(c) Multiple outputs (Up to 32 points) can be also set to one watch data. In each
setting, the output device may be the same.
If multiple ON section settings have been made to the same output device,
the logical add of the output results in the regions is output.
ON
ON
Output device
OFF
ON section setting No.1
OFF Value
ON Value
ON section setting No.2
OFF Value
ON Value
OFF
OFF
Watch data value
(2) Output enable/disable bit can be set and executed enable/disable of the limit
switch outputs point-by-point.
Limit switch output control is executed when the output enable/disable bit is ON,
and the output is OFF when it is OFF.
If there is no setting, the outputs are always enabled.
4-2
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(3) Forced output bit can be set and turned the forcibly output of the limit switch
outputs point-by-point ON.
The output is ON when the forced output bit is ON. Priority is given to control of
this setting over off (disable) of the "output enable/disable bit".
If there is no setting, no forced outputs are not always made.
(4) When the multiple watch data, ON region, output enable/disable bit and forced
output bit are set to the same output device, the logical add of output results of the
settings is output.
SM500
ON
1) Without output enable/disable bit/forced output settings
Output device
OFF Value
ON section setting
ON Value
Watch data value
2) With output enable/disable bit/forced output settings
Output device
Output OFF
Output control based on
ON Value and OFF Value
Output ON
(Forced output) Output OFF
Output OFF
Output control based on
ON Value and OFF Value
Output OFF
Enable/disable bit
Forced output bit
Output ON
(Forced output)
4-3
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.1.2 Limit output setting data
Limit output data list are shown below.
Up to 32 points of output devices can be set.
(The following items of No.1 to No.5 are set together as one point.)
No.
Item
Setting range
1
Output device
Bit device (X, Y, M, B, U \G)
2
Watch data
Motion control data/ word device (D, W, #, U \G)
(16-bit integer type/32-bit integer type/
64-bit floating-point type)
3
ON section ON Value
setting
OFF Value
Word device (D, W, #, U
4
Output enable/disable
bit
Bit device (X, Y, M, B, F, SM, U \G)/none (default)
5
Forced output bit
Bit device (X, Y, M, B, F, SM, U \G)/none (default)
Fetch cycle
Refresh
cycle
—
Operation
cycle
Remarks
—
\G)/constant (K, H)
Operation
cycle
—
ON : Enable
OFF : Disable
None : Always enable
None : No forced outputs
are always made
(OFF status)
(1) Output device
(a) Set the bit device which outputs the ON/OFF signal toward the preset watch
data.
(b) As the output device, the following devices can be used.
Item
Input relay
Device No. setting range
(Note-1)
Output relay
X0 to X1FFF
(Note-2)
Internal relay
(Note-4)
Y0 to Y1FFF
(Note-3)
M0 to M8191
Link relay
B0 to B1FFF
Multiple CPU area device
U \G10000.0 to U \G (10000+p-1).F
(Note-5), (Note-6)
(Note-1): PX is write-disabled and it cannot be used as the output device.
For X, only the free No. of the input card non-loading can be used.
(Note-2): The real output device range (PY) is also included.
(Note-3): M2001 to M2032 cannot be used to the output device.
Be careful because it affect a positioning operation, when the positioning
dedicated devices are set.
(Note-4): The range of "PXn+4 to PXn+F" cannot be used (fixed at 0) for the input
device (PXn+0 to PXn+F) allocated to the built-in interface in Motion CPU
(DI). (n: First input No.)
QDS
(Note-5): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area for each CPU.
(Note-6): Only device of the self CPU can be used.
4-4
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(2) Watch data
(a) This data is used to perform the limit switch output function. This data is
comparison data to output the ON/OFF signal. The output device is
ON/OFF-controlled according to the ON section setting.
(b) As the watch data, motion control data or optional word device data can be
used.
1) Motion control data
a) SV13/SV22
Item
Feed current value
Real current value
Unit
Position
command
Deviation counter value
PLS
Motor current
0.1%
Motor speed
(Note-1)
Data type
Axis No. setting range
Q173DSCPU
Q172DSCPU
Q173DCPU(-S1) Q172DCPU(-S1)
32-bit
integer type
—
16-bit
integer type
1 to 32
0.1r/min
1 to 16
1 to 32
Cam axis 1 revolution
current value
1 to 8
Feed current value (Virtual)
Current value after
differential gear (Virtual)
PLS
Remarks
32-bit
integer type
Encoder current value after
differential gear (Virtual)
1 to 12
Valid in
SV22
virtual
mode only
Valid in
SV22 only
Encoder current value
(Note-1): The motor speed ( 0.1[mm/s]) is stored at linear servo use.
b) SV43
Item
Machine value
Real machine value
Unit
Position
command
Deviation counter value
PLS
Motor current
0.1%
Motor speed
(Note-1)
Current value
Data type
Axis No. setting range
Q173DCPU(-S1)
Q172DCPU(-S1)
1 to 32
1 to 8
Remarks
32-bit
integer type
16-bit
integer type
—
0.1r/min
32-bit
Position
integer type
command
(Note-1): The motor speed (
4-5
0.1[mm/s]) is stored at linear servo use.
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
2) Word device data
Item
Device No. setting range
Data register
D0 to D8191
Link register
W0 to W1FFF
Motion register
#0 to #9215
Multiple CPU area device
U \G10000 to U \G (10000+p-1)
(Note-1)
(Note-1): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area for each CPU.
3) The following data type is set as the data type to be compared.
Data type
Remarks
16-bit integer type
—
32-bit integer type
64-bit floating-point type
Set the device No. as an even No.
(3) ON section setting
(a) The data range which makes the output device turn ON/OFF toward the
watch data.
(b) The following devices can be used as the ON Value and OFF Value of the
data range.
The data type of device/constant to be set is the same as the type of watch
data.
Item
Device No. setting range
Data register
D0 to D8191
Link register
W0 to W1FFF
Motion register
#0 to #9215
Multiple CPU area device
U \G10000 to U \G (10000+p-1)
Constant
(Note-1)
Hn/Kn
(Note-1) : "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area for each CPU.
(4) Output enable/disable bit
(a) Set the status of output enable/disable bit when the limit switch output is
forbidden during operation.
The following control is exercised.
Output enable/disable bit
Without setting
Limit switch output is turned ON/OFF based on the
(always enable)
With setting
Control description
ON (enable)
ON section setting (ON Value, OFF Value).
OFF (disable) Limit switch output is turned OFF.
4-6
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(b) Usable devices
Item
Input relay
Device No. setting range
(Note-1)
Output relay
X0 to X1FFF
(Note-3)
(Note-2)
Y0 to Y1FFF
Internal relay
M0 to M8191
Link relay
B0 to B1FFF
Annunciator
F0 to F2047
Special relay
SM0 to SM1999
U \G10000.0 to U \G (10000+p-1).F
Multiple CPU area device
(Note-4)
(Note-1): The real input range(PX) is included.
(Note-2): The range of "PXn+4 to PXn+F" cannot be used (fixed at 0) for the input
device (PXn+0 to PXn+F) allocated to the built-in interface in Motion CPU
(DI). (n: First input No.)
QDS
(Note-3): The real input range(PY) is included.
(Note-4): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area for each CPU.
(5) Forced output bit
(a) Set the "forced output bit" when you want to forcibly provide the limit switch
outputs during operation.
The following control is exercised.
Output enable/disable bit
Without setting
With setting
Control description
Limit switch outputs are turned ON/OFF on the basis
of the "output enable/disable bit" and ON section
OFF
setting (ON Value, OFF Value).
ON
Limit switch outputs are turned ON.
(b) Usable devices
Item
Device No. setting range
X0 to X1FFF
Input relay
(Note-1)
Output relay
Y0 to Y1FFF
Internal relay
M0 to M8191
Link relay
B0 to B1FFF
Annunciator
F0 to F2047
Special relay
SM0 to SM1999
Multiple CPU area device
U \G10000.0 to U \G (10000+p-1).F
(Note-2)
(Note-1): The range of "PXn+4 to PXn+F" cannot be used (fixed at 0) for the input
device (PXn+0 to PXn+F) allocated to the built-in interface in Motion CPU
(DI). (n: First input No.)
QDS
(Note-2): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area for each CPU.
POINT
Refer to Chapter 2 for the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area.
4-7
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.1.3 Operations (SV22 advanced synchronous control only)
QDS
Ver.!
(1) ON output to an output device is made while the watch data value is in the ON
region set with lower limit value and upper limit value in the limit switch output
function.
Up to two ON regions can be set for each limit output setting data.
(a) Lower limit value, upper limit value and watch data value are handled as
signed data.
ON output region where an ON output is made to the output device is
governed by the magnitude relationship between lower limit value and upper
limit value as indicated below.
Relationship between lower limit value and
ON output region
upper limit value
Lower limit value < Upper limit value
Lower limit value  (watch data value) < Upper
limit value
Lower limit value > Upper limit value
Lower limit value = Upper limit value
Lower limit value  (watch data value)
(Watch data value) < Upper limit value
Output OFF in whole region
1) Lower limit value < Upper limit value
ON
Output device
OFF
OFF
Upper limit value
ON section setting
Lower limit value
Watch data value
Lower limit value < (Watch data value) < Upper limit value
2) Lower limit value > Upper limit value
ON
Output device
ON
OFF
Upper limit value
ON section setting
Lower limit value
Watch data value
(Watch data value) < Upper limit value
Lower limit value < (Watch data value)
3) Lower limit value = Upper limit value
Output device
ON section setting
OFF in whole region
Lower limit value Upper limit value
Watch data value
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
4-8
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(b) The limit switch outputs are controlled based on each watch data during the
READY complete status (SM500: ON) by the PLC ready flag (M2000) from
OFF to ON.
With the setting of "M2000 keep the output device when turns OFF" invalid,
when the READY complete flag (SM500) turns OFF by turning the PLC ready
flag (M2000) from ON to OFF, all points turn OFF.
With the setting of "M2000 keep the output device when turns OFF" valid for
output devices other than Y devices, the output devices do not turn OFF even
when the PLC ready flag (M2000) turns from ON to OFF. The setting is valid
for all the output devices.
Y devices always turn OFF when the PLC ready flag (M2000) turns from ON
to OFF.
When lower limit value and upper limit value are specified with word devices,
the word device contents are input to the internal area when the PLC ready
flag (M2000) turns from OFF to ON.
After that, the word device contents are input per motion operation cycle, and
limit switch outputs are controlled.
(c) Multiple outputs (Up to 64 points) can be also set to one watch data. In each
setting, the output device may be the same.
If both of the two regions of the ON section setting are used or if the same
output device is designated by multiple output settings (regardless of whether
or not the watch data is the same), the logical add of the output results in the
regions is output.
ON
ON
Output device
OFF
ON section setting No.2
Upper limit value
Lower limit value
ON section setting No.1
Upper limit value
Lower limit value
OFF
OFF
Watch data value
(2) Forced OFF bit can be set to forcibly turn off the output of the output device pointby-point.
When the forced OFF bit is ON, the output is OFF.
(3) Forced ON bit can be set to forcibly turn on the output of the output device pointby-point.
When the forced ON bit is ON, the output is ON.
Priority is given to control of this setting over ON of the "forced OFF bit" (forced
output OFF).
4-9
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.1.4 Limit output setting data (SV22 advanced synchronous control only)
QDS
Ver.!
Limit output data list are shown below.
Up to 64 points of output devices can be set.
(The following items of No.2 to No.7 are set together as one point.)
No.
1
2
3
4
5
Item
Setting range
M2000 keep the output device
when turns OFF
Invalid (default)/valid
Output device
Bit device (X, Y, M, B, U \G)
16 point unit batch output
setting
Watch data
Motion control data/word device (D, W, #, U \G)/
word device (ring counter) (D, W, #, U \G)
(16-bit integer type/32-bit integer type)
16-bit integer type: K1 to K32767, H0001 to H7FFF
32-bit integer type: K1 to K2147483647,
H00000001 to H7FFFFFFF
ON section Upper limit value
setting 2
Lower limit value
Remarks
—
Operation
cycle
Invalid (default)/valid
-5000000 to 5000000[µs]
Word device (D, W, #, U \G)
ON section Upper limit value
setting 1
Lower limit value
Refresh
cycle
—
Limit output compensation time
Ring counter value
(At word device (ring
counter) selection)
Fetch cycle
Word device (D, W, #, U
\G)/constant (K, H)
6
Forced OFF bit
Bit device (X, Y, M, B, F, SM, U \G)/none (default)
7
Forced ON bit
Bit device (X, Y, M, B, F, SM, U \G)/none (default)
Operation
cycle
—
—
—
Operation
cycle
(1) M2000 keep the output device when turns OFF
With this setting valid for output devices other than Y devices, the output devices
do not turn OFF even when the PLC ready flag (M2000) turns from ON to OFF.
The setting is valid for all the output devices. Y devices always turn OFF when
the PLC ready flag (M2000) turns from ON to OFF.
(2) Output device
(a) Set the bit device which outputs the ON/OFF signal toward the preset watch
data.
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
4 - 10
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(b) As the output device, the following devices can be used.
Item
Input relay
Device No. setting range
(Note-1)
Output relay
X0 to X1FFF
(Note-2)
Internal relay
(Note-4)
Y0 to Y1FFF
(Note-3)
M0 to M8191
Link relay
B0 to B1FFF
Multiple CPU area device
U \G10000.0 to U \G (10000+p-1).F
(Note-5), (Note-6)
(Note-1): PX is write-disabled and it cannot be used as the output device.
For X, only the free No. of the input card non-loading can be used.
(Note-2): The real output device range (PY) is also included.
(Note-3): Be careful because it affect a positioning operation, when the positioning
dedicated devices are set.
(Note-4): The range of "PXn+4 to PXn+F" cannot be used (fixed at 0) for the input
device (PXn+0 to PXn+F) allocated to the built-in interface in Motion CPU
(DI). (n: First input No.)
QDS
(Note-5): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area for each CPU.
(Note-6): Only device of the self CPU can be used.
(c) When the 16 point unit batch output setting is valid, the batch output of the
sequential 16 point unit devices has less effect on the operation cycle as
compared with the output of each output device point-by-point.
When the 16 point unit batch output setting is valid, it is recommended to set
multiple output devices as sequential 16 point unit output devices.
The sequential devices to be output in a 16 point unit batch is counted as
one set and up to 4 sets can be set.
When the 16 point unit batch output setting is valid, among the 16 point unit
devices, the devices that are not used as the output devices are always OFF.
16 point unit batch
Control description
output setting
Invalid
The output device is output point-by-point.
Valid
The sequential 16-point output devices are output in a batch.
4 - 11
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(3) Limit output compensation time
(a) Compensate the output timing of the output device.
Set it to compensate for output signal delays. (Set a positive value to
compensate for a delay.)
The timing is compensated as "-5000000" when the compensation time is
set to less than -5000000, and it is compensated as "5000000" when it is set
to more than 500000.
1) Direct designation
Setting range
-5000000 to 5000000[µs]
2) Indirect designation
Device No. setting range
Item
Data register
D0 to D8191
Link register
W0 to W1FFF
Motion register
(Note-1)
#0 to #9215
Multiple CPU area device
U \G10000 to U \G (10000+p-1)
(Note-2)
(Note-1): Set an even number as the first device.
(Note-2): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area for each CPU.
4 - 12
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(4) Watch data
(a) This data is used to perform the limit switch output function. This data is
comparison data to output the ON/OFF signal. The output device is
ON/OFF-controlled according to the ON section setting.
(b) As the watch data, motion control data, word device data or word device
data (ring counter) can be used.
1) Motion control data
Item
Unit
Axis No. setting range
Data type
Q173DSCPU
Q172DSCPU
Remarks
Feed current value
Real current value
Control unit
Motor real current value
32-bit
integer type
Servo command value
Position feed back
PLS
Absolute position encoder single revolution position
Absolute position encoder multiple revolution position
—
Deviation counter value
PLS
Servo command speed
PLS/s
Motor speed
0.01r/min
Motor current value
0.1%
—
16-bit
integer type
1 to 32
1 to 16
32-bit
integer type
16-bit
integer type
Command generation axis feed current value
Command generation axis cumulative current value
Control unit
Command generation axis current value per cycle
Synchronous encoder axis current value
Encoder axis
unit
Synchronous encoder axis current value per cycle
Cam axis current value per cycle
32-bit
integer type
1 to 12
Cam axis
cycle unit
Cam axis current value per cycle (Actual)
Valid in
synchronous
control
1 to 32
1 to 16
2) Word device data/word device data (ring counter)
Item
Device No. setting range
Data register
D0 to D19823
Link register
W0 to W1FFF
Motion register
#0 to #9215
Multiple CPU area device
U \G10000 to U \G (10000+p-1)
(Note-1)
(Note-1): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area for each CPU.
3) The following data type is set as the data type to be compared.
Data type
Remarks
16-bit integer type
—
32-bit integer type
Set the device No. as an even No.
4 - 13
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(c) Ring counter value
When the watch data is the word device data (ring counter), the ring counter
value is set.
Data type
Remarks
16-bit integer type
H0001 to H7FFF
32-bit integer type
K1 to K2147483647, H00000001 to H7FFFFFFF
ON
Without output device
OFF
compensation time
OFF
Ring counter value
ON section
setting
Upper limit setting
Lower limit setting
0
POINT
For the word device data updated as ring counter, when the output timing is
compensated without setting the correct ring counter value or when the output
timing is compensated by setting the ring counter for the word device data that is
not updated as ring counter, the output device may not be output at the correct
timing.
(5) ON section setting
(a) The data range which makes the output device turn ON/OFF toward the
watch data.
Up to two ON regions can be set for each limit output setting data.
(b) The following devices can be used as the lower limit value and upper limit
value of the data range.
The data type of device/constant to be set is the same as the type of watch
data.
Item
Device No. setting range
Data register
D0 to D8191
Link register
W0 to W1FFF
Motion register
#0 to #9215
Multiple CPU area device
U \G10000 to U \G (10000+p-1)
Constant
(Note-1)
Hn/Kn
(Note-1): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area for each CPU.
4 - 14
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(6) Forced OFF bit
(a) Set the "forced OFF bit" when forced OFF of the output device is desired
during operation.
The following control is exercised.
Forced OFF bit
Without setting
With setting
Control description
Output device is turned ON/OFF based on the ON
OFF
section setting.
ON
Output device is turned OFF.
(b) Usable devices
Item
Input relay
Device No. setting range
(Note-1)
Output relay
X0 to X1FFF
(Note-3)
(Note-2)
Y0 to Y1FFF
Internal relay
M0 to M12287
Link relay
B0 to B1FFF
Annunciator
F0 to F2047
Special relay
SM0 to SM1999
Multiple CPU area device
U \G10000.0 to U \G (10000+p-1).F
(Note-4)
(Note-1): The real input range(PX) is included.
(Note-2): The range of "PXn+4 to PXn+F" cannot be used (fixed at 0) for the input
device (PXn+0 to PXn+F) allocated to the built-in interface in Motion CPU
(DI). (n: First input No.)
(Note-3): The real input range(PY) is included.
(Note-4): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area for each CPU.
4 - 15
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(7) Forced ON bit
(a) Set the "forced ON bit" when forced ON of the output device is desired
during operation.
The following control is exercised.
Forced ON bit
Without setting
With setting
Control description
Output device is turned ON/OFF based on the ON
OFF
section setting .
ON
Output device is turned ON.
(b) Usable devices
Item
Device No. setting range
X0 to X1FFF
Input relay
(Note-1)
Output relay
Y0 to Y1FFF
Internal relay
M0 to M8191
Link relay
B0 to B1FFF
Annunciator
F0 to F2047
Special relay
SM0 to SM1999
Multiple CPU area device
U \G10000.0 to U \G (10000+p-1).F
(Note-2)
(Note-1): The range of "PXn+4 to PXn+F" cannot be used (fixed at 0) for the input
device (PXn+0 to PXn+F) allocated to the built-in interface in Motion CPU
(DI). (n: First input No.)
(Note-2): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area for each CPU.
POINT
Refer to Chapter 2 for the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area.
4 - 16
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.2 Absolute Position System
The positioning control for absolute position system can be performed using the
absolute-position-compatible servomotors and servo amplifiers.
If the machine position is set at the system starting, home position return is not
necessary because the absolute position is detected at the power on.
The machine position is set with the home position return using the Motion SFC
program (SV13/SV22)/Motion program (SV43) or MT Developer2.
(1) Conditions of the absolute position system start
Perform a home position return after machine adjustment at the absolute position
system start.
(2) In the absolute positioning system, the absolute position may be lost in the
following cases:
Set the absolute position with a home position return.
(a) The battery unit is removed or replaced.
(b) The battery error of the servo amplifier occurs. (It is detected at the servo
amplifier power on).
(c) The machine system is disturbed by a shock.
(d) The cable between servo amplifier and encoder is removed, or the servo
amplifier or encoder is replaced.
(3) The current value history can be monitored using of the "System setting allowable
travel during power off" or "Monitor" using a MT Developer2.
(Refer to the help of MT Developer2 or details.)
4 - 17
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(4) If a major error (error code: 1202, 12020) occurs because of a communication
error between the servo amplifier and encoder, home position return request
(M2409+20n) turns ON, and absolute data is erased.
However, the erasing of the absolute data can be avoided with the following
combinations.
Operating system software
Q173DSCPU/
Q172DSCPU
Servo amplifier
Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)
Model name
Software
version
Operation of home position
return request (M2409+20n)
when error occurs
MR-J3- B
MR-J3- B-RJ006
C3 or later
MR-J3- B Safety
MR-J3- B-RJ004
00B or later
00S or later
MR-J3- B-RJ080W
MR-J3W- B
C5 or later
B1 or later
Home position return request
(M2409+20n: OFF) does not
(Note-1)
turn ON.
MR-J4- B
MR-J4- B-RJ
—
MR-J4W- B
Others
Home position return request
(M2409+20n: ON) turns ON.
(absolute data is lost)
—: There is no restriction by the version.
(Note-1): The history for the number of times a major error (error code: 1202, 12020) occurred is not
displayed in the current value history for MT Developer2 that does not support the display of the
current value history of the past 10 times. Use a version of MT Developer2 that supports the display
of the current value history of the past 10 times. (Refer to Section 1.5.)
CAUTION
After removing or replacing the battery unit, correctly install the new unit and set the absolute
position.
After a servo amplifier battery error occurs, eliminate the cause of the error and ensure
operation is safe before setting the absolute position.
After the mechanical system is disturbed by a shock, make the necessary checks and repairs,
and ensure operation is safe before setting the absolute position.
POINT
(1) The address setting range of absolute position system is -2147483648 to
2147483647. It is not possible to restore position commands that exceed this
limit, or current values after a power interruption.
Correspond by the [degree] setting for an infinite feed operation.
(2) Even when the current value address is changed by a current value change
instruction, the restored data for the current value after a power interruption is
the value based on the status prior to execution of the current value change
instruction.
(3) When home position return has not been completed (home position return
request is ON), restoration of the current value after a power interruption is not
possible.
4 - 18
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.2.1 Current value control
The current value when using the ABS encoder is controlled by following functions.
(1) The validity of an encoder data during operation is checked.
(a) Checks that the amount of change of the encoder in a 3.5[ms] is within 180
degrees at the motor axis. (An error is displayed at the abnormal.)
(b) Checks that adjustment of the encoder data and feed-back positions
controlled with the servo amplifier. (An error is displayed at the abnormal.)
(2) The following values can be monitored by the current value history monitor of
MT Developer2.
Monitor conditions
Multiple CPU system power ON/OFF
Home position return completion
Monitor value
Encoder current value,
Servo command value,
Monitor current value
(a) Current value history monitor
Month/day/hour/minute
The time such as at the completion of home position return and servo
amplifier power supply ON/OFF is indicated.
(b) Encoder current value
When using the servo amplifier, the multiple revolution data and within-onerevolution data read from the encoder is indicated.
(c) Servo command value
The command value issued to the servo amplifier is indicated.
(d) Monitor current value
The current value controlled in the Motion CPU is indicated.
(Note): A value near the feed current value is indicated. However, because
the monitor current value and feed current value are different data, it
is not abnormal even if a different value is indicated.
(e) Alarms
When an error for current value restoration occurs at the servo amplifier
power on, an error code is indicated.
(3) By setting of the "Allowable travel during power off", if the encoder data changes
exceeding the setting range during power-off, it checks at servo amplifier poweron. (An error is displayed at the abnormal.)
"Allowable travel during power off" cannot be set when using the linear servo
motor and direct drive motor.
(4) The current value history of the past 10 times is indicated at the servo amplifier's
power ON/OFF. Ver.!
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
4 - 19
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.3 High-Speed Reading of Specified Data
This function is used to store the specified positioning data in the specified device (D,
W, U \G). The signal from input module controlled in the Motion CPU is used as a
trigger.
It can be set in the system setting of MT Developer2.
POINT
High-speed reading function cannot be used in the SV22 advanced synchronous
control. QDS
(1) Positioning data that can be set
(a) SV13/SV22
Setting data
Word No.
Unit
Remarks
-1
-5
-5
-1
-5
-5
Feed current value
2
10 [µm], 10 [inch], 10 [degree], [PLS]
Real current value
2
10 [µm], 10 [inch], 10 [degree], [PLS]
Deviation counter value
2
[PLS]
M-code
1
—
Torque limit value
1
[%]
Motor current
1
[%]
Motor speed
2
[r/min]
(Note-1)
Servo command value
2
[PLS]
Feed current value (Virtual)
2
[PLS]
Encoder current value
2
[PLS]
M-code (Virtual)
1
—
Current value after differential gear
(Virtual)
2
[PLS]
Encoder current value after differential
gear
2
[PLS]
Cam axis 1 revolution current value
2
[PLS]
Execute cam No.
1
Execute stroke amount
2
—
10-1[µm], 10-5[inch] [PLS]
Optional address (Fixed to 4 bytes)
2
—
(Note-2)
Valid in
SV22
virtual
mode only
(Note-1): The motor speed (unit [mm/s]) is stored at linear servo use.
(Note-2): It is also valid in real mode for the version (Refer to Section 1.5) that supports "synchronous
encoder current value in real mode".
(b) SV43
Setting data
Word No.
Unit
Remarks
-4
-5
-5
-4
-5
-5
Machine value
2
10 [mm], 10 [inch], 10 [degree]
Real machine value
2
10 [mm], 10 [inch], 10 [degree]
Deviation counter value
2
[PLS]
M-code
1
—
Torque limit value
1
[%]
Motor current
1
[%]
Motor speed
2
[r/min]
Servo command value
2
[PLS]
Optional address (Fixed to 4 bytes)
2
—
(Note-1)
(Note-1): The motor speed (unit [mm/s]) is stored at linear servo use.
4 - 20
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
POINT
If the wrong address is set in the absolute address, the WDT error will occur.
Explain to our sales representative before setting the absolute address.
(2) Modules and signals to be used
Input module
Signal
Q172DEX
Read timing
Number of settable points
2
TREN
Q173DPX
Built-in interface in Motion CPU
QDS
PLC input module
(Note-1)
PX device
3
(Note-2)
0.8[ms]
4
8
(Note-1): Only one PLC input module can be used.
(Note-2): Either of the input signal of built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI) and PLC input module can be used.
(3) Usable devices
Word devices
Usable devices
D
0 to 8191
W
0 to 1FFF
U \G
10000 to (10000 + p-1)
(Note-1), (Note-2)
(Note-1): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area for each CPU.
(Note-2): Only device of the self CPU can be used.
POINT
(1) Set an even numbered device No. in the two word data.
(2) Refer to Chapter 2 for the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high
speed transmission area.
4 - 21
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.4 ROM Operation Function
This function is used to operate based on the data in the FLASH ROM built-in Motion
CPU module that the user programs and parameters have been stored.
4.4.1 Specifications of 7-segment LED/switches
No.
Q172DCPU
1)
CD
AB E
789
CDE
AB
F01
45
23 6
F01
789
1
45
23 6
SW
2
STOP RUN
CAUTION
3)
Functions
7-segment LED
2)
Rotary switch 1 (SW1) • Set the operation mode (Normal mode, Installation
mode and mode operated by ROM, etc.)
Rotary switch 2 (SW2)
• Each switch setting is 0 to F.
3)
EMI
• Indicate the operation state and error information.
CN1
2)
Items
1)
FRONT
BAT
(1) Operation mode
"Operation mode" of the Motion CPU is set by the rotary switch setting of Motion
CPU module at the power supply ON of the Multiple CPU system.
The rotary switch setting, operation mode and operation mode overview are
shown below.
(a) Rotary switch setting and operation mode
Rotary switch setting
(Note-1)
Operation mode
SW1
SW2
A
Any setting (Except C)
Installation mode
0
0
Mode operated by RAM
0
6
Mode operated by ROM
0
8
Ethernet IP address display mode
Any setting
C
SRAM clear
(Note-2)
(Note-1): Do not set other than the above setting.
(Note-2): The programs, parameters, motion devices (#), devices of latch data and
absolute position data of SRAM built-in Motion CPU module are cleared.
4 - 22
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(b) Operation mode overview
Operation mode
7-segment LED
Operation overview
• " . " remains flashing in the first digit of 7-segment LED.
• It operates based on the user programs and parameters stored in the SRAM
Mode operated
built-in Motion CPU module.
by RAM
• The user programs and parameters for the ROM operation can be written to
the FLASH ROM built-in Motion CPU module.
• " . " remains flashing in the first digit and steady " . " display in the second
digit of 7-segment LED.
• Operation starts after the user programs and parameters stored in the FLASH
ROM built-in Motion CPU module are read to the SRAM built-in Motion CPU
module at power supply on or reset of the Multiple CPU system.
If the ROM writing is not executed, even if the user programs and parameters
Mode operated
are changed using the MT Developer2 during mode operated by ROM,
by ROM
operation starts with the contents of the FLASH ROM built-in Motion CPU
module at next power supply on or reset.
Also, If the ROM writing is not executed, even if the auto tuning data are
reflected on the servo parameter of Motion CPU by operation in the autotuning setting, operation starts with the contents of the FLASH ROM built-in
Motion CPU module at next power supply on or reset.
POINT
(1) Be sure to turn OFF the Multiple system's power supply before the rotary
switch setting change.
(2) It is recommended to shift to the mode operated by ROM after the programs
and parameters are fixed. The erasing of the programs and parameters can be
avoided even if the battery decrease. (The ROM writing cannot be executed
for the current position of the servo motor in the absolute position system,
home position and latch device. Back up them beforehand using
MT Developer2.)
4 - 23
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.4.2 Outline of ROM operation
When the ROM writing is requested to the Motion CPU module using the
MT Developer2, the programs and parameters stored in the SRAM built-in Motion CPU
module are batch-written to the FLASH ROM, after the data of FLASH ROM built-in
Motion CPU are erased.
When the Motion CPU starts in the "Mode operated by ROM", a normal operation
starts, after the data written in the FLASH ROM is read to the SRAM.
The programs and parameters created by the MT Developer2 must be written
beforehand to the FLASH ROM built-in Motion CPU module at the ROM operation.
The following methods for ROM writing are shown below.
• Write the programs and parameters written in the SRAM built-in Motion CPU module
to the FLASH ROM built-in Motion CPU module.
• Write the programs and parameters of the MT Developer2 to the SRAM built-in
Motion CPU module, and then write them to the FLASH ROM built-in Motion CPU
module.
The data batch written to the FLASH ROM built-in Motion CPU module by ROM writing
are shown below. Backup data except the following (current position of servomotor in
absolute position system, home position and latch device.) cannot be written to the
FLASH ROM.
SV13
SV22
SV43
System setting data
Each parameter for servo control
Servo program
—
Motion SFC parameter
Motion parameter
Motion SFC program
Motion program
—
Mechanical system program
—
—
Cam data
—
POINT
(1) "Backup • load" operation of the MT Developer2 targets the SRAM built-in
Motion CPU module. (The FLASH ROM built-in Motion CPU module is not
targeted.)
Set to "Mode operated by ROM" after ROM writing to execute the ROM
operation after "Backup • load" operation at the Motion CPU module exchange.
(2) The FLASH ROM built-in Motion CPU module serves as a life in 100000 times
writing. Make the ROM writing within 100000 times. If it passes over a life,
"writing error" will occur, replace the Motion CPU module.
(3) The online change of Motion SFC program executes the Motion SFC program
performed the online change from the next scanning at the mode operated by
ROM. Operation starts with the contents of the Motion SFC program written in
the FLASH ROM built-in Motion CPU module at next power supply on or reset.
(4) It needs to meet the following conditions for the ROM writing.
(a) PLC ready flag (M2000) OFF
(b) Not installation mode
4 - 24
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(1) Write the programs and parameters written in the SRAM built-in Motion CPU
module to the FLASH ROM built-in Motion CPU module for the ROM operation.
<ROM writing>
Mode operated by RAM/Mode operated by ROM
Motion CPU module
Be sure to write the programs and parameters beforehand
to the SRAM built-in Motion CPU module at the ROM
operation.
Personal computer
SRAM
Programs
Parameters, etc.
MT Developer2
1) ROM writing request
FLASH ROM
Programs
Parameters, etc.
2) ROM writing
<ROM operation>
Mode operated by ROM
Motion CPU module
SRAM
Programs
Parameters, etc.
Read at
starting
FLASH ROM
Programs
Parameters, etc.
4 - 25
Programs
Parameters, etc.
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(a) Writing procedure for the data of SRAM built-in Motion CPU module to the
ROM.
Execute the ROM writing to the FLASH ROM built-in Motion CPU module by
selecting the [Execute] button on the Export to ROM Format screen
displayed by the menu bar [Online] - [Export to ROM Format].
Select "Execute" button.
Refer to the help of MT Developer2 for details of the operation procedures.
POINT
Be sure to write the all data beforehand to SRAM built-in Motion CPU module at the
ROM writing.
4 - 26
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(2) Write the programs and parameters of the MT Developer2 to the SRAM built-in
Motion CPU module, and then write them to the FLASH ROM built-in Motion CPU
module for the ROM operation.
<Data writing + ROM writing>
Mode operated by RAM/Mode operated by ROM
Motion CPU module
SRAM
Personal computer
1) Write data
(ROM writing request)
Programs
Parameters, etc.
Programs
Parameters, etc.
2) ROM writing request
after write data
FLASH ROM
Programs
Parameters, etc.
3) ROM writing
<ROM operation>
Mode operated by ROM
Motion CPU module
SRAM
Programs
Parameters, etc.
MT Developer2
Read at
starting
FLASH ROM
Programs
Parameters, etc.
4 - 27
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(a) Writing procedure for the data of MT Developer2 to the ROM.
Check the data written in the Motion CPU by selecting the [Program memory
+ CPU ROM] of target memory on the Write to CPU screen displayed by the
menu bar [Online] - [Write to CPU].
Select "Program memory + CPU ROM".
Select "Execute" button.
(Note): The display of selectable data are different depending on the operating software.
Refer to the help of MT Developer2 for details of the operation procedures.
POINT
Be sure to write the all data beforehand to SRAM built-in Motion CPU module at the
ROM writing.
4 - 28
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.4.3 Operating procedure of the ROM operation function
(1) ROM operation procedure
The ROM operation procedure is shown below.
Preparation for ROM operation
Set the "Mode operated by RAM" by setting
the rotary switch 1 (SW1) and 2 (SW2) to "0".
Turn ON the power supply of Multiple CPU
system.
Create or correct the system setting,
parameters and programs using the
MT Developer2, and write them to the
Motion CPU module.
Execute the trial run and adjustment.
Is the operation normal ?
YES
Mode operated
by RAM
(ROM writing)
Write the system setting, parameters, and
programs of SRAM built-in Motion CPU
module to the FLASH ROM built-in Motion
CPU module by the ROM writing request
using the MT Developer2.
Turn OFF the power supply of Multiple CPU
system.
Set the "Mode operated by ROM" by setting
the rotary switch 1 (SW1) to "0" and rotary
switch 2 (SW2) to "6".
Turn ON the power supply of Multiple CPU
system.
Mode operated
by ROM
ROM operation start
4 - 29
NO
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(2) Operation at the "Mode operated by ROM"
Mode operated by ROM start
Is the data written
to the FLASH ROM built-in
Motion CPU module ?
NO
(Data (programs and parameters) are
not written to the FLASH ROM built-in
Motion CPU module.)
YES
Read the following of the FLASH ROM
built-in Motion CPU module to the SRAM
built-in Motion CPU module.
System setting data
Parameter for servo control
Servo program (SV13/SV22)
Motion SFC parameter (SV13/SV22)
Motion SFC program (SV13/SV22)
Mechanical system program (SV22)
Cam data (SV22)
Motion parameter (SV43)
Motion program (SV43)
Normal operation start
The system setting error (" AL" flashes 3
times
steady "L01" display) in the 7segment LED at the front side of Motion
CPU module.
Wait for restart of Multiple
CPU system.
After that, it cannot be operated because of
stop state.
Retry the operation for "ROM writing"
"Mode operated by ROM" after confirm the
contents for programs and parameters of the
SRAM built-in Motion CPU module.
After that, it is same operation as the
RAM operation.
POINT
(1) Change the operation mode using the rotary switch of Motion CPU module.
(2) Confirm the operation mode by the 7-segment LED of Motion CPU module.
4 - 30
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.5 Security Function
4.5.1 Protection by password
This function is used to protect the user data of Motion CPU by registering a password.
The illegal reading or writing of the user data are prevented by setting a password.
Registered password can be changed and deleted.
(1) Operating procedure password
[Register/Change Password] or [Delete Password] screen is used to
register/change/delete a password. Select from a menu bar or each screen of MT
Developer2 to display these screen.
• Select from a menu bar
• Select from each screen of Write to CPU/Read from CPU/Verify with CPU
4 - 31
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(2) User data protected by password
The user data protected in this function are shown below.
"Write Protection" or "Read/Write Protection" can be set every user data.
Operating
User data
system software
Protected contents
Motion SFC programs (Control code, text)
Motion SFC program
SV13/SV22
and motion SFC parameters
Servo program
Servo programs and program allocation
Safety observation function
Safety signal comparison parameter and
parameter
(Note-1) Ver.!
speed monitoring parameter
Mechanical system program
(Note-2)
SV22
SV43
Synchronous control
(Note-3) QDS
parameter
Mechanical system programs
Input axis parameter and synchronous
Ver.!
parameter
(Note-4)
Cam data
Cam data (Converted data, edit data
Motion program
Motion programs and motion parameters
(Note-1): Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU/Q173DCPU-S1/Q172DCPU-S1 only.
(Note-2): Virtual mode only.
(Note-3): Advanced synchronous control only.
(Note-4): Cam edit data "Read from CPU/Write to CPU/Verity with CPU" is possible for the
MT Developer2 version "1.09k or later".
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
4 - 32
)
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(3) Password registration/change
Execute the password registration/change on the "Register/Change password"
screen of MT Developer2.
Refer to the help of MT Developer2 for details of the operation procedures.
<SV13/SV22 use>
<SV43 use>
Items
Details
Type
Type of user data
Registration
" " is displayed when a password is registered in the Motion CPU.
Enter initial registration/change password.
Alphanumeric character (ASCII) of 6 or less
Password
Match case (Not full-size character)
(Note-1): Make the item an empty column when a password is not
registered.
A registration condition set in the Motion CPU is displayed.
Registration condition
• Write Protection
• Read/Write Protection
New registration condition can be selected by password input.
4 - 33
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
POINT
(1) If a user has forgotten a registration password, clear a password of Motion
CPU by the all clear function. However, the all password data and user data
are cleared by the all clear function. Re-write the user data to the Motion CPU.
(Refer to Section 4.6 for details.)
(2) ROM operation can be executed by user data registered a password.
The password setting is also included in the ROM writing/reading data.
(3) The password data is not saved in a project without project save.
Be sure to save project.
(4) If an operation stops by reset or power OFF of the Multiple CPU system while
a password registration/change, the user data may not be registered.
Register/change a password again to restore the user data.
4 - 34
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(4) Password delete
Execute the password delete on the "Delete password" screen of
MT Developer2.
Refer to the help of MT Developer2 for details of the operation procedures.
<SV13/SV22 use>
<SV43 use>
Items
Details
Type
Type of user data
Registration
" " is displayed when a password is registered in the Motion CPU.
Enter old password.
Password
(Note-1): Make the item an empty column when a password is not
registered.
POINT
(1) The password data is not saved in a project without project save.
Be sure to save project.
(2) If an operation stops by reset or power OFF of the Multiple CPU system while
delete of password, the data may not be deleted. Delete a password again to
restore the user data.
4 - 35
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(5) Password check
When operating the user data that sets password, the check password screen is
displayed automatically.
Protection by the password temporarily released by success of password check.
A password is memorized until MT Developer2 ends. (Since protection by
password is automatically released temporarily at the user data operation, a
check password screen is not displayed.)
Refer to the help of MT Developer2 for details of the operation procedure.
<SV13/SV22 use>
<SV43 use>
Items
Details
Type
Type of user data
Password
Enter old password.
4 - 36
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(6) Password save
Registered/changed/deleted password or password read with user data from
"Read from CPU" screen displayed by reading operation of the data can be
saved in a project data.
A password saved in a project data can be registered with user data, when the
user data are written in the Motion CPU that does not set password from "Write
to CPU" screen displayed by menu [Online] [Write to CPU].
Select menu [Project]
[Save] to save the updated password data in a project.
(a) Status of password data for each operation
Operation
Status of password data
Read
When a password is set in the call source Motion CPU, the password contents are
called and the password data in a project are updated.
Write
When a password data is set in a project, if a password is not set in the write
designation Motion CPU, the password contents are also written.
Verification
Password data in a project are not updated.
ROM writing
Password contents registered in the write designation Motion CPU are written in
ROM.
Online change
(SV13/SV22)
Password contents of write designation Motion CPU are not updated.
Backup
It is saved in backup data including also the password contents registered in the
call source Motion CPU. The password data in a project is not updated.
Load
Password contents in backup data are written in the write designation Motion CPU.
Register/change
password
New password contents are written in the write designation Motion CPU.
Password data in a project is also updated to new password contents.
Delete password
A password is deleted from the write designation Motion CPU.
A password is deleted also from the password data in a project.
Project diversion
The password data in diverting source project is not diverted.
POINT
(1) The password data is not saved in a project without project save.
(2) Save a project after delete of password to delete the password data in a
project. Or, create a project without password data by creating new project
and diverting user data from a project with password data.
4 - 37
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.5.2 Protection by software security key
QDS
This function is used to protect the user data by setting the software security key to the
project, operating system software, and MT Developer2 to limit the computer which
operates the project and Motion CPU which runs the project.
The software security key is created in MT Developer2 and registered to the operating
system software when the operating system software is installed to Motion CPU. It is
also registered to the user program when the project is created.
The software security key verify is executed between MT Developer2 and Motion CPU
during communication of the computer and Motion CPU. If the keys are not matched,
the communication is not possible.
Only the enabled computer can communicate with Motion CPU. When the user data
are leaked, copying and analyzing the data are prevented.
Computer 1
Motion CPU
MT Developer2
Reading/writing project
data is possible.
Software security
key A
Operating system software
Software security
key A
Editing
project data
is possible.
Due to unmatched
software security
keys, reading/
writing project
data is not
possible.
Project
Software security
key A
Executing
project data
is possible.
Project
Software security
key A
Computer 2
MT Developer2
Illegal leak
of project
data
Software security
key B
Due to unmatched
software security
keys, editing project
data is not possible.
Project
Software security
key A
POINT
Even when the communication between MT Developer2 and Motion CPU is not
possible due to the unmatched software security keys, monitoring and servo
parameter reading/writing are possible in MR Configurator .
CAUTION
If the software security key set in the project data or operating system software cannot be
imported to MT Developer2, the software security key cannot be released even in repair or
maintenance, and the project data cannot be referred to permanently. Mitsubishi Electric
Corporation cannot be held responsible for any damage which may occur as a result of not being
able to refer to the project data for our customers or other individuals and organizations. Please
be aware of this when using the software security key.
4 - 38
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(1) Overview of software security key
The software security key is controlled with the software security key name. Eight
software security key names can be registered to MT Developer2.
Key function level (Administrator/Developer/User) is set in the software security
key, and some operations are restricted depending on the key function level.
The software security key can be exported/imported and used in computers other
than the computer where it is created.
Key expiration date can be set when exporting the key. When the expiration date
is expired, re-export/import the key since the communication with Motion CPU is
not possible. (Even when the expiration date is expired, the operation of Motion
CPU continues.)
The exported software security key cannot be imported and re-exported.
When replacing computers, delete the software security key from the project and
Motion CPU and create the software security key again in the new computer.
The details of key function level are shown below.
Items
Details
Software security key
name
• Set when creating the software security key.
• Alphanumeric character of 16 or less (symbols such as "!" ' #$%&()+,/:;<=>?@[\]^_`{|}~" and space can be also used.)
• The characters are case-sensitive.
• Any of "Administrator", "Developer" or "User"
• Set when exporting the software security key.
• The level of newly created software security key is "Administrator".
<Prohibited operation function>
Key function level
• None
Developer
• Deleting the key from the project
User
• Deleting the key from the project
• External output of program data
• Exporting the project verify
• Copying data among projects of Motion SFC
• Exporting cam data
• Copying and exporting device comments
• Exporting the servo program list
• Printing project data
(Note-1)
• Saving sampling data of the digital oscilloscope
Key function level
Key expiration date
Prohibited operation function
Administrator
• "Not Specified" or the period from the date when the key is exported to the
expiration date (1 to 365 days)
• Set when exporting the software security key.
(Note-1): Enabled/disabled can be set for saving sampling data of the digital oscilloscope.
4 - 39
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(2) Start-up procedure of software security key
The operation of software security key function is executed on the software
security key management screen of MT Developer2.
Select the menu bar [Tools]-[Software Security Key Management].
Refer to the help of MT Developer2 for details of the operation procedures.
Operation details of software security key function are shown below
Items
Details
Software security key creation
Create the software security key in MT Developer2.
Write the software security key that can be used in
Software security key export
MT Developer2 of other computers to the file.
Register the exported software security key to
Software security key import
MT Developer2.
Software security key embedding
(Installation of operating system
software)
Software security key embedding
(Project)
Software security key delete
Embed the software security key to Motion CPU at
installation of the operating system software.
Embed the software security key to the project.
Delete the software security key from the project.
(Delete from the project)
Software security key delete
Delete the software security key from MT Developer2.
(Delete from MT Developer2)
Software security key information
Confirm the software security key information registered
confirmation
to the operating system software.
4 - 40
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(3) Operating procedure of software security key function
(a) Using procedure of software security key
START
Create the software security key.
Export the software security key.
Will communication
and project management be
executed in another
computer?
NO
YES
Import the software security key to
another computer. (Execute the
following operations in the computer
where the software security key is
imported.)
At installation of operating system
software, embed the software security
key to Motion CPU. (Motion CPU is all
cleared.)
Create the project and embed the
software security key to the project.
Write the project to Motion CPU.
END
POINT
(1) Backup the exported data after exporting the software security key. Be sure to
store the data in a safe place.
(2) If the software security key of the operating system software already installed
in Motion CPU is different from that embedded to the operating system
software to be installed, "Clear all" is executed at installation. It is
recommended to backup the data in advance using MT Developer2. If the
software security keys are matched, the programs, parameters and absolute
position data that are written to Motion CPU are not re-written.
4 - 41
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(b) Delete procedure of software security key
START
Install the operating system software
without setting the software security
key. (Motion CPU is all cleared.)
Delete the software security key from
the project.
Write the project to Motion CPU.
Is the deleted
software security key used
on another project?
NO
Delete the software security key from
MT Developer2.
END
4 - 42
YES
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.6 All Clear Function
This function is used to clear the all user data, password setting, device memory,
backup area and user data area of FLASH ROM in the Motion CPU module.
(1) Procedure for clear all
(a) Set the Motion CPU module to installation mode (Set a rotary switch 1
(SW1) to "A".)
(b) Execute the all clear.
Select the menu bar [Online]-[Clear CPU Memory].
Refer to the help of MT Developer2 for details of the operation procedure.
POINT
(1) Set the Motion CPU module to installation mode to clear all.
Be sure to set a rotary switch after power supply OFF.
(2) The user data area of FLASH ROM built-in Motion CPU module is also
cleared.
(3) All user data and password setting are cleared at the "Clear all".
It is recommended to be backup them in advance using MT Developer2.
(4) When all clear is executed for user data created by the operating system
software type "SV22" of Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU, the operation method
becomes "virtual mode switching method".
4 - 43
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.7 Communication Via Network
The communication between the personal computer and the Motion CPU is possible
via Q series Network module (CC-LinkIE, CC-Link, MELSECNET/10(H), Ethernet and
etc.) in the Motion CPU module.
Refer to the PLC manuals for the specifications of each network modules of
CC-LinkIE, CC-Link, MELSECNET/10(H), Ethernet and Serial communication, the
handling method.
4.7.1 Specifications of the communications via network
(1) Communications via network enables using MT Developer2 in the Motion CPU.
(2) Access range of the communications via network of the Motion CPU is an access
range equivalent to connection PLC CPU using GX Works2/GX Developer.
Refer to the operating manual of GX Works2/GX Developer for details.
(3) By setting the routing parameter to the control CPU of the network module and the
CPU which connected the peripheral devices in the network by
MELSECNET/10(H) and Ethernet, it is possible to relay to 8 network points and
communicate.
(4) Because the Motion CPU cannot become the control CPU of the network module,
there is not setting item of the network module and network parameter.
However, when connecting with the CPU on the other network from the peripheral
device which connected the Motion CPU, it needs to the setting of the routing
parameter.
(5) It can operate by remote control the monitor or program editing of the Motion CPU
via the intranet using the Ethernet module.
Personal Computer
Personal Computer
Ethernet
Ethernet
Intranet
Power
supply
QnUD
CPU
Q173 D(S)
CPU
Ethernet
module
4 - 44
Power
supply
QnUD
CPU
Q173 D(S)
CPU
Ethernet
module
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.8 Monitor Function of the Main Cycle
(1) Information for main cycle of the Motion CPU (process cycle executed at free time
except for motion control) is stored to the special register.
(2) Since the automatic refresh of CPU shared memory, normal task of Motion SFC
program (SV13/SV22) and Motion program (SV43) are executed in the main cycle,
make it reference for process time, etc. to program.
(3) There are following methods to shorten a main cycle.
(a) Lengthen an operation cycle setting.
(b) Reduce the number of event task programs to execute in the Motion SFC
program. (SV13/SV22)
(c) Reduce the number of normal task programs to execute simultaneously in
the Motion SFC program. (SV13/SV22)
(d) Reduce the number of automatic refresh points of CPU shared memory.
(e) Reduce the number of Motion programs to execute simultaneously. (SV43)
(4) When a main cycle is lengthened (more than 1.0[s]), a WDT error may occur in
the Motion CPU.
(5) Details of main cycle monitor register is shown below.
No.
Name
Meaning
SD520
Scan time
Current scan time
(1ms units)
SD521
Maximum scan time
Maximum scan time
(1ms units)
4 - 45
Details
• Current scan time is stored in the unit 1[ms].
• Range (0 to 65535[ms])
• Maximum main cycle is stored in the unit 1[ms].
• Range (0 to 65535[ms])
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.9 Servo Parameter Read/Change Function
(1) When the servo parameters are changed, the Motion CPU will be automatically
read the servo parameters and reflected them to the servo parameter storage
area in the Motion CPU. Therefore, an operation to read servo parameters is
unnecessary in the following cases.
(a) The parameters are changed by auto tuning.
(b) The parameters are changed by connecting directly MR Configurator to
the servo amplifier.
POINT
If the power supply of Multiple CPU system is turned off/reset or the power supply
of servo amplifier is turned off immediately after change, it may not be reflected.
(2) After executing the servo parameter reading function, when it needs to reflect the
servo parameters changed to the MT Developer2, read the servo parameters from
the Motion CPU and save data.
(3) The servo parameters can be changed or displayed individually from Motion CPU.
QDS
Store the value in the following special registers to change or display the servo
parameter.
(a) "Servo parameter write/read request" device
No.
Name
SD552
SD804
(Note-1)
SD805 Servo parameter
write/read request
Meaning
Details
Set by
Servo parameter
read value
• The read value of servo parameter which executed
"2: Read request" in SD804 is stored.
System
(At reading
request)
Servo parameter
write/read request
flag
• The "write/read request" is executed after setting of
the axis No. and servo parameter No.
1: Write request
2: Read request
• "0" is automatically set by Motion CPU after
completion of servo parameter write/read request.
("-1" is stored by Motion CPU at write/read error.)
User/
System
Axis No.
• The axis No. to write/read servo parameter is stored.
Q173DSCPU: 1 to 32
Q172DSCPU: 1 to 16
• The servo parameter No. to be written/read is stored
in hexadecimal.
H
SD806
Servo parameter
No.
SD807
Servo parameter
setting value
Parameter No.
Parameter group No.
0: PA
5: PF
1: PB
9: Po
2: PC
A: PS
3: PD
B: PL (MR-J4(W)- B only)
4: PE
C: PT (MR-J4(W)- B only)
Fixed at 0
User
• The setting value of servo parameter to be written is
stored when "1: Write request" is set in SD804.
(Note-1): Do not execute the automatic refresh.
4 - 46
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(b) Procedure to servo parameter write/read
1) Procedure to write
1. Set the axis No., servo parameter No. and servo parameter setting
value in SD805 to SD807.
2. Set "1: Write request" in SD804.
3. Check that "0" is set in SD804.
(Completion of write)
2) Procedure to read
1. Set the axis No. and servo parameter No. in SD805 and SD806.
2. Set "2: Read request" in SD804.
3. Check that "0" is set in SD804.
(Completion of read)
4. Stores the read value in SD552.
POINT
(1) New servo parameter is reflected to Motion CPU, therefore, the servo
parameter of Motion CPU side does not need to change.
(2) When the axis No., servo parameter No. or servo parameter setting value is
outside the setting range, "-1: write/read error" is stored in the servo
parameter write/read request flag. The setting value of servo parameter is
reflected to Motion CPU even when the write error occurred. Be sure to set
within the setting range.
4 - 47
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.10 Optional Data Monitor Function
This function is used to store the data (MR-J4(W)- B: 1 to 6 per axis, MR-J3(W)- B:
1 to 3 per axis) to the specified devices (D, W, #, U \G) and monitor them.
It can be set by the system setting of MT Developer2.
(1) Data that can be set
(a) Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU use
Set the total of number of communication data points per 1 axis as shown
below.
MR-J4(W)- B: Up to 6 points
MR-J3(W)- B: Up to 3 points
When setting an axis of servo amplifier (MR-J4- B-RJ) selected as "101:
Synchronous encoder via servo amplifier" by [Pr.320] Synchronous encoder
axis type, set the number of communication data points so that the total
comes to 2 points or less per axis.
Data type
Unit
Servo amplifier
Number of
Number of
communication
words
MR-J3(W)- B MR-J4(W)- B
data points
Effective load ratio
[%]
1
Regenerative load ratio
[%]
1
1
Peak load ratio
[%]
1
1
[PLS]
2
0
[PLS]
2
0
Position feed back
Absolute position encoder single
revolution position
Motor side encoder single
revolution position
1
Fully closed control use
Absolute position encoder multiple
revolution counter
[rev]
Motor side encoder multiple
revolution counter
Load inertia moment ratio
1
1
Fully closed control use
[
0.1]
1
1
[rad/s]
1
1
Main circuit bus voltage
[V]
1
1
Cumulative current value
[Position
command]
2
0
1
1
Load mass ratio
Position loop gain 1
(Note-1)
Servo motor speed
[r/min]
Servo motor speed
[mm/s]
Selected droop pulse
[PLS]
2
2
[W]
1
1
[Wh]
2
2
[0.1%]
1
1
Load-side encoder information 1
[PLS]
2
2
Load-side encoder information 2
—
2
2
[PLS]
2
2
[°C]
1
1
Module power consumption
(Note-2)
Unit integral power consumption
(Note-2)
Instantaneous torque
Instantaneous thrust
Z-phase counter
Motor thermistor temperature
Remark
4 - 48
Linear servo motor use
Linear servo motor use
Linear servo motor use
Fully closed control or
synchronous encoder
via servo amplifier use
Linear servo motor use
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
Data type
Disturbance torque
Disturbance thrust
Overload alarm margin
Error excessive alarm margin
Servo amplifier
Number of
Number of
communication
words
MR-J3(W)- B MR-J4(W)- B
data points
Unit
[0.1%]
1
1
[0.1%]
1
1
[16PLS]
1
1
Settling time
[ms]
1
1
Overshoot amount
[PLS]
1
1
Motor side/load-side position
deviation
[PLS]
2
2
[0.01r/min]
2
2
Motor side/load-side speed
deviation
Remark
Linear servo motor use
Fully closed control use
: Settable
: Unsettable
(Note-1): The position command is command unit set in the servo data setting.
(Note-2): In the servo amplifier for multiple axes, the measured value of whole unit is monitored. When these values set to each axis of
MR-J4 multi-axis servo amplifier, the same value can be monitored in each axis. Use the monitored value of not each axis but
each module to calculate the module power consumption power consumption and unit integral power consumption of multiple
modules.
(b) Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1) use
Unit
Number of
words
Effective load ratio
[%]
1
Regenerative load ratio
[%]
1
Peak load ratio
[%]
1
[PLS]
2
[PLS]
2
Data type
Position feed back
Absolute position encoder single
revolution position
Motor side encoder single
revolution position
Load inertia moment ratio
Load mass ratio
Position loop gain 1
Servo amplifier
MR-J3(W)- B
Remark
Fully closed control use
[
0.1]
1
[rad/s]
1
[V]
1
Main circuit bus voltage
Linear servo motor use
: Settable
: Unsettable
(2) Devices that can be set
Word device
Device that can be set
D
0 to 8191
W
0 to 1FFF
#
U \G
0 to 7999
10000 to (10000+p-1)
(Note-1), (Note-2)
(Note-1): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed transmission area
for each CPU.
(Note-2): Only device of the self CPU can be used.
4 - 49
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
POINT
(1) The updating cycle of data is every operation cycle.
(2) Set an even numbered device No. in the two word data.
(3) Refer to Chapter 2 for the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high
speed transmission area.
4 - 50
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.11 SSCNET Control Function
The following controls are possible in the SSCNET control function.
Function
Application
Temporarily connect/disconnect of SSCNET communication is executed during Multiple
Connect/disconnect of SSCNET
CPU system's power supply ON.
communication
This function is used to exchange the servo amplifiers or SSCNET cables.
Start/release of amplifier-less
operation
Start/release of amplifier-less operation is requested.
This function is used to confirm the operation without connection of the servo amplifies.
(1) Device list
Set the request in SD803, and the process status is stored in SD508.
(a) SSCNET control status devices
Device No.
Overview
Set by
The execute status (Note) of the SSCNET control is stored.
Monitoring value
0
Status
Command accept
waiting
SD508
-1
Execute waiting
-2
Executing
Contents
Connect/disconnect command of SSCNET communication or
start/release command of amplifier-less operation is in the status
that can be accepted.
SD508 is waiting for connect/disconnect execute command after
accepting the connect/disconnect command of SSCNET
communication or start/release of amplifier-less operation.
Connect/disconnect of SSCNET communication or start/release of
amplifier-less operation is in process.
System
(Note): The status for amplifier-less operation status is set in the amplifier-less operation status flag (SM508). (Refer to Section 4.11.2.)
(b) SSCNET control command devices
Device No.
Overview
Set by
Set the SSCNET control command.
Setting
value
0
1 to 32
-10
SD803
-20
-21
-25
-2
Command
No command
Contents
Connect/
disconnect
Amplifierless
operation
Set "0" if there is no command.
Disconnect command of
Set axis No. "1 to 32" to be disconnected.
SSCNET communication
Connect command of
Set "-10" to connect axis while
SSCNET communication disconnecting.
Set "-20" to change from the normal
operation to amplifier-less operation.
Start command 1 of
EMI signal is invalid during amplifier-less
amplifier-less operation
operation, and the wiring of EMI signal is
(EMI invalid)
not necessary.
Set "-21" to change from the normal
operation to amplifier-less operation.
Start command 2 of
EMI signal is valid during amplifier-less
amplifier-less operation
operation, and the wiring of EMI signal is
(EMI valid)
necessary.
Release command of
Set "-25" to change from the amplifier-less
amplifier-less operation
operation to normal operation.
Set "-2" to execute the processing when
Execute command
the status (SD508) is execute waiting after
setting the value of each command
4 - 51
User
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.11.1 Connect/disconnect function of SSCNET communication
Temporarily connect/disconnect of SSCNET communication is executed during
Multiple CPU system's power supply ON.
This function is used to exchange the servo amplifiers or SSCNET cables.
Set the request for the connect/disconnect of SSCNET communication in SSCNET
control command (SD803), and the status for the command accept waiting or execute
waiting is stored in SSCNET control status (SD508).
Use this device to connect the servo amplifiers disconnected by this function.
When the power supply module of head axis of each SSCNET line (servo amplifier
connected directly to the Motion CPU module) turns OFF/ON, this function is not
necessary.
POINT
(1) Confirm the LED display of the servo amplifier for "AA" after completion of
SSCNET communication disconnect processing. And then, turn OFF the servo
amplifier's power supply.
(2) The SSCNET control status device (SD508) only changes into the execute
waiting status (-1) even if the disconnect command of SSCNET
communication (1 to 32) or connect command of SSCNET communication
(-10) is set in SSCNET control command device (SD803). The actual
processing is not executed. Set the execute command (-2) in SSCNET control
command device (SD803) to execute.
(3) When the disconnect command of SSCNET communication (1 to 32) is set to
axis not disconnect, the SSCNET control status device (SD508) returns the
command accept waiting status (0) without entering the execute waiting status
(-1).
(4) Operation failure may occur in some axes if the servo amplifier's power
supply is turned OFF without using the disconnect function. Be sure to turn
OFF the servo amplifier's power supply by the disconnect function.
(5) When the connect/disconnect command is executed to the axis allocated to Baxis and C- axis of MR-J4W- B or B- axis of MR-J3W- B, it can be
disconnected, however it cannot be reconnected. Execute the
connect/disconnect command to the A-axis.
(6) Only the release command of amplifier-less operation can be accepted
during amplifier-less operation. The connect/disconnect command cannot be
accepted.
4 - 52
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(1) Procedure to connect/disconnect of SSCNET communication
Procedure to connect/disconnect at the exchange of servo amplifiers or
SSCNET cables is shown below.
(a) Procedure to disconnect
1) Set the axis No. to disconnect in SD803. (Setting value: 1 to 32)
2) Check that "-1: Execute waiting" is set in SD508.
(Disconnect execute waiting)
3) Set "-2: Execute command" in SD803.
4) Check that "0: Command accept waiting" is set in SD508.
(Completion of disconnection)
5) Turn OFF the servo amplifier's power supply after checking the LED
display "AA" of servo amplifier to be disconnected.
SSCNET control command
(SD803)
Disconnect command
(Axis No. of servo amplifier
to be disconnected)
Disconnect execute
command
1 to 32
-2
0
Disconnect
command clear
0
Completion of disconnection
SSCNET control status
(SD508)
0
Command accept
waiting
-1
-2
0
Disconnect execute
waiting
Disconnect
processing execute
Command accept
waiting
(b) Procedure to connect
1) Turn ON the servo amplifier's power supply.
2) Set "-10: Connect command of SSCNET communication" in SD803.
3) Check that "-1: Execute waiting" is set in SD508.
(Connect execute waiting)
4) Set "-2: Execute command" in SD803.
5) Check that "0: Command accept waiting" is set in SD508.
(Completion of connection)
6) Resume operation of servo amplifier after checking the servo ready
(M2415+20n) ON.
SSCNET control command
(SD803)
0
Connect command
Connect execute command
-10
-2
Connect command clear
0
Completion of connection
SSCNET control status
(SD508)
0
-1
Command accept
waiting
4 - 53
Connect execute waiting
-2
0
Connect processing execute
Command accept
waiting
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(2) Program
(a) Program to connect/disconnect the servo amplifiers after Axis 5 of self CPU
Disconnect procedure : Turn OFF the servo amplifier's power supply after
checking the LED display "AA" of servo amplifier.
Connect procedure : Resume operation of servo amplifier after checking
the servo ready (M2415+20n) ON.
System configuration
Q61P
QnUD
CPU
Q172D QY40P QY40P Q172D QY40P
CPU
LX
Disconnection (After Axis 5)
AMP
Axis 1
AMP
Axis 2
M
AMP
Axis 3
M
AMP
Axis 4
M
AMP
AMP
Axis 5
M
AMP
Axis 6
M
Axis 7
M
AMP
Axis 8
M
M
(a) Motion SFC program (SV13/SV22)
Disconnect operation
Connect operation
Disconnect processing
[G10]
[F10]
[G20]
[F20]
[G30]
Connect processing
SD508==0
Check the disconnect
command accept status.
[G10]
SD803=5
Set "5: Disconnect command
of SSCNET communication"
(Disconnect after Axis 5)
in SD803.
[F11]
SD508==-1
Disconnect execute waiting
SD803=-2
Set "-2: Execute command"
in SD803.
[F20]
SD508==0
Check the completion of
disconnect processing.
[G30]
[G20]
SD508==0
Check the connect
command accept status.
SD803=-10
Set "-10: Connect command
of SSCNET communication"
in SD803.
SD508==-1
Connect execute waiting
SD803=-2
Set "-2: Execute command"
in SD803.
SD508==0
Check the completion of
connect processing.
END
END
(b) Motion program (SV43)
Connect operation
Disconnect operation
N10 IF[#SD508 EQ 0] GOTO20;
GOTO10;
N20 #SD803=5;
N30 IF[#SD508 EQ -1] GOTO40;
GOTO30;
N40 #SD803=-2;
N50 IF[#SD508 EQ 0] GOTO60;
Check the disconnect command accept
status.
Set "5: Disconnect command of SSCNET
communication" (Disconnect after Axis 5)
in SD803.
Disconnect execute waiting
Set "-2: Execute command" in SD803.
Check the completion of disconnect
processing.
N10 IF[#SD508 EQ 0] GOTO20;
GOTO10;
N20 #SD803=-10;
N30 IF[#SD508 EQ -1] GOTO40;
GOTO30;
N40 #SD803=-2;
N50 IF[#SD508 EQ 0] GOTO60;
GOTO50;
N60;
GOTO50;
N60;
4 - 54
Check the connect command accept
status.
Set "-10: Connect command of
SSCNET communication" in SD803.
Connect execute waiting
Set "-2: Execute command" in SD803.
Check the completion of connect
processing.
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(b) Program to connect/disconnect the servo amplifiers after Axis 5 connected
to the Motion CPU (CPU No.2) by the PLC CPU (CPU No.1).
Disconnect procedure : Turn OFF the servo amplifier's power supply after
checking the LED display "AA" of servo amplifier by
turning X0 from OFF to ON.
Connect procedure : Resume operation of servo amplifier after checking
the servo ready (M2415+20n) of servo amplifier by
turning X1 from OFF to ON.
System configuration
Q61P
QnUD
CPU
Q172D QY40P QY40P Q172D QY40P
CPU
LX
Disconnection (After Axis 5)
AMP
AMP
Axis 1
Axis 2
M
AMP
Axis 3
M
AMP
Axis 4
M
AMP
Axis 5
M
AMP
Axis 6
M
AMP
Axis 7
M
AMP
Axis 8
M
M
(a) Sequence program
0
5
SM400
M100
M101
M102
X0
MOV
K1
D51
MOV
K-2
D104
Set "-2: Execute command" in D104.
MOV
K5
D102
Set "5: Disconnect command of SSCNET
communication" (Disconnect after Axis 5)
in D102.
SET M100
X1
MOV
K-10
D102
Set "-10: Connect command of SSCNET
communication" in D102.
SET M100
18
M100
M10
M10
DP.DDRD H3E1
M11
=
D100
D50
SD508 D100
K0
M10
RST M100
Read the data of SD508 for Multiple CPU
system (CPU No.2) by turning M100 ON, and
store them to data area (D100) of self CPU.
SET M101
39
M101
M12
M12
DP.DDWR H3E1
D50
D102
M13
SD803 M12
RST M101
Write D102 to the data of SD803 for Multiple
CPU system (CPU No.2) by turning M101 ON.
(Disconnect/Connect command)
SET M102
57
M102
M10
M10
DP.DDRD H3E1
M11
=
D100
D50
SD508 D100
K-1
M10
RST M102
Read the data of SD508 for Multiple CPU
system (CPU No.2) by turning M102 ON, and
store them to data area (D100) of self CPU.
SET M103
78
M103
M12
M12
DP.DDWR H3E1
D50
M13
D104
SD803 M12
RST M103
Write D104 to the data of SD803 for Multiple
CPU system (CPU No.2) by turning M103 ON.
(Disconnect/connect execute command)
SET M104
96
M104
M10
M10
DP.DDRD H3E1
M11
=
D100
D50
K0
SD508 D100
M10
RST M104
4 - 55
Read the data of SD508 for Multiple CPU
system (CPU No.2) by turning M104 ON, and
store them to data area (D100) of self CPU.
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.11.2 Amplifier-less operation function
Ver.!
This function is used to confirm for the operation without connecting the servo
amplifiers at the starting or debugging.
The start/release request of amplifier-less operation is set in SSCNET control
command (SD803), and status of the command accepting waiting or execute waiting
is stored in SSCNET control status (SD508).
Confirm the amplifier-less operation status by the amplifier-less operation status flag
(SM508).
POINT
(1) The SSCNET control status device (SD508) only changes into the execute
waiting status (-1) even if the start command of amplifier-less operation
1/2 (-20/-21) or release command of amplifier-less operation (-25) in SSCNET
control command device (SD803). The actual processing is not executed. Set
the execute command (-2) in SSCNET control command device (SD803) to
executed.
(2) Only the release command of amplifier-less operation can be accepted
during amplifier-less operation. The start command for the other amplifier-less
operation cannot be accepted.
(3) The operation of servo motor or the timing of operation cycle, etc. at the
amplifier-less operation is different from the case where the servo amplifiers
are connected. Confirm the operation finally with a real machine.
(4) The amplifier-less operation becomes invalid immediately after the Multiple
CPU system's power supply ON or reset.
(1) Amplifier-less operation status flag
Device No.
SM508
Signal name
Amplifier-less operation
status flag
Overview
Set by
The amplifier-less operation status is stored.
OFF : During normal operation
ON : During amplifier-less operation
System
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
4 - 56
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(2) Control details
Operation during amplifier-less operation is shown below.
Item
Servo amplifier type
Servo amplifier status
Servo amplifier external
signal
(At the setting valid)
Operation
All axes set in the system setting are connected with the following type regardless of the setting details of
system setting.
(1) Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU use
(a) For communication type "SSCNET /H"
• Servo amplifier : MR-J4-10B
• Servo motor : HF-KR053
(b) For communication type "SSCNET "
• Servo amplifier : MR-J3-10B
• Servo motor : HF-KP053
(2) Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1) use
• Servo amplifier : MR-J3-10B
• Servo motor : HF-KP053
• Deviation counter value : Always 0
• Motor speed
: Motor speed for the command
• Motor current value
: At the amplifier-less operation start: "0"
(The motor current value can be simulated during amplifier-less operation by
changing the motor current (#8001+20n) using the user program.)
• Servo ready signal
: This signal changes depending on the status of all axes servo ON command
(M2042) or servo OFF command (M3215+20n).
• Torque limiting signal : This signal turns ON by the following condition.
|Motor current value|  Torque limit value
(Note): When the positive direction and negative direction of torque limit value is
set individually using CHGT2 instruction is as follows. QDS
|Motor current value|  Positive direction torque limit or Negative direction torque limit value
• Zero pass signal
: Always ON
Each signals is shown below at the amplifier-less operation start.
(1) Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU use
• FLS signal (M2411+20n) : Normal open: OFF/Normal close: ON
• RLS signal (M2412+20n) : Normal open: OFF/Normal close: ON
• DOG signal (M2414+20n) : Normal open: OFF/Normal close: ON
(2) Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1) use
• FLS signal (M2411+20n) : ON
• RLS signal (M2412+20n) : ON
• DOG signal (M2414+20n) : OFF
The servo amplifier external signals can be operated during amplifier-less operation by turning ON/OFF the
FLS signal (M2411+20n), RLS signal (M2412+20n) or DOG signal (M2414+20n) using the user program.
Home position return
All home position return methods can be used.
Absolute position system
The absolute position is controlled as the normal servo amplifier connection.
(1) At the amplifier-less operation start
The absolute position is restored by the saved absolute position data. The absolute position is restored as
the travel value "0" during the servo amplifier's power supply OFF.
(2) During amplifier-less operation
Suppose the servo motor operated during amplifier-less operation, and the absolute position data is
refreshed.
(3) The servo amplifiers are connected after amplifier-less operation
The absolute position is restored by the refreshed absolute position data during amplifier-less operation.
When the distance between the motor position of saved absolute position data and actual motor
position is the allowable travel during Power-Off or more away, the minor error (Error code: 901 (real
mode)/9010 (virtual mode)) will occur. If the distance is "2147483648[PLS]" or more away, the absolute
position is restored normally.
Operation using
MR Configurator
Online operation and monitor of the servo amplifiers cannot be executed.
Optional data monitor
Driver communication
Only "position feed back" and "absolute position encoder single revolution position" are possible.
The other monitor values are "0".
Cannot change to amplifier-less operation when connected and not connected servo amplifier axes are mixed.
Change to amplifier-less operation when all axes are connected, or disconnect all axes of the servo amplifier.
4 - 57
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(3) Procedure to start/release of amplifier-less operation
(a) Procedure to start
1) Set "-20: Start command 1 of amplifier-less operation (EMI invalid)" in
SD803.
2) Check that "-1: Execute waiting" is set in SD508.
(Start processing execute waiting of amplifier-less operation)
3) Set "-2: Execute command" in SD803.
4) Check that "0: Command accept waiting" is set in SD508.
(Start processing completion of amplifier-less operation)
5) Check that "ON: During amplifier-less operation" is set in SM508.
Resume operation of servo amplifier after checking the servo ready
(M2415+20n) ON.
SSCNET control command
(SD803)
Start command of
amplifier-less operation
Execute command
-20
-2
0
Execute command clear
0
Start completion of amplifier-less operation
SSCNET control status
(SD508)
0
-1
Command accept
waiting
Amplifier-less operation
status (SM508)
Start execute wating of
amplifier-less operation
-2
0
Start processing execution of
amplifier-less operation
Command accept
waiting
ON
OFF
During amplifier-less
operation
During normal operation
(b) Procedure to release
1) Set "-25: Release command of amplifier-less operation" in SD803.
2) Check that "-1: Execute waiting" is set in SD508.
(Release processing execute waiting of amplifier-less operation)
3) Set "-2: Execute command" in SD803.
4) Check that "0: Command accept waiting" is set in SD508.
5) Check that "OFF: During normal operation" is set in SM508.
(Release processing completion of amplifier-less operation. When the
servo amplifiers are connected, they are automatically reconnected.)
SSCNET control command
(SD803)
Release command of
amplifier-less operation
Execute command
-25
-2
0
Execute command clear
0
Release completion of amplifier-less operation
SSCNET control status
(SD508)
0
Command accept
waiting
Amplifier-less operation
status (SM508)
-1
-2
0
Release execute waiting of
amplifier-less operation
Release processing execution
of amplifier-less operation
Command accept
waiting
ON
OFF
During amplifier-less operation
4 - 58
During normal
operation
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(4) Program
Program to start/release of amplifier-less operation for the self CPU
(a) Motion SFC program (SV13/SV22)
Operation release
Operation start (EMI input invalid)
Release processing of
amplifier-less operation
Start processing of amplifier-less
operation
[G40]
[G10]
[F12]
[G20]
[F20]
[G41]
!SM508
Check the normal
operation.
[G41]
SD508==0
Check the accept status.
[G10]
SD803=-20
Set "-20: Start command 1
of amplifier-less operation"
in SD803.
[F11]
SD508==-1
Execute waiting
SD803=-2
Set "-2: Execute command"
in SD803.
[F20]
SM508
Check the amplifier-less
operation.
[G40]
[G20]
SM508
Check the amplifier-less
operation.
SD508==0
Check the connect
command accept status.
SD803=-25
Set "-25: Release command
1 of amplifier-less operation"
in SD803.
SD508==-1
Execute waiting
SD803=-2
Set "-2: Execute command"
in SD803.
!SM508
Check the normal
operation.
END
END
4 - 59
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.12 Remote Operation
This function is used to control the following operation of Motion CPU using
MT Developer2.
• Remote RUN/STOP
• Remote latch clear
POINT
Latch clear can be executed only using the remote control of MT Developer2.
4.12.1 Remote RUN/STOP
The PLC ready flag (M2000) is turned ON/OFF using MT Developer2 with RUN/STOP
switch of Motion CPU module set to RUN.
(1) Operation procedure
Select [RUN] or [STOP] on "CPU remote operation" screen displayed by menu
[Online] – [Remote Operation], and click [Execute] button.
Refer to the help of MT Developer2 for details of the operation procedure.
4 - 60
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
POINT
(1) Remote RUN cannot be executed if RUN/STOP switch sets to STOP.
Operation after remote operation by RUN/STOP switch is shown below.
Position of RUN/STOP switch
RUN
Remote operation
STOP
Execute remote RUN
RUN
STOP
Execute remote STOP
STOP
STOP
(2) The following parameters are read by turning on the PLC ready flag (M2000).
• Fixed parameter
• Home position return data
• JOG operation data
• Parameter block
• Work coordinate data (SV43)
• Servo parameter
• Mechanical system program (SV22 virtual mode)
• Motion SFC parameter (SV13/SV22)
• Motion parameter (SV43)
• Limit switch output data
• Cam data (SV22 advanced synchronous control)
REMARK
The PLC ready flag (M2000) can also be turned ON/OFF (PCPU READY complete
flag (SM500) ON/OFF) in the following methods.
• RUN/STOP switch change
• PLC ready flag (M2000) ON/OFF
4 - 61
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.12.2 Remote latch clear
Device data of Motion CPU that latched are cleared by MT Developer2 at PLC
ready flag (M2000) OFF (PCPU READY complete flag (SM500) OFF).
Operation for remote latch clear is combined with remote RUN/STOP.
(1) Operation procedure
(a) Turn OFF the PLC ready flag (M2000) (PCPU READY complete flag
(SM500) OFF) by remote STOP.
(b) Select [Latch clear (1)] or [Latch clear (1)(2)] on "CPU remote operation"
screen displayed by menu [Online] – [Remote Operation], and click
[Execute] button.
(Note): Execute remote RUN to turn ON the PLC ready flag (M2000) after
remote latch clear.
Refer to the help of MT Developer2 for details of the operation procedure.
POINT
(1) Remote latch clear cannot be operated while the PLC ready flag (M2000) is ON
(PCPU READY complete flag (SM500) is ON) or test mode.
(2) The following latch area are cleared in the remote latch clear operation.
• Latch clear (1)
: Clear the range set in latch area (1)
• Latch clear (1)(2) : Clear the range set in latch area (1) and (2)
(3) The user area (#0 to #7999) of motion device are also cleared by executing
remote latch clear.
(4) All of the user device not latched are cleared by the remote latch clear operation
of latch area (1) and (2).
(5) Set the range of latch area (1) and (2) in the system basic setting of system
setting. (Refer to Section 3.1.3.)
4 - 62
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.13 Communication Function via PERIPHERAL I/F
Ver.!
The built-in Ethernet Motion CPU (Q173DSCPU /Q172DSCPU/Q173DCPU-S1/
Q172DCPU-S1) can communicate data by connecting built-in PERIPHERAL I/F of the
Motion CPU with personal computers and/or display devices, etc. using an Ethernet
cable.
There are following three ways to communicate between the Motion CPU and
MT Developer2.
• "Direct connection" connected with the Ethernet cable
• "Connection via HUB" connected via HUB
• MC protocol communication
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
4.13.1 Direct connection
Between the Motion CPU and MT Developer2 can be connected using one Ethernet
cable without HUB.
The direct connection enables communication with only specifying connection target.
IP address setting is not required.
Ethernet cable (Crossover cable)
PERIPHERAL I/F
MT Developer2
4 - 63
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(1) Communication setting in MT Developer2 side
Set the items on the Transfer Setup screen in MT Developer2 as shown below.
1)
2)
3)
1) Select [Ethernet Board] for PC side I/F.
2) Select [PLC Module] for CPU side I/F.
Select the "Ethernet Port Direct Connection" on the CPU side I/F Detailed
Setting of PLC Module screen.
Select "Ethernet Port
Direct Connection"
3) Make the setting for Other Station Setting.
Select it according to the operating environment.
4 - 64
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(2) Precautions
Precautions for direct connection are shown below.
(a) Connection to LAN line
When the Motion CPU is connected to LAN line, do not perform
communication using direct connection. If performed, the communication
may put a load to LAN line and adversely affect communications of other
devices.
(b) Connection not connected directly
• The system configuration that connects a Motion CPU with an external
device using a hub as shown below is not regarded as direct connection.
HUB
• When two or more Ethernet ports are enables in the network connections
setting on the personal computer, communication by direct connection is
not possible. In the setting, leave only one Ethernet port enabled for direct
connection and disable the other Ethernet ports.
(c) Condition in which direct connection communication may not be available
Under the following conditions, direct connection communication may not be
available. In that case, check the setting of the Motion CPU and/or personal
computer.
• In the Motion CPU IP address, bits corresponding to "0" in the personal
computer subnet mask are all ON or all OFF.
(Example) Motion CPU IP address
: 64. 64. 255. 255
Personal computer IP address : 64. 64. 1. 1
Personal computer subnet mask : 255.255. 0. 0
• In the Motion CPU IP address, bits corresponding to the host address for
each class in the personal computer IP address are all ON or all OFF.
(Example) Motion CPU IP address
: 64. 64. 255. 255
Personal computer IP address : 192.168. 0. 1
Personal computer subnet mask : 255. 0. 0. 0
4 - 65
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.13.2 Connection via HUB
Between the Motion CPU and MT Developer2 can be connected via HUB.
Ethernet cable
(Straight cable)
Ethernet cable
(Straight cable)
PERIPHERAL I/F
MT Developer2
HUB
Panel computer
(1) Setting in Motion CPU side
Set the items on the Built-in Ethernet Port Setting in Basic Setting as shown
below.
1)
2)
1) Set the Motion CPU IP address.
(Default IP address: 192.168.3.39)
Change the IP address if required.
No need to set "Subnet Mask Pattern" and "Default Router IP Address".
4 - 66
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
2) Select the protocol ("TCP" or "UDP") to be used, in accordance with the
external device on the Built-in Ethernet Port Open Setting screen.
Select "TCP" to emphasize communication reliability.
• Enabling the parameters of Motion CPU
Using Ethernet direct connection or USB/RS-232 connection, write the
settings in parameter to the Motion CPU by selecting [Online] - [Write to
CPU] in MT Developer2. After writing the parameter settings, power the
Multiple CPU system OFF to ON or reset using the RUN/STOP/RESET
switch so that the parameters become valid.
Connect directly with an Ethernet cable (crossover cable) between the
personal computer and Motion CPU to write the parameters using the
Ethernet cable. Refer to Section 4.13.1 for details.
4 - 67
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(2) Communication setting in MT Developer2 side
Set the items on the Transfer Setup screen in MT Developer2 as shown below.
1)
2)
3)
1) Select [Ethernet Board] for PC side I/F.
2) Select [PLC Module] for CPU side I/F.
Select the "Connection via HUB" on the CPU side I/F Detailed Setting of PLC
Module screen, and set the Motion CPU IP address.
Select the "Connection
via HUB"
Set the Motion CPU
IP address
3) Make the setting for Other Station Setting.
Select it according to the operating environment.
4 - 68
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
POINT
The Find CPU function can be used for specifying the IP address for Motion CPU side in
the connection via HUB.
This function can be activated in [Find CPU (Built-in Ethernet port) on Network] of CPU
side I/F Detailed Setting of PLC Module screen, finds the Motion CPU connected to the
same HUB as MT Developer2, and displays a list. Select the connecting Motion CPU
and click [Select IP Address Input] button to set the IP address for Motion CPU side.
Found Motion CPU
is displayed.
[Selection IP Address
Input] button
[Find CPU (Built-in
Ethernet port) on
Network] button
• Set the label and comment of the Motion CPU in [CPU Name Setting] of Basic Setting.
The label and comment set in [CPU Name Setting] are displayed on the CPU side I/F
Detailed Setting of PLC Module screen.
Item
Description
Setting range
Label
Enter a label (name and/or purpose) of the Motion CPU.
Up to 10 characters
Comment
Enter comments regarding the Motion CPU.
Up to 64 characters
4 - 69
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(3) Precautions
Precautions for connection via HUB are shown below.
(a) When the personal computer that can connect to LAN line is used, set the
same value for Motion CPU IP address as the following personal computer
IP address.
Motion CPU
IP address
192
168
3
39
Set the same value as the
personal computer IP address
(Example) Personal computer IP address: "192.168.3.1"
<Setting for Motion CPU side>
Set the same value as the personal
computer IP address.
(Example) 192.168.3.
Set the IP address not used with devices
connected to network.
(Example) . . .39
<Setting for MT Developer2 side>
Set the same value as the Motion CPU
IP address.
(Example) 192.168.3.39
4 - 70
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(b) The maximum number of devices that can access to one Motion CPU
simultaneously is 16.
(c) Hubs with 10BASE-T or 100BASE-TX ports can be used.
(The ports must comply with the IEEE802.3 100BASE-TX or IEEE802.3
10BASE-T standards.)
(d) The Ethernet cables must to be installed away from power cabling/lines.
(e) The module operation is not guaranteed if any of the following connection is
used. Check the module operation on the user side.
• Connections using the Internet (general public line)
• Connections using devices in which a firewall is installed
• Connections using broadband routers
• Connections using wireless LAN
(f) When multiple Motion CPUs are connected to MT Developer2, beware of the
below cautions:
• IP addresses must be different for each Motion CPU.
• Different projects must be used for each Motion CPUs on MT Developer2.
4 - 71
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.13.3 MC protocol communication
PERIPHERAL I/F of the Motion CPU enables communication using the
(Note-1)
.
MC protocol
External devices such as personal computers and display devices read/write device
data from/to the Motion CPU using the MC protocol.
External devices monitor the operation of the Motion CPU, analyze data, and manage
production by reading/writing device data.
REMARK
(Note-1): The MC protocol is an abbreviation for the MELSEC communication
protocol.
The MELSEC communication protocol is a name of the communication
method used to access CPU modules from external devices in accordance
with the communication procedure of Q-series programmable controllers
(such as serial communication modules, Ethernet modules).
For details on the MC protocol, refer to the "MELSEC-Q/L Communication
Protocol Reference Manual".
POINT
External devices such as personal computers and display devices can
communicate with only the Motion CPU connected by Ethernet using the MC
protocol.
An access to any of the following CPU modules is not available.
• CPU modules on other stations, via CC-Link or others.
(1) Setting for MC protocol communication
Setting for communication using the MC protocol is described below.
Set the items of following (a) to (c) in the Built-in Ethernet Port Setting of the
Basic Setting of MT Developer2.
(c)
(a)
(b)
4 - 72
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(a) Communication data code
Select a communication data code used for the MC protocol, "Binary code"
or "ASCII code".
(b) Enable online change (MC protocol)
Check the checkbox to enable online change when writing data to the
Motion CPU from the external device that communicates using the MC
protocol.
For details on the available functions with this setting, refer to this section (2).
(c) Open Setting
Set the following items.
1) Protocol
Select a connection used as MC protocol. (Up to 16 CPU modules can
be connected.)
2) Open System
Select "MC protocol".
3) Host Station Port No. (Required)
Set the host station port number (in hexadecimal).
• Setting range : 0401H to 1387H, 1392H to FFFEH
1)
2)
3)
POINT
When the "Enable online change (MC protocol)" box is unchecked, if a data write
request is sent from an external device to the Motion CPU which is in the RUN
status, data will not be written to the Motion CPU and the module returns the NAK
message.
4 - 73
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(2) Command list
When the PERIPHERAL I/F of the Motion CPU communicates using the MC
protocol, commands listed in table below can be executed.
Command
(Subcommand)
Function
Batch read
Batch write
Random read
(Note-2)
(Note-1)
In units
of bits
0401
(0001)
In units
of words
0401
(0000)
In units
of bits
1401
(0001)
In units
of words
1401
(0000)
In units
of words
0403
(0000)
In units
of bits
1402
(0001)
Device
memory
Test
(Random write)
Monitor
registration
(Note-2), (Note-3),
(Note-4), (Note-6)
Monitor
(Note-6)
In units
of words
(Note-2)
1402
(0000)
In units
of words
0801
(0000)
In units
of words
0802
(0000)
Status of Motion CPU
Description
Number of
processed points
Reads bit devices in units of one point.
ASCII : 3584 points
BIN : 7168 points
Reads bit devices in units of 16 points.
960 words
(15360 points)
Reads word devices in units of one point.
Writes bit devices in units of one point.
Writes bit devices in units of 16 points.
960 words
(15360 points)
Writes word devices in units of one point.
Reads word devices in units of one or two
points by randomly specifying a device or
device number.
Sets/resets bit devices in units of one point by
randomly specifying a device or device
number.
Sets/resets bit devices in units of 16 or 32
points by randomly specifying a device or
device number.
Write
Write
enabled disabled
960 points
ASCII : 3584 points
BIN : 7168 points
Reads bit devices in units of 16 or 32 points
by randomly specifying a device or device
number.
RUN
STOP
960 points
192 points
188 points
(Note-5)
Writes word devices in units of one or two
points by randomly specifying a device or
device number.
Registers bit devices to be monitored in units
of 16 or 32 points.
Registers word devices to be monitored in
units of one or two points.
Monitors devices registered.
192 points
Number of
registered points
: Available,
(Note-1): Subcommand is for the QnA-compatible 3E frame.
(Note-2): Devices such as TS, TC, SS, SC, CS, and CC cannot be specified in units of words.
For the monitor registration, an error (4032H) occurs during the monitor operation.
(Note-3): During monitor registration, monitor condition cannot be set.
(Note-4): Do not execute monitor registration from multiple external devices. If executed, the last monitor registration becomes valid.
(Note-5): Set the number of processed points so that the following condition is satisfied.
(Number of word access points) 12 + (Number of double-word access points) 14  1920
• Bit devices are regarded as 16 bits during word access and 32 bits during double-word access.
• Word devices are regarded as 1 word during word access and 2 words during double-word access.
(Note-6): Only Motion CPU module connected by Ethernet can be used.
4 - 74
: Not available
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(3) Available devices
The devices available in commands used in the MC protocol communication
function is shown below.
(a) PLC CPU
Device code
Classification
Device
Internal system
device
Special relay
SM
91h
000000 to 002047
Special register
SD
A9h
000000 to 002047
Decimal
Input
X
9Ch
000000 to 001FFF
Hexadecimal
Output
Y
9Dh
000000 to 001FFF
Hexadecimal
Internal relay
M
90h
000000 to 008191
Decimal
Latch relay
L
92h
000000 to 008191
Decimal
Annunciator
F
93h
000000 to 002047
Decimal
Edge relay
V
94h
000000 to 002047
Decimal
Link relay
B
A0h
000000 to 001FFF
Hexadecimal
File register
Extended data
register
Extended link
register
Binary code
Device number range (Default)
Remarks
Decimal
D
A8h
000000 to 012287
Decimal
Link register
W
B4h
000000 to 001FFF
Hexadecimal
000000 to 002047
Decimal
000000 to 002047
Decimal
000000 to 001023
Decimal
Retentive
timer
Contact
TS
C1h
Coil
TC
C0h
Current
value
TN
C2h
Contact
SS
C7h
Coil
SC
C6h
Current
value
SN
C8h
Contact
CS
C4h
Coil
CC
C3h
Current
value
CN
C5h
Link special relay
SB
A1h
000000 to 0007FF
Hexadecimal
Link special register
SW
B5h
000000 to 0007FF
Hexadecimal
Step relay
S
98h
000000 to 008191
Decimal
Direct input
DX
A2h
000000 to 000FFF
Hexadecimal
Direct Output
DY
A3h
000000 to 000FFF
Hexadecimal
Decimal
Counter
Index register
(Note-1)
Data register
Timer
Internal user
device
ASCII code
Index register
File register
Extended data register
Extended link register
Z
CCh
000000 to 000019
R
AFh
000000 to 032767
Decimal
ZR
B0h
000000 to 3FD7FF
Hexadecimal
A8h
• Binary:
000000 to 4184063
(4086k points maximum)
• ASCII:
000000 to 999999
(976.6k points maximum)
B4h
000000 to 3FD7FF
(4086k points maximum)
D
W
• When the device number range is
changed, access is possible up to
the largest device number after the
change.
• Local devices cannot be accessed.
Devices of DX/DY1000 or later are not
available. Use X/Y devices to access
devices of DX/DY1000 or later.
—
Decimal
If the number of points is set on the
PLC file tab of PLC parameter, access
is possible up to the largest device
number after the setting.
However, in the ASCII code
communication, the number of points
described on the left is the access
limit.
Hexadecimal
If the number of points is set on the
PLC file tab of PLC parameter, access
is possible up to the largest device
number after the setting.
(Note-1): When data is communicated in ASCII code, the second character "
4 - 75
—
" can be designated a blank space (code: 20H).
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(b) Motion CPU
Device code
Classification
Device
Internal system
device
Special relay
SM
91h
000000 to 002255
Decimal
Special register
SD
A9h
000000 to 002255
Decimal
Internal user
device
ASCII code
(Note-1)
Device number range (Default)
Binary code
Remarks
—
Input
X
9Ch
000000 to 001FFF
Hexadecimal
Including actual input device PX.
Output
Y
9Dh
000000 to 001FFF
Hexadecimal
Including actual input device PY.
Internal relay
M
90h
000000 to 012287
Decimal
Annunciator
F
93h
000000 to 002047
Decimal
Link relay
B
A0h
000000 to 001FFF
Hexadecimal
Data register
D
A8h
Link register
W
B4h
000000 to 001FFF
Hexadecimal
Motion register
#
E0h
000000 to 012287
Decimal
000000 to 008191
(Note-2)
Decimal
—
(Note-1): When data is communicated in ASCII code, the second character " " can be designated a blank space (code: 20H).
(Note-2): The range of 000000 to 019823 is valid in the SV22 advanced synchronous control.
(4) Precautions
(a) Number of connected modules
In the connection with external devices using the MC protocol, the number
of Motion CPUs set as "MELSOFT Connection" in the Open Setting on Builtin Ethernet Port Setting of Basic Setting can be connected simultaneously.
(b) Data communication frame
Table below shows the frames available in the communication function
using the MC protocol with PERIPHERAL I/F.
Communication frame
Communication function using the MC protocol
with PERIPHERAL I/F
4E frame
QnA-compatible 3E frame
A-compatible 1E frame
: Available, : Not available
(c) Access range
1) Only Motion CPU connected by Ethernet can be accessed.
Accessing a Motion CPU not connected by Ethernet results in an error.
2) Accessing a Motion CPU on another station in CC-Link IE controller
network, MELSECNET/H, Ethernet or CC-Link via a connected Motion
CPU is not possible.
(d) Precautions when UDP protocol is selected
1) If a new request message is sent to the same UDP port while the port
waits for a response message, the new request message is discarded.
2) Setting same host station port number to multiple UDP ports is regarded
as one setting. When communicating with multiple external devices
using the same host station port number, select TCP protocol.
4 - 76
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(e) Response message receive processing
Figure below shows an example of the response message receive
processing on the external device side.
Communication processing
on the external device side
Request message send processing
Response message receive processing
Is TCP connection open?
TCP connection is closed.
Receive the rest of
response messages.
Has the data
been received other than the
monitoring timer?
The monitoring timer has run over.
The receive data exceeds
the size limit.
Check the receive data size.
Processing for response messages
The response message
for the following request
has been received.
Has processing
for all received messages
completed?
END
Error processing
REMARK
Personal computers use the TCP socket functions internally for Ethernet
communication.
These functions do not have boundary concept. Therefore, when data is sent by
executing the "send" function once, the "recv" function needs to be executed once or
more to receive the same data. (One execution of the "send" function does not
correspond to one execution of the "recv" function.)
For this reason, receive processing described above is required on the external
device side. If the "recv" function is used in blocking mode, data may be read by
executing the function once.
4 - 77
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(5) Error codes for communication using MC protocol
Table below shows the error codes, error descriptions, and corrective actions
that will be sent from the Motion CPU to an external device when an error occurs
during communication using the MC protocol.
No.
Error code
(Hexadecimal)
1
4000H to 4FFFH
Description
Corrective action
Motion CPU detected error (Error that occurred in
other than communication using the MC protocol)
Refer to the QCPU User's Manual (Hardware Design,
Maintenance and Inspection) and take corrective
action.
0055H
When the setting for online change is disabled on the
Built-in Ethernet Port Setting of Basic Setting in
MT Developer2, an external device requested online
change to the Motion CPU.
• When enabling online change, write data.
• Change the status of the Motion CPU to STOP and
write data.
3
C050H
• Set the communication data code to binary code and
When the communication data code setting is set to
restart the Motion CPU for communication.
ASCII code in the Built-in Ethernet Port Setting, ASCII
code data that cannot be converted to binary code was • Correct the send data on the external device side and
resend the data.
received.
4
C051H to C054H
The number of device points for reading/writing is
outside the allowable range.
Correct the number of device points for reading/writing
and resend the data to the Motion CPU.
5
C056H
The read/write request data exceeds the allowable
address range.
Correct the start address or the number of device
points for reading/writing, and resend the data to the
Motion CPU.
(Do not exceed the allowable address range.)
6
C058H
The request data length after the ASCII to binary
conversion does not match the data size of the
character area (a part of text data).
Correct the text data or the request data length of the
header data, and resend the data to the Motion CPU.
7
C059H
• The command and/or subcommand are specified
incorrectly.
• The command and/or subcommand not supported in
the Motion CPU are specified.
• Check the request data.
• Use commands and/or subcommands supported in
the Motion CPU.
8
C05BH
The Motion CPU cannot read/write data from/to the
specified device.
Check the device for reading/writing data.
9
C05CH
The request data is incorrect. (ex. specifying data in
units of bits for reading/writing of word devices)
Correct the request data (such as subcommand
correction) and resend the data to the Motion CPU.
10
C05DH
Monitor registration is not performed.
Perform the monitor registration before monitor
operation.
11
C05FH
The external device sent a request that cannot be
executed in the Motion CPU.
• Correct the network number, PC number, request
destination module I/O number, and request
destination module station number.
• Correct the read/write request data.
12
C060H
The request data is incorrect. (ex. incorrect
specification of data for bit devices)
Correct the request data and resend the data to the
Motion CPU. (ex. data correction)
13
C061H
The request data length does not match the data size
of the character area (a part of text data)
Correct the text data or the request data length of the
header data, and resend the data to the Motion CPU.
14
C070H
The device memory extension cannot be specified for
the target station.
Read/Write data to the device memory without
specifying the extension.
15
C0B5H
Data that cannot communicate in the Motion CPU is
specified.
• Check the request data.
• Stop the current request.
2
4 - 78
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.14 Mark Detection Function
QDS
Any motion control data and all device data can be latched at the input timing of the
mark detection signal. Also, data within a specific range can be latched by specifying
the data detection range.
The following three modes are available for execution of mark detection.
1) Continuous Detection mode
The latched data is always stored at mark detection.
Operation is the same as the high-speed reading function.
Mark detection signal
Mark detection data
storage device
+0n
2) Specified Number of Detection mode
The latched data from a specified number of detections is stored.
Example) Number of detections: 3
Mark detection signal
Mark detection data
storage device
+0n
The 4th detection
and later are ignored.
+1n
+2n
The 3rd detection
+3n
3) Ring Buffer mode
The latched data is stored in a ring buffer for a specified number of detections.
The latched data is always stored at mark detection.
Example) Number of detections: 4
Mark detection signal
Mark detection data
storage device
+0n
The 5th detection
replaces the previous
first detection.
+1n
+2n
+3n
The 4th detection
(Note): "n" in above figure is different depending on the data type storage device.
• 16-bit integer type
:1
• 32-bit integer type
:2
• 64-bit floating-point type : 4
4 - 79
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(1) Operations
Operations done at mark detection are shown below.
• Calculations for the mark detection data are estimated at leading edge/trailing
edge of the mark detection signal.
However, when the Specified Number of Detection mode is set, the current
mark detection is checked against the counter value for number of mark
detections and then it is determined whether or not to latch the current detection
data.
• When a mark detection data range is set, it is first confirmed whether the mark
detection data is within the range or not. Data outside the range are not
detected.
• The mark detection data is stored in the first device of the mark detection data
storage area according to the mark detection mode, and then the number of
mark detections counter is updated.
Operation examples for each mode are shown in the table below.
(a) Continuous Detection mode
Confirmation of mark detection data range
(Upper/lower value setting: Valid)
Mark detection signal
(Leading edge detection
setting)
Data outside range are not latch.
Mark detection data current
value
Real current value
(Continuous update)
Mark detection data storage
device
Detected real current value
Number of mark detections
counter
0
Detected real current value
1
2
"0 clear" by user program
(b) Specified Number of Detection mode (Number of detections: 2)
Confirmation of mark detection data range
(Upper/lower value setting: Valid)
Mark detection signal
(Leading edge detection
setting)
Mark detection data current
value
Real current value
(Continuous update)
Mark detection data storage
device
Detection real current value (1st)
Mark detection data storage
device (2nd area)
Number of mark detection
counter
Mark detection is not executed
because the counter for number of
mark detections is already 2 (More
than the number of detections).
Detection real current value (2nd)
0
1
"0 clear" by user program
4 - 80
2
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(2) Mark detection setting
The mark detection setting parameters are shown below.
Up to 32 mark detections setting can be registered.
No.
Item
Setting range
Built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI)/Q172DLX (DOG/CHANGE)/Device (Bit device (X, Y, M,
B, SM, U \G))
Mark detection signal
1
2
Mark detection signal detection
(Note-1)
direction
Mark detection signal compensation
-5000000 to 5000000[µs]/Word device (D, W, #, U \G)
(Note-2)
time
Mark detection data
3
At device
selection
Motion control data/Device (Word device (D, W, #, SD, U \G))
Data type
16-bit integer type/32-bit integer type/64-bit floating-point type
Estimate
calculation
Valid (Normal data)/Valid (Ring counter)/Invalid
Ring counter
value
4
Mark detection data storage device
5
Mark detection data
range
Upper value
Lower value
7
8
16-bit integer type
: K1 to K32767, H001 to H7FFF
32-bit integer type
: K1 to K2147483647, H00000001 to H7FFFFFFF
64-bit floating-point type : K2.23E-308 to K1.79E+308
Word device (D, W, #, U \G)
Direct designation (K, H)/Word device (D, W, #, U \G)
16-bit integer type
: K-32768 to K32767, H0000 to HFFFF
32-bit integer type
: K-2147483648 to K2147483647, H00000000 to HFFFFFFFF
64-bit floating-point type : K-1.79E+308 to K-2.23E-308, K0, K2.23E-308 to K1.79E+308
Continuous detection mode/Specified number of detection mode/Ring buffer mode/
(Note-3)
Device (Word device (D, W, #, U \G))
Mark detection mode setting
6
Valid on leading edge/Valid on trailing edge
Number of detections
1 to 8192 (Specified number of detection mode/Ring buffer mode)
Mark detection times counter
—
Mark detection current value
monitor device
—
Mark detection signal status
—
(Note-4)
(Continuous detection mode)/Word device (D, W, #, U \G)
(Note-4)
/Word device (D, W, #, U \G)
(Note-4)
/Bit device (X, Y, M, B, U \G)
(Note-1): Set the input signal detection direction of built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI) in the "CPU Setting" of system setting.
For the input signal detection direction of Q172DLX (DOG/CHANGE), select "Q172DLX" of "Motion slot setting" and set the
direction with detail setting.
(Note-2): The mark detection signal compensation time cannot be set if "Invalid" is selected in the estimate calculation. (0[µs] is set.)
(Note-3): When the setting value is outside the range of "-8192 to 8192", the mark detection is invalid.
(Note-4): This setting can be omitted.
(a) Mark detection signal
Set the input signal for mark detection.
1) Module input signal
a) Built-in interface in Motion CPU
Input module
Built-in interface in
Motion CPU
Signal
DI
Module No.
Q173DSCPU
Q172DSCPU
—
4 - 81
Signal No.
Detection
accuracy [µs]
1 to 4
30
Signal detection direction
(Leading edge/Trailing edge)
Set direction in the "CPU
Setting" of system settings.
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
b) Q172DLX
• Install the Q172DLX to the main base to use Q172DLX
(DOG/CHANGE). If the Q172DLX is installed to the extension base,
the mark detection function cannot be used.
• The mark detection operation is executed at the DOG/CHANGE
signal input with the count type home position return or speedposition switching control.
Set the device in the "mark detection mode setting" and setting
value outside "-8192 to 8192" to invalidate the mark detection.
• The signal which does not set the axis No. in the system setting
can be also used as the mark detection signal.
Input
module
Module No.
Signal
Q173DSCPU Q172DSCPU
Q172DLX DOG/CHANGE
1 to 4
1 to 2
Signal No.
1 to 8
Detection accuracy [µs]
Signal detection direction
(Leading edge/Trailing edge)
Select "Q172DLX" of "Motion
• I/O response time 0.4[ms]: 69
slot setting" in the system
• I/O response time 0.6[ms]: 133
setting and set the direction
• I/O response time 1.0[ms]: 261
with detail setting.
2) Bit device
Bit device
X(PX)
Y(PY)
M
0 to 1FFF
(Note-1)
0 to 1FFF
0 to 8191
(Note-2)
B
0 to 1FFF
SM
0 to 1999
U \G
Signal detection direction
(Leading edge/Trailing edge)
Detection accuracy [µs]
Setting range
• Operation cycle 222[µs]
: 222
• Operation cycle 444[µs] or more : 444
10000.0 to (10000+p-1).F
Set direction in the mark
detection signal detection
direction.
(Note-3)
(Note-1): The range of "PXn+4 to PXn+F" cannot be used (fixed at 0) for the input device (PXn+0 to PXn+F)
allocated to the built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI). (n: First input No.)
(Note-2): The range of M0 to M12287 is valid in the SV22 advanced synchronous control.
(Note-3): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed transmission area for each CPU.
(b) Mark detection signal detection direction
Set whether to execute the mark detection to valid on leading edge (OFF to
ON) or valid on trailing edge (OFF to ON) of input signal.
Set the input signal detection direction in the System Settings as shown
below.
• For built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI)
Set direction in the "CPU Setting" of system settings.
• For Q172DLX (DOG/CHANGE)
Select "Q172DLX" of "Motion slot setting" in the system setting and set the
direction with detail setting.
Input signal detection direction
Valid on leading edge
Valid on trailing edge
4 - 82
Remarks
The mark detection is executed when the mark
detection signal transitions from OFF to ON.
The mark detection is executed when the mark
detection signal transitions from ON to OFF.
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(c) Mark detection signal compensation time
Compensate the output timing of the mark detection signal.
Set it to compensate for sensor input delays, etc. (Set a positive value to
compensate for a delay.)
However, the mark detection signal compensation time cannot be set if
"Invalid" is selected in the estimate calculation. (0[µs] is set.)
The timing is compensated as "-5000000" when the compensation time is
set to less than -5000000, and it is compensated as "5000000" when it is set
to more than 500000.
1) Direct designation
Setting range
-5000000 to 5000000 [µs]
2) Indirect designation
Word device
Setting range
D
0 to 8191
W
Remarks
(Note-2)
0 to 1FFF
#
U \G
(Note-1)
The setting value is input for
every operation cycle.
0 to 9215
10000 to (10000+p-1)
(Note-3)
(Note-1): Set an even number as the first device.
(Note-2): The range of D0 to D19823 is valid in the SV22 advanced synchronous control.
(Note-3): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed transmission
area for each CPU.
4 - 83
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(d) Mark detection data
Set the data to latch at mark detection.
1) Motion control data
Item
Unit
Feed current value
-1
Data type
Axis No. setting range
Q173DSCPU
Q172DSCPU
1 to 32
1 to 16
Remarks
-5
10 [µm], 10 [inch],
-5
10 [degree], [PLS]
Real current value
Motor real current value
32-bit integer type
Servo command value
Position feed back
Absolute position encoder single revolution
position
Absolute position encoder multiple revolution
position
Deviation counter value
[PLS]
—
—
16-bit integer type
[PLS]
Servo command speed
[PLS/s]
Motor speed
0.01[r/min]
Motor current
0.1[%]
32-bit integer type
16-bit integer type
1 to 12
Synchronous encoder current value
Virtual servomotor feed current value
Current value within one cam shaft revolution
(Note-1)
[PLS]
Valid in SV22
virtual mode
only
Current value within one cam shaft revolution
(Note-2)
(Actual)
1 to 32
Command generation axis feed current value
Command generation axis cumulative
current value
Control unit
1 to 16
32-bit integer type
Command generation axis current value per
cycle
Synchronous encoder axis current value
Synchronous encoder axis current value per
cycle
Valid in SV22
only
Encoder axis unit
1 to 12
(Note-3)
Valid in SV22
advanced
synchronous
control only
Ver.!
Cam axis current value per cycle
Cam axis current value per cycle (Actual)
(Note-4)
Cam axis cycle unit
1 to 32
1 to 16
(Note-1): Set the synchronous encoder No. (P1 to 12) allocated in the system setting.
(Note-2): Current value within one cam shaft revolution takes into consideration the delay of the servo amplifier.
(Note-3): Set the axis No. (axis 1 to 12) of the synchronous encoder axis parameter set in the synchronous
control parameter.
(Note-4): Current value per cycle takes into consideration the delay of the servo amplifier.
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
4 - 84
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
Since the system-specific delay exists in the current value data of the
synchronous encoder axis, there may be a difference between the
actual current value and the current value of mark detection.
When the "synchronous encoder current value", "synchronous encoder
axis current value" or "synchronous encoder axis current value per
cycle" is used in the mark detection data, the mark detection signal
compensation time shown below can be set to compensate the delay.
However, when the "phase compensation advance time" is set in the
synchronous control parameter to compensate the delay of the
synchronous encoder, setting of the mark detection signal compensation
time is not necessary.
Synchronous encoder type
Mark detection signal compensation time [µs]
Built-in interface in Motion CPU
0
Incremental synchronous encoder
0
MR-HENC
-232
Q171ENC-W8
-276
2) Word device data
Word device
Setting range
0 to 8191
D
W
0 to 1FFF
#
0 to 9215
SD
U \G
Remarks
(Note-1)
—
0 to 1999
10000 to (10000+p-1)
(Note-2)
(Note-1): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed transmission
area for each CPU.
(Note-2): The range of D0 to D19823 is valid in the SV22 advanced synchronous control.
3) Data type
Set the data type at word device data setting.
Data type
Remarks
16-bit integer type
—
32-bit integer type
64-bit floating-point type
4 - 85
Set the device No. as an even No.
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4) Estimate calculation
Set the estimate calculation to "Valid/Invalid" at the word device data
setting.
Estimate calculation
Ring counter value
Normal data
—
16-bit integer type
Valid
Ring counter 32-bit integer type
K1 to K32767, H0001 to H7FFF
K1 to K2147483647,
H00000001 to H7FFFFFFF
64-bit floating-point type K2.23E-308 to K1.79E+308
Invalid
—
a) Estimate calculation : Valid
Calculation for word device data in the operation cycle is estimated.
The latch data is the value estimated at the timing in which the mark
detection signal is input. The value is calculated as shown in the
figure below whether the word device data is normal data or a ring
counter. Set the ring counter value for the ring counter.
• Valid (Normal data)
Operation
cycle
Estimate line
Word device data
Latch data
t
Mark detection signal
• Valid (Ring counter)
Operation
cycle
Ring counter value
Latch data
Estimate line
Word device data
t
Mark detection signal
POINT
If "Valid (Normal data)" is selected for word device data updated as a ring counter,
the latch data may not be estimated correctly.
4 - 86
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
b) Estimate calculation : Invalid
Calculation for word device data in operation cycle is not estimated.
The latch data is the word device data at the timing in which the
mark detection signal is input. The detection accuracy is the
operation cycle regardless of the mark detection signal type.
Operation
cycle
Word device data
Latch data
t
Mark detection signal
(e) Mark detection data storage device
Set the mark detection data storage device (first device to use in the
"Specified Number of Detections mode" or "Ring Buffer mode").
When using the "Specified Number of Detections mode" or "Ring Buffer
mode", reserve the device area to accommodate the number of detections.
Word device
D
W
Setting range
0 to 8191
(Note-1)
Remarks
(Note-2)
0 to 1FFF
(Note-3)
#
0 to 9215
U \G
10000 to (10000+p-1)
—
(Note-4)
(Note-1): Set an even numbered device in the 32-bit integer type/64-bit floating-point type.
(Note-2): The range of D0 to D19823 is valid in the SV22 advanced synchronous control.
(Note-3): The data can be stored in #9216 to #12287 in the "Specified Number of Detections mode"
or "Ring Buffer mode".
(Note-4): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed transmission area
for each CPU.
4 - 87
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(f) Mark detection data range
When the data at mark detection is within the range, they are stored in the
mark detection data storage device and the number of mark detections
counter is incremented by 1.
• Upper limit value > Lower limit value
The mark detection is executed when the mark detection data is "greater or
equal to the lower limit value and less than or equal to the upper limit
value".
t
Lower limit
value
Upper limit
value
• Upper limit value < Lower limit value
The mark detection is executed when the mark detection data is "greater or
equal to the lower limit value or less than or equal to the upper limit value".
t
Lower limit
value
Upper limit
value
• Upper limit value = Lower limit value
The mark detection range is not checked. The mark detection is always
executed.
1) Direct designation
Data type
Setting range
16-bit integer type
K-32768 to K32767, H0000 to HFFFF
32-bit integer type
K-2147483648 to K2147483647, H00000000 to HFFFFFFFF
64-bit floating-point type K-1.79E+308 to K-2.23E-308, K0, K2.23E-308 to K1.79E+308
2) Indirect designation
Word device
D
Setting range
0 to 8191
(Note-1)
W
0 to 1FFF
#
0 to 9215
U \G
Remarks
(Note-2)
10000 to (10000+p-1)
The setting value is input for every
operation cycle.
(Note-3)
(Note-1): Set an even numbered device in the 32-bit integer type/64-bit floating-point type.
(Note-2): The range of D0 to D19823 is valid in the SV22 advanced synchronous control.
(Note-3): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed transmission area
for each CPU.
4 - 88
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(g) Mark detection mode setting
Set the data storage method of mark detection.
1) Direct designation
Mode
Continuous
detection mode
Number of
detections
Operation for mark detection
Mark detection data storage method
—
Always
The data is updated in the mark detection
data storage device.
Number of detections
(If the number of mark detections counter is
the number of detections or more, the mark
detection is not executed.)
Always
(The mark detection data storage device is
used as a ring buffer for the number of
detections.)
The data is stored in the following device
area.
"Mark detection data storage device +
Number of mark detections counter ×
Mark detection data size"
Specified number
of detection mode
1 to 8192
Ring buffer mode
1 to 8192
2) Indirect designation
Word device
D
Setting range
0 to 8191
W
0 to 1FFF
#
0 to 9215
U \G
Remarks
(Note-1)
10000 to (10000+p-1)
(Note-2)
• Used as 1 word device.
• Set the mark detection mode using the following setting values.
0
: Continuous detection mode
1 to 8192 : Specified number of detection mode (Set the number of
detections.)
-8192 to -1 : Ring buffer mode (Set the value that make the number of
buffers into negative value.)
Others
: Mark detection : Invalid
• The setting value is input for every operation cycle.
(Note-1): The range of D0 to D19823 is valid in the SV22 advanced synchronous control.
(Note-2): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed transmission area for each CPU.
(h) Number of mark detections counter
The counter value is incremented by 1 at mark detection. Preset the initial
value (0, etc.) in the user program to execute the mark detection in
"Specified Number of Detections mode" or "Ring Buffer mode".
This setting can be omitted when the continuous detection mode is selected.
Word device
D
Setting range
0 to 8191
Remarks
(Note-1)
W
0 to 1FFF
#
0 to 9215
• Used as 1 word device.
• The counter is updated as follows after the mark detection data storage.
Continuous detection mode: 0 to 65535
The counter value is incremented by 1.
It returns to 0 when the counter value exceeds 65535.
Specified number of detection mode: 0 to (number of detections)
U \G
10000 to (10000+p-1)
(Note-2)
The counter value is incremented by 1.
Ring buffer mode: 0 to (number of buffers -1)
The counter value is incremented by 1.
It returns to 0 when the counter value reaches the set number of
buffers or more.
(Note-1): The range of D0 to D19823 is valid in the SV22 advanced synchronous control.
(Note-2): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed transmission area for each CPU.
4 - 89
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(i) Mark detection current value monitor device
The current value of mark detection data can be monitored.
This setting can be omitted.
Word device
D
Setting range
0 to 8191
(Note-1)
W
0 to 1FFF
#
0 to 9215
U \G
Remarks
(Note-2)
10000 to (10000+p-1)
The monitor value is updated for
every operation cycle.
(Note-3)
(Note-1): Set an even number as device in the 32-bit integer type/64-bit floating-point type.
(Note-2): The range of D0 to D19823 is valid in the SV22 advanced synchronous control.
(Note-3): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed transmission area
for each CPU.
(j) Mark detection signal status
The ON/OFF status of mark detection signal can be monitored.
This setting can be omitted.
Bit device
X
Setting range
0 to 1FFF
Y
0 to 1FFF
M
0 to 8191
B
0 to 1FFF
U \G
Remarks
(Note-1)
10000.0 to (10000+p-1).F
The ON/OFF status is reflected for
every operation cycle.
(Note-2)
(Note-1): The range of "PXn+4 to PXn+F" cannot be used (fixed at 0) for the input device (PXn+0 to
PXn+F) allocated to the built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI). (n: First input No.)
(Note-2): Set an even number as device in the 32-bit integer type/64-bit floating-point type.
4 - 90
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.15 High-speed Input Request Signal Setting (SV22 advanced synchronous control only)
QDS
Ver.!
Set the high-speed input request signal assignment.
The high-speed input request signal is the signal to execute the high-accuracy control
of the clutch ON/OFF operation of synchronous control or the counter enable/counter
disable/current value change operation of the synchronous encoder axis.
The example of current value change of the synchronous encoder axis using
Q173DPX (TREN1) as the high-speed input request signal is shown below.
[Md.320]Synchronous encoder axis
current value
(D13240+20n, D13241+20n)
High-speed input request signal 3
(Q173DPX (TREN1))
OFF
High-speed input request signal
valid flag
OFF
High-speed input request signal
status
OFF
[Cd.320]Synchronous encoder axis
control start condition (D14822+10n)
(Note-1)
ON
t
ON
ON
103: High-speed input request signal 3
[Cd.321]Synchronous encoder axis
control method (D14823+10n)
0: Current value change
(Note-1): The input signal detection direction of
TREN1 signal is set to normal open.
(1) High-speed input request signal setting
The High-speed input request signal setting data are shown below.
Up to 32 signals can be registered.
No.
Item
Setting range
(Note-1)
Built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI)/Q172DLX (DOG/CHANGE)/Q172DEX (TREN)/
Q173DPX (TREN)
1
High-speed input request signal
2
High-speed input request signal
compensation time
3
High-speed input request signal valid flag —
4
High-speed input request signal status
-5000000 to 5000000[µs]/Word device (D, W, #, U \G)
—
(Note-2)
/Word device (D, W, #, U \G)
(Note-2)
/Bit device (X, Y, M, B, U \G)
(Note-1): Set the input signal detection direction of built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI) in the "CPU Setting" of system setting.
For the input signal detection direction of Q172DLX (DOG/CHANGE), select "Q172DLX" of "Motion slot setting" and set the
direction with detail setting.
For the input signal detection direction of Q172DEX (TREN), select "Q172DEX" of "Motion slot setting" and set the direction
with detail setting.
For the input signal detection direction of Q172DPX (TREN), set the direction with dip switch of Q173DPX.
(Note-2): This setting can be omitted.
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
4 - 91
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(a) High-speed input request signal
Set the input signal for high-speed input request signal.
1) Built-in interface in Motion CPU
Input module
Built-in interface in
Motion CPU
Signal
Module No.
Q173DSCPU
DI
Q172DSCPU
—
Signal No.
Detection
accuracy [µs]
1 to 4
30
Signal detection direction
(Leading edge/Trailing edge)
Set direction in the "CPU
Setting" of system settings.
2) Q172DLX/Q172DEX/Q173DPX
Install the Q172DLX to the main base to use Q172DLX
(DOG/CHANGE)/Q172DEX (TREN)/Q173DPX (TREN).
If the Q172DLX/Q172DEX/Q173DPX is installed to the extension base,
the high-speed input request signal cannot be used.
Input
module
Q172DLX
Signal
DOG/CHANGE
Module No.
Q173DSCPU Q172DSCPU
1 to 4
1 to 2
Signal No.
Detection accuracy [µs]
Select "Q172DLX" of "Motion
slot setting" in the system
setting and set the direction
with detail setting.
1 to 8
Q172DEX
TREN
1 to 6
1 to 2
Q173DPX
TREN
1 to 4
1 to 3
Signal detection direction
(Leading edge/Trailing edge)
• I/O response time 0.4[ms]: 69
Select "Q172DEX" of "Motion
• I/O response time 0.6[ms]: 133
slot setting" in the system
• I/O response time 1.0[ms]: 261
setting and set the direction
with detail setting.
Set the direction with dip
switch of Q173DPX.
(b) High-speed input request signal compensation time
Compensate the input timing of the high-speed input request signal.
Set it to compensate for sensor input delays, etc. Set a positive value to
compensate for a delay, and set a negative value to compensate for an
advance.
However, high-speed input request status outputs the status of the signal
with no relation to the set value.
The timing is compensated as "-5000000" when the compensation time is
set to less than -5000000, and it is compensated as "5000000" when it is set
to more than 500000.
1) Direct designation
Setting range
-5000000 to 5000000 [µs]
2) Indirect designation
Word device
Setting range
(Note-1)
D
0 to 8191
W
0 to 1FFF
#
0 to 9215
U \G
10000 to (10000+p-1)
Remarks
The setting value is input for
every operation cycle.
(Note-2)
(Note-1): Set an even number as the first device.
(Note-2): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed transmission
area for each CPU.
4 - 92
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(c) High-speed input request signal valid flag
The high-speed input request signal is valid only when the flag is ON.
The high-speed input request signal is invalid when the flag is OFF.
This setting can be omitted.
The high-speed input request signal is always valid when it is ignored.
Bit device
X
Setting range
0 to 1FFF
Remarks
(Note-1)
Y
0 to 1FFF
ON/OFF command is input when the
M
0 to 8191
high-speed input request signal is
B
0 to 1FFF
U \G
10000.0 to (10000+p-1).F
detected.
(Note-2)
(Note-1): The range of "PXn+4 to PXn+F" cannot be used (fixed at 0) for the input device (PXn+0 to
PXn+F) allocated to the built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI). (n: First input No.)
(Note-2): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed transmission area
for each CPU.
(d) High-speed input request signal status
The ON/OFF status of high-speed input request signal can be monitored.
ON/OFF status can be monitored regardless of the status of the high-speed
input request signal valid flag.
This setting can be omitted.
Bit device
X
Setting range
0 to 1FFF
Y
0 to 1FFF
M
0 to 8191
B
0 to 1FFF
U \G
Remarks
(Note-1)
10000.0 to (10000+p-1).F
The ON/OFF status is reflected for
every operation cycle.
(Note-2)
(Note-1): The range of "PXn+4 to PXn+F" cannot be used (fixed at 0) for the input device (PXn+0 to
PXn+F) allocated to the built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI). (n: First input No.)
(Note-2): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed transmission area
for each CPU.
POINT
When signal is inputted in a state where the detection of high-speed input request
signal is unnecessary ([St.380] Synchronous control (M10880+n) is turned OFF, or
[Rq.320] Synchronous encoder axis control request (M11601+4n) is turned OFF),
the high-speed input request signal valid flag turns OFF. Turn ON when the
detection of high-speed input request signal is necessary.
4 - 93
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.16 Driver Communication Function
QDS
Ver.!
This function uses the "Master-slave operation function" of servo amplifier. The Motion
CPU controls the master axis and the slave axis is controlled by data communication
(driver communication) between servo amplifiers without going through the Motion
CPU.
This function is used for the case such as to operate the ball screw controlled by
multiple axes via the belt.
There are restrictions in the function that can be used by the version of the servo
amplifier.
Refer to the "Servo amplifier Instruction Manual" for details.
The following shows the number of settable axes for the master axis and slave axis.
Model name
Number of
SSCNET (/H)
lines
Number of
control
axes
Q173DSCPU
2 lines
32 axes
Q172DSCPU
1 line
16 axes
Combination of number of settable axes
Master axis
SSCNET
(Note-1)
1 axis to 8 axes
1 axis to 4 axes
SSCNET /H
(Note-2)
Slave axis
1 axis to 16 axes
1 axis to 8 axes
—
Remark
The axes other than the master
axis and slave axis can be used
as normal axis.
—: No restriction
(Note-1): Up to 4 axes per line are settable in the master axis.
(Note-2): Up to 8 axes per line are settable in the master axis.
POINT
Driver communication function is only valid in MR-J3- B and MR-J4- B.
MR-J4W- B and MR-J3W- B cannot be used.
Nor can MR-J4W- B be used in MR-J3- B compatibility mode.
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
4 - 94
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.16.1 Control details
Set the master axis and slave axis in the servo parameter.
Execute each control of Motion CPU in the master axis. (However, be sure to execute
the servo ON/OFF of slave axis, and error reset at servo error occurrence in the slave
axis.) The servo amplifier set as master axis receives command (positioning command,
speed command, torque command) from the Motion CPU, and sends the control data
to the servo amplifier set as slave axis by driver communication between servo
amplifiers.
The servo amplifier set as the slave axis is controlled by the control data transmitted
from the master axis by driver communication between servo amplifiers.
Motion CPU
Servo amplifier
MR-J3- B/MR-J4- B
SSCNET (/H)
Master axis: Position command, speed command or torque command is received
from Motion CPU.
Slave axis : Control data is received from Master axis by driver communication.
Master axis
Slave axis 2
Slave axis 1
[Driver
communication]
Control data 1
Control data 2
Control data 3
Slave axis 3
[Driver
communication]
[Driver
communication]
Control data 2
Control data 3
Control data 3
Positioning command/
speed command/
torque command
d1
Axis 1
ABS/INC
d2
Axis 2
INC
d3
Axis 3
INC
d4
Axis 4
INC
POINT
When a servo amplifier fails due to a SSCNET (/H) communication failure,
communication with the axes after the failed axis cannot be executed. For this
reason, be sure to connect the master axis to the position closest to the Motion
CPU.
4 - 95
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.16.2 Precautions during control
CAUTION
During operation by driver communication function, the positioning control or JOG operation, etc.
by servo program is not interrupted even if a servo error occurs in the slave axis. Be sure to stop
the master axis by user program.
(1) Servo amplifier
(a) For the axes where driver communication is executed, be sure to use a
servo amplifier that supports driver communication.
(b) Driver communication function is only valid in MR-J3- B and MR-J4- B.
MR-J4W- B and MR-J3W- B cannot be used.
Nor can MR-J4W- B be used in MR-J3- B compatibility mode.
(c) Be sure to connect the master CPU and slave CPU in the same
SSCNET (/H) line.
(d) The master CPU and slave CPU combination is set in the servo parameters.
After writing the servo parameters, turn ON again or reset the Multiple CPU
system power supply so that the parameters become valid.
(e) The differences between SSCNET and SSCNET /H communication
method in driver communication function are shown below.
Communication method
SSCNET
SSCNET /H
Communication with
servo amplifiers after
Multiple CPU system
power supply ON.
Servo amplifier cannot be operated until
connection with all axes set to driver
Servo amplifiers cannot be operated until
communication is confirmed.
connection with all axes set by system
Normal axes (axes not set to driver
setting is confirmed.
communication) can also be connected
after the network is established.
Connect/disconnect
with servo amplifier
Only the first axis of the SSCNET line
(servo amplifier connected directly to the
Motion CPU) can connect/disconnect.
Only normal axes (axes not set to driver
Only the first axis of the SSCNET line
communication) other than the first axis
(servo amplifier connected directly to the
can be connected when they are
Motion CPU) can connect/disconnect.
disconnected. However, when axes set
Servo amplifiers other than the first axis
to driver communication are
can be disconnected but cannot be
disconnected, they cannot communicate
connected.
with servo amplifiers that were
connected after disconnecting. (The
servo amplifier's LED display remains
"AA")
4 - 96
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(f)
If all axes set to driver communication are not detected at the start of
communication with the servo amplifier, all axes connected to that line,
including normal axes cannot be operated. (The servo amplifier's LED
display remains "Ab").
Check with the following SSCNET searching flags (SM532, SM533) if a
SSCNET line can be operated.
When all normal axes and axes set to driver communication are connected,
the SSCNET searching flags (SM532, SM533) turn OFF.
Device No.
SM532
SM533
Name
SSCNET
(Line 1)
SSCNET
(Line 2)
searching flag
searching flag
Details
Set by
• Turns ON when searching axes that
have been set by system setting in
line 1 or line 2.
• Turns OFF when all axes that have
been set by system setting in line 1 or
line 2 have been searched.
OFF: Search complete
ON : Searching
S
(Change status)
(2) Positioning dedicated device used for positioning control of slave
axis
In the slave axis, only the following positioning dedicated devices are valid.
Do not use devices other than the following.
(a) Axis status
(Note-1)
• Zero pass (M2406+20n)
• Servo error detection (M2408+20n)
• Servo ready (M2415+20n)
(Note-1): Because the slave axis cannot execute home position return, it
does not use this in control.
(b) Axis command signal
• Servo error reset command (M3208+20n)
• Servo OFF command (M3215+20n)
(c) Axis monitor device
• Servo error code (D8+20n)
• Torque limit value (D14+20n)
(d) Control change register
Control change registers (D640+20n, D641+20n) that apply to the slave axis
become invalid.
Control change registers (D640+20n, D641+20n) in virtual mode become
valid for the virtual servo.
4 - 97
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(e) Common device
The following common devices that apply to the slave axis cannot be used.
Do not use an interlock.
• Start accept flag (M2001 to M2032)
• Speed change accepting flag (M2061 to M2092)
• Automatic decelerating flag (M2128 to M2159)
• Speed change "0" accepting flag (M2240 to M2271)
• Control loop monitor status (M2272 to M2303)
(3) Current position management
(a) Set "0: Used in incremental system" in " Absolute position detection system
(PA03)" of servo parameter for slave axis.
(b) Because the slave axis is in torque control and operates by input from the
master axis, current feed value and deviation counter are not updated.
However, the real current value is updated.
(During servo ON, the current feed value is not a value that reflects the
motor movement amount. If servo is turned OFF, the current feed value is a
value that reflects the motor movement amount. The deviation counter is
always 0.)
(c) The home position return request (M2409+20n) of slave axis is always ON
but has no influence on the control of slave axis.
(d) During slave operation, the following slave axis external signals, and
parameters are invalid.
• Upper stroke limit signal (FLS)
• Lower stroke limit signal (RLS)
• Stop signal (STOP)
• Upper/lower stroke limit value of fixed parameter
(e) Do not operate the slave axis by a method other than driver communication
with the master axis. If operated by a method other than driver
communication, commands to the servo amplifier become invalid and
current feed value and other current position management cannot be
guaranteed.
(4) Servo program
Do not set the slave axis to the start axis of the servo program.
When slave axis is started, the position commands to the servo amplifier become
invalid.
4 - 98
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(5) Mechanical system program
(a) Do not set the slave axis to the output modules of the mechanical system
program or the real mode axis. When the slave axis is set to output modules
of the mechanical system program or the real mode axis, the position
commands to the servo amplifier become invalid.
(b) If a servo error occurs in the slave axis during operation by driver
communication function, the "Error time operation mode" which was set in
the mechanical system program does not apply. Measures at an error
occurrence should be executed in the user program.
(6) Advanced synchronous control
(a) The master axis can be set to the servo input axis, or the output axis.
(b) When the slave axis is set to the servo input axis, set [Pr.300] Servo input
axis type to "2: Real current value", or "4: Feedback value".
When set to anything else, the slave axis does not operate as input axis.
(c) Do not set the slave axis to output axis. When the slave axis is set to output
axis, the position commands to the servo amplifier become invalid.
(7) Motion dedicated PLC instruction
Do not execute the following Motion dedicated PLC instructions for slave axis.
When executed they become invalid.
• D(P).SVST (Start request of the specified servo program)
• D(P).CHGV (Speed change request of the specified axis)
(8) Motion SFC program
Do not execute the following instructions for slave axis. When executed they
become invalid.
• CHGV (Speed change request)
• CHGP (Target position change request)
(9) Control mode of master axis
The control mode of the master axis can switch between position control mode,
speed control mode, and torque control mode. For the master axis, when a
switch to continuous operation to torque control mode is executed, there is a
minor error (error code: 155), and the control mode does not switch.
(10) Control mode of slave axis
(a) Because the slave axis is always controlled by torque mode, the control
mode (b2, b3) of servo status1 (#8010+20n) is in torque control mode ([0,
1]).
(b) Do not operate slave axis by speed-torque control. For the slave axis,
when a control mode switch is executed, or is operated by speed-torque
control, the speed-torque control commands become invalid.
4 - 99
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.16.3 Servo parameter
Set the following parameters for the axes that execute the master-slave operation.
(Refer to the "Servo amplifier Instruction Manual" for details.)
No.
Item
Setting details
Setting range
MR-J3- B
MR-J4- B
0000h to 2100h
0000h to 2100h
0000h to 0011h
0000h to 0011h
0000h to FFFFh
0000h to FFFFh
0000h to FFFFh
0000h to FFFFh
PA04
Function selection A-1
Set the forced stop input and forced stop
deceleration function.
(Note): Set "0: Forced stop deceleration
function disabled" for forced stop
deceleration function selection.
PD15
Driver communication setting
Set the master axis and slave axis.
PD16
Driver communication setting
Master transmit data selection 1
PD17
Driver communication setting
Master transmit data selection 2
PD20
Driver communication setting
Master axis No. selection 1 for slave
Set the axis No. (d1 to d16) of master
axis at slave axis setting.
0 to 16
0 to 32
PD30
Master-slave operation - Torque
command coefficient on slave
Set the coefficient to reflect the internal
torque command with the torque
command value from the master axis.
0000h to 01FFh
0 to 500
PD31
Master-slave operation - Speed limit
coefficient on slave
Set the coefficient to reflect the internal
speed limit command with the speed
limit command value from the master
axis.
0000h to 01FFh
0 to 500
PD32
Master-slave operation - Speed limit
adjusted value on slave
Set the lowest value of the internal
speed limit.
0000h to 7FFFh
0 to 32767
Set the transmitted data at master axis
setting.
POINT
After writing the servo parameters to the Motion CPU, turn ON again or reset the
Multiple CPU system power supply so that the parameters become valid.
4 - 100
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.17 Intelligent Function Modules Controlled by Motion CPU
The Motion CPU can be used as the control CPU of intelligent function modules
(excluding some modules).
Up to 4 intelligent function modules in total can be used.
The intelligent function modules that can be controlled by the Motion CPU are shown
in Table 4.1.
Table 4.1 Intelligent function modules controlled by Motion CPU list
Module name
Model name
Number of
points
Number of usable modules
Q173DSCPU/
Q172DSCPU
Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)
Remark
Q68ADV
Q62AD-DGH
Analogue input
module
Q66AD-DG
Q68ADI
Q64AD
Q64AD-GH
Total 4 modules
(256 points or less)
Q68AD-G
Q68DAVN
Q68DAIN
Analogue output
module
16 points
Q62DAN
Q62DA-FG
Q64DAN
Q66DA-G
Analogue input/output
module
Q64AD2DA
QD62D
High-speed counter
module Ver.!
Cannot use coincidence detection
interrupt function.
Total 4 modules
(256 points or less
(Note-1)
)
QD65PD2
Cannot use coincidence detection
interrupt function and periodic interrupt
function.
QD75P1
QD75P2
QD75P4
Positioning module
Ver.!
QD75D1
—
QD75D2
QD75D4
QD75MH1
32 points
QD75MH2
QD75MH4
Simple Motion module
Ver.!
QD77MS4
QD77MS16
Control unit of
displacement sensor
Ver.!
QD77MS2
UQ1-01
Manufactured by Optex FA Co., LTD.
Cannot use dedicated setting
software.
UQ1-02
(Note-1): Number of I/O points is total of "Built-in interface in Motion CPU (Input 4 points) + I/O module + intelligent function module".
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
4 - 101
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(1) Setting method
Select "General", "Analog input", or "Analog output" in the Motion slot setting of
intelligent function module and set the detail setting.
Refer to the help of MT Developer2 for details of the operation procedures.
Select the intelligent
function module
POINT
(1) Modules that can be used as a Motion CPU (Q172DLX, Q173DPX, Q172DEX,
QI60 etc.) cannot be set as an intelligent function module. When these are set
as intelligent function module, there is a system setting error.
(2) The valid/invalid of "Error time output mode" settings differ for each intelligent
function module. Refer to the manual of each intelligent function module for
details.
(2) Access to the intelligent function module
Use the TO and FROM instructions from Motion SFC programs to access the
buffer memory of the intelligent function modules.
Also, you can access the I/O signal of the intelligent function module in the first
I/O No. set in the system setting.
POINT
When reading or writing 2 words of data or more using the FROM instruction or TO
instruction, if the start address of the buffer memory is set to an even number, data
will be read/written in units of 2 words.
4 - 102
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(3) Usage example
An example using Q64AD2DA is shown below.
(a) Detail setting
Setting item
First I/O No.
Setting details
0030
Points
16 points
Switch setting
Input format
Hexadecimal
Switch 1
02A0H (CH1 to CH4: Input range setting)
Switch 2
0020H (CH5, CH6: Output range setting)
Switch 3
0010H (CH5, CH6: Analog output HOLD/CLEAR function)
Switch 4
0100H (High resolution mode setting)
Switch 5
Error time output mode
0000H (Fixed at 0)
Clear
(b) Motion SFC program
PX30*!PY39*PX39 //Unit ready and operating condition setting
request OFF, and operating condition setting
complete ON?
//Initial setting program
#0=0
TO H30,0,#0,1
//Enables A/D conversion of CH1
(Write to buffer memory 0)
TO H30,200,#0,1 //Enables A/D conversion of CH2
(Write to buffer memory 200)
#0=2
//Sets average processing of CH2
#1=50
//Sets average processing of CH2
TO H30,201,#0,2 //Write to buffer memory 201 to 202
#0=0
//Sets A/D conversion scaling function of CH2
#1=1000
//Sets A/D conversion scaling function of CH2
#2=5000
//Sets A/D conversion scaling function of CH2
TO H30,210,#0,3 //Write to buffer memory 210 to212
#0=0
//Enables A/D conversion of CH3
#1=3
//Sets average processing of CH3
#2=10
//Sets average processing of CH3
TO H30,400,#0,3 //Write to buffer memory 400 to 402
#0=1
//Defaults input signal error detection of CH3
#1=100
//Defaults input signal error detection of CH3
TO H30,420,#0,2 //Write to buffer memory 420 to 421
#0=0
TO H30,800,#0,1 //Enables D/A conversion of CH5
(Write to buffer memory 800)
TO H30,1000,#0,1 //Enables D/A conversion of CH6
(Write to buffer memory 1000)
#0=0
//Sets D/A conversion scaling function of CH6
#1=1000
//Sets D/A conversion scaling function of CH6
#2=5000
//Sets D/A conversion scaling function of CH6
TO H30,1010,#0,3 //Write to buffer memory 1010 to 1012
SET PY39
//Turns ON operating condition setting request
!PX39 //Operating condition setting complete OFF?
RST PY39 //Turns OFF operating condition setting request
4 - 103
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.18 Connection of SSCNET /H Head Module
QDS
Ver.!
The MELSEC-L series SSCNET /H head module (LJ72MS15) can be connected to
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU (SV13/SV22).
4.18.1 System configuration
A system configuration that uses SSCNET /H head modules is shown below.
Motion CPU module
Q17 DSCPU
Servo amplifier
MR-J4(W)- B
SSCNET /H
head module
LJ72MS15
I/O module,
intelligent function
module
SSCNET /H
MT Developer2
Servo amplifier
MR-J4(W)- B
GX Works2
SSCNET /H head module
LJ72MS15
SSCNET /H
Q173DSCPU: 2 lines (Up to 8 stations
(Up to 4stations/line))
Q172DSCPU: 1 line (Up to 4 stations)
Q173DSCPU: 2 lines (Up to 32 axes (Up to 16axes/line))
Q172DSCPU: 1 line (Up to 16 axes)
POINT
The parameters of the SSCNET /H head module and modules mounted to the
SSCNET /H head module are set using GX Works2.
Refer to the "MELSEC-L SSCNET /H Head Module User's Manual" for details of
the SSCNET /H head module.
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
4 - 104
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.18.2 SSCNET /H head module parameters
(1) Parameter setting
Set the parameters to use the SSCNET /H head module.
The parameters are set using MT Developer2.
The setting items for parameters are shown in table 4.2.
Table 4.2 SSCNET /H head module parameter list
No.
Item
Setting range
Default value
0: Invalid/1: Valid
0: Invalid
Station number
1 to 64
—
Axis No.
0 to 8
—
Bit device : X, Y, M, B
Word device : D, W, #, U \G
—
Bit device : 16 to 512
Word device : 1 to 32
—
1
Valid setting
2
3
Device name
4
Refresh device
Points
setting (CPU side)
(RX, RWr, RY, RWw)
Start
X0 to X1FFF/Y0 to Y1FFF/M0 to M8191/B0 to B1FFF/
(Note-1)
/#0 to #9215/W0 to W1FFF/
D0 to D8191
(Note-2)
U \G10000 to (U \G10000+p-1)
—
5
Status device
M0 to M8176/B0 to B1FFF/
D0 to D8191/#0 to #9215/W0 to W1FFF/
(Note-2)
U \G10000 to (U \G10000+p-1)
—
6
Monitor device
D0 to D8191/#0 to #9215/W0 to W1FFF/
(Note-2)
U \G10000 to (U \G10000+p-1)
—
7
Command device
M0 to M8176/B0 to B1FFF/
D0 to D8191/#0 to #9215/W0 to W1FFF/
(Note-2)
U \G10000 to (U \G10000+p-1)
—
(Note-1): Range of D0 to D19823 is valid for SV22 advanced synchronous control.
(Note-2): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high speed transmission area for each CPU.
POINT
(1) The number of SSCNET /H head module stations that can be connected to a
SSCNET /H line according to operation cycle settings, are as follows.
Operation cycle [ms]
Stations connected
0.88
Up to 4 stations
0.44
Up to 2 stations
0.22
Up to 1 station
(a) Valid setting
Set valid/invalid of SSCNET /H head module
• 0: Invalid ........... Not using SSCNET /H head module
• 1: Valid ............. Using SSCNET /H head module
4 - 105
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(b) Station number
Set the station number of SSCNET /H head module.
The same station number can be used for line 1 and line 2.
Cannot use the same station number as the axis No. of the servo amplifier.
(Example) When using servo amplifier setting "d01", cannot set station
number to "1".
Setting range
1 to 64
(c) Axis No.
Set the axis No. of SSCNET /H head module.
(For Motion SFC programs, this number is used for specifying).
Cannot use the same axis No. for line 1 and line 2.
The same Motion axis No. and axis No. can be used.
Communication is not executed with a station that has axis No. set to "0".
(Use as a reserved axis.)
There can be duplicate axis No. 0.
Setting range
0 to 8
(d) Refresh device setting (CPU side)
Set the device (RX, RWr, RY, RWw) for storage of link data.
Motion CPU device is set using automatic refresh by cyclic transmission of
the SSCNET /H head module.
Link devices (RX, RWr, RY, RWw) of the Motion CPU are automatically
assigned in MT Developer2.
POINT
Link devices (RX, RWr, RY, RWw) of the Motion CPU are used only for internal
processing. These cannot be used in user data such as Motion SFC programs etc.
1) Device name
Set the device name that stores link data.
• Bit device : X, Y, M, B
• Word device : D, W, #, U \G
2) Points
Set the points of the device that stores link data. Set the points of the
device in units of words.
The total points for bits and words must be 64 bytes or less.
Device
Bit device (X, Y, M, B)
Setting range
(Note-1)
Word device (D, W, #, U \G)
(Note-1): Set in units of 16 points (1 word).
4 - 106
16 to 512
1 to 32
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
3) Start
Set the start device number that stores link data.
• Bit device
Bit device
Setting range
X
0 to 1FFF
Y
0 to 1FFF
M
0 to 8191
B
0 to 1FFF
• Word device
Word device
Setting range
0 to 8191
D
(Note-1)
W
0 to 1FFF
#
0 to 9215
U \G
10000 to (10000+p-1)
(Note-2), (Note-3)
(Note-1): The range of D0 to D19823 is valid in the SV22 advanced
synchronous control.
(Note-2): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high
speed transmission area for each CPU.
(Note-3): Only device of the self CPU can be used.
(e) Status device
Set the device for storage of the status of the SSCNET /H head module.
1) Usable devices are shown below.
• Bit device
Bit device
Setting range
(Note-1)
M
0 to 8191
B
0 to 1FFF
(Note-1): Set the start device as a unit of 16 points.
• Word device
Word device
Setting range
D
0 to 8191
W
0 to 1FFF
#
0 to 9215
U \G
10000 to (10000+p-1)
(Note-1), (Note-2)
(Note-1): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high
speed transmission area for each CPU.
(Note-2): Only device of the self CPU can be used.
4 - 107
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
2) The device uses 16 points (1 point if a word device) from the specified
device number.
The details stored in the status device are shown below.
Off set
Signal name
Refresh cycle
+0
+1
+2
+3
Unusable
—
+4
+5
+6
+7
During stop error
Operation cycle
+8
+9
+10
+11
Unusable
—
+12
+13
+14
+15
During continue error
Operation cycle
a) During stop error
Can be used to judge whether there is an error or not by the signal
turning ON when a stop error is detected in the SSCNET /H head
module.
The applicable error code is stored in the error code signal of the
monitor device of the SSCNET /H head module set in the system
settings.
If error is reset by turning ON the error reset command, or turning
ON the SSCNET /H head module power supply again, the signal
turns OFF.
b) During continue error
Can be used to judge whether there is an error or not by the signal
turning ON when a continue error is detected in the SSCNET /H
head module.
The applicable error code is stored in the error code signal of the
monitor device of the SSCNET /H head module set in the system
settings.
If error is reset by turning ON the error reset command, or turning
ON the SSCNET /H head module power supply again, the signal
turns OFF.
4 - 108
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(f) Monitor device
Set the devices for monitoring the status of SSCNET /H head module.
1) Usable devices are shown below.
• Word device
Word device
Setting range
D
0 to 8191
W
0 to 1FFF
#
0 to 9215
U \G
10000 to (10000+p-1)
(Note-1), (Note-2)
(Note-1): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high
speed transmission area for each CPU.
(Note-2): Only device of the self CPU can be used.
2) The device uses 10 points per word from the specified device number.
The details stored in the status device are shown below.
Off set
Signal name
+0
Module operating status
+1
Error code
+2
Accumulative count for communication
retry
+3
Maximum continuous times for
communication retry
Refresh cycle
Operation cycle
At a communication
retry
+4
+5
+6
+7
Unusable
—
+8
+9
a) Module operating status
Stores the operating status of SSCNET /H head module.
• 0: No communication
• 1: STOP status
• 2: RUN status
• 3: ERROR status
b) Error code
Stores the error code when an error is detected in the SSCNET /H
head module. (Continue error and stop error)
If error is reset by turning ON the error reset command, or the
SSCNET /H head module power supply is turned ON again, this
device is also cleared.
c) Accumulative count for communication retry
Holds the accumulative count for communication retry with the
SSCNET /H head module.
d) Maximum continuous times for communication retry
Counts each time a communication retry with the SSCNET /H head
module occurs. When communication is successful, the count is "0".
4 - 109
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
(g) Command device
Set the device for commands to SSCNET /H head module.
1) Usable devices are shown below.
• Bit device
Setting range
Bit device
(Note-1)
M
0 to 8191
B
0 to 1FFF
(Note-1): Set the start device as a unit of 16 points.
• Word device
Word device
Setting range
D
0 to 8191
W
0 to 1FFF
#
0 to 9215
U \G
10000 to (10000+p-1)
(Note-1)
(Note-1): "p" indicates the user setting area points of the Multiple CPU high
speed transmission area for each CPU.
2) The device uses 16 points (1 point if a word device) from the specified
device number.
The details stored in the command device are shown below.
Off set
Signal name
Refresh cycle
+0
+1
+2
+3
Unusable
—
+4
+5
+6
+7
Error reset command
Main cycle
+8
+9
+10
+11
+12
Unusable
+13
+14
+15
4 - 110
—
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
a) Error reset command
Clears the error code storage device and resets the error code
detection signal of the SSCNET /H head module. At an error reset
command, turn this signal OFF after confirming the error detection
signal of the SSCNET /H head module is turned OFF.
However, depending on the error of the SSCNET /H head module,
an error reset may not be executed, or conditions may apply to the
error reset. In this case, the error code storage device is not cleared
and the error code detection signal is not reset, even if an alarm
reset is executed. Refer to the manual of the SSCNET /H head
module for details.
(2) Operation example of parameter
(a) When setting 2 SSCNET /H head modules (station 17, station 18) to
SSCNET line 1.
1) Parameter setting
The setting example of parameter is shown below.
Station
number
Axis
No.
Input/
Output
Input
17
1
Output
Input
18
2
Output
Link device
Refresh device
(CPU side)
(Note-1)
Device
name
Points
Start
End
Points
Start
End
RX
128
0000
007F
128
M112
M239
RWr
24
0000
0017
24
W000
W0017
RY
128
0000
007F
128
M240
M367
RWw
24
0000
0017
24
RX
0
RWr
32
RY
0
RWw
32
Status
device
Monitor
device
Command
device
M0
D2000
M16
M32
D2010
M48
W0018 W002F
0
0018
0037
32
D2020
D2051
D2052
D2083
0
0018
0037
32
(Note-1): Used only for internal processing of Motion CPU. The number of points set in the refresh device (CPU side) is automatically
assigned in MT Developer2.
4 - 111
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
2) Operation example
The example of operating parameter is shown below.
SSCNET /H head module
(Station number 17)
Motion CPU
RX (Note-1)
M
M112
SSCNET /H head module
(Station number 18)
RX
RX
0000
0000
007F
007F
0000
M239
M240
M367
RWr (Note-1)
W
W0000
RWr
RWr
0000
0000
0000
0017
0017
001F
0018
0037
W0017
W0018
W002F
RY (Note-1)
RY
RY
0000
0000
007F
007F
0000
D
RWw (Note-1)
RWw
RWw
D2020
0000
0000
0000
D2051
0017
0017
001F
D2052
0018
D2083
0037
(Note-1): Used only for internal processing of Motion CPU. The number of points set in the
refresh device (CPU side) is automatically assigned in MT Developer2.
4 - 112
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
4.18.3 Data operation of intelligent function module by Motion SFC program
In addition to refresh of data by device, data read/write operations to the buffer
memory of intelligent function modules on the SSCNET /H head module can be
executed by the RTO and RFROM instructions of Motion SFC programs.
Refer to "Q173D(S)CPU/Q172D(S)CPU Motion controller (SV13/SV22) Programming
Manual (Motion SFC)" for details.
Classification
Symbol
Instruction
Description
RTO
Write buffer memory data
to head module
Writes word device data to the buffer memory
of the intelligent function module mounted to
the SSCNET /H head module.
RFROM
Read buffer memory data
from head module
Reads data from the buffer memory of the
intelligent function module mounted to the
SSCNET /H head module, to the word device.
Others
4.18.4 Data of refresh device
The refresh of data by device, for the status of Motion CPU, or when there is a
communication failure with the head module are as follows.
Refresh of data
Bit device
Input
Output
At communication failure
occurrence
Clear
At STOP of Motion CPU
Maintain
At Motion CPU operation stop error
occurrence
Word device
Maintain
Clear
4.18.5 Precautions when using SSCNET /H head module
(1) Disconnect/reconnect function cannot be used for SSCNET /H head module.
If executed it is ignored.
4 - 113
4 AUXILIARY AND APPLIED FUNCTIONS
MEMO
4 - 114
APPENDICES
APPENDICES
APPENDIX 1 Special Relays/Special Registers
APPENDIX 1.1 Special relays
Special relays are internal relays whose applications are fixed in the Motion CPU. For
this reason, they cannot be used in the same way as the normal internal relays by the
Motion SFC programs (SV13/SV22)/Motion programs (SV43).
However, they can be turned ON/OFF as needed in order to control the Motion CPU.
The headings in the table that follows have the following meanings.
Item
No.
Explanation
• Indicates the device No. of the special relay.
Name
• Indicates the name of the special relay.
Meaning
• Indicates the nature of the special relay.
Details
• Indicates detailed information about the nature of the special relay.
• Indicates whether the relay is set by the system or user, and, if it is set by system, when
setting is performed.
<Set by>
S: Set by system (Motion CPU)
U: Set by user (Motion SFC program/Motion program or test operation using
MT Developer2)
Set by
(When set)
S/U: Set by both system (Motion CPU) and user
<When set>
Indicated only if setting is done by system (Motion CPU).
Main process: Set during each main processing (free time processing of the CPU)
Initial process: Set only during initial processing (when power supply is turned ON, or
when executed the reset)
Status change : Set only when there is a change in status
Error : Set when error is occurred.
Request : Set only when there is a user request (Special relay, etc.)
Operation cycle : Set during each operation cycle of the Motion CPU.
APP - 1
APP.
APPENDICES
Table 1.1 Special relay list
No.
Name
Meaning
Details
• Turn ON if an error occurs as a result of diagnosis.
• Remains ON even if the condition is restored to normal
thereafter.
• Turn ON by ON to OFF of the Motion error detection flag
(M2039) for except the stop error after confirming the error
content.
Diagnostic error
OFF : No error
ON : Error
SM1
Self-diagnostic error
• Turn ON if an error occurs as a result of self-diagnosis.
• Remains ON even if the condition is restored to normal
OFF : No self-diagnostic error thereafter.
ON : Self-diagnostic error
• Turn ON by ON to OFF of the Motion error detection flag
(M2039) for except the stop error after confirming the error
content.
SM51
Battery low latch
OFF : Normal
ON : Battery low
• Turn ON if the voltage of battery reduces to less than 2.5[V].
• Remains ON even if the condition is restored to normal
thereafter.
SM52
Battery low
OFF : Normal
ON : Battery low
• Turn on when the voltage of the battery reduces to less than
2.5[V].
• Turn OFF when the voltage of external battery returns to
normal.
SM0
Set by
(When set)
S (Occur an error)
• Turn ON if an instantaneous power failure of within 20[ms]
occurs during use of the AC power supply module.
Reset when the power supply is switched OFF, then ON.
SM53
AC/DC DOWN
detection
OFF : AC/DC DOWN
not detected
ON : AC/DC DOWN
detected
SM58
Battery low warning
latch
OFF : Normal
ON : Battery low
• Turn ON if the voltage of battery reduces to less than 2.7[V].
• Remains ON even if the condition is restored to normal
thereafter.
SM59
Battery low warning
OFF : Normal
ON : Battery low
• Turn on when the voltage of the battery reduces to less than
2.7[V].
• Turn OFF when the voltage of external battery returns to
normal.
SM60
• Turn ON if there is at least one output module whose fuse
has blown.
OFF : Normal
Fuse blown detection
ON : Module with blown fuse • Remains ON even if the condition is restored to normal
thereafter.
• Turn ON if an instantaneous power failure of within 10[ms]
occurs during use of the AC power supply module.
Reset when the power supply is switched OFF, then ON.
SM211 Clock data error
OFF : No error
ON : Error
• Turn ON if an error occurs in clock data (SD210 to SD213)
value, and turn OFF if no error is detected.
SM220 CPU No.1 READY
(Note-1)
complete
OFF : CPU No.1 READY
incompletion
ON : CPU No.1 READY
completion
• Turn ON if CPU No. 1 which uses Multiple CPU high speed
bus can be operated between Multiple CPU.
SM221 CPU No.2 READY
(Note-1)
complete
OFF : CPU No.2 READY
incompletion
ON : CPU No.2 READY
completion
• Turn ON if CPU No. 2 which uses Multiple CPU high speed
bus can be operated between Multiple CPU.
SM222 CPU No.3 READY
(Note-1)
complete
OFF : CPU No.3 READY
incompletion
ON : CPU No.3 READY
completion
• Turn ON if CPU No. 3 which uses Multiple CPU high speed
bus can be operated between Multiple CPU.
SM223 CPU No.4 READY
(Note-1)
complete
OFF : CPU No.4 READY
incompletion
ON : CPU No.4 READY
completion
• Turn ON if CPU No. 4 which uses Multiple CPU high speed
bus can be operated between Multiple CPU.
SM240 No.1 CPU resetting
• Goes OFF when reset of the No.1 CPU is cancelled.
• Comes ON when the No.1 CPU is resetting
OFF : CPU No.1 reset cancel
(including the case where the CPU module is removed from
ON : CPU No.1 resetting
the base).
The other CPUs are also put in reset status.
APP - 2
S (Request)
S (Change status)
Remark
APPENDICES
Table 1.1 Special relay list (Continued)
No.
Name
Meaning
Details
SM241 No.2 CPU resetting
• Goes OFF when reset of the No.2 CPU is cancelled.
• Comes ON when the No.2 CPU is resetting
OFF : CPU No.2 reset cancel
(including the case where the CPU module is removed from
ON : CPU No.2 resetting
the base).
The other CPUs result in "MULTI CPU DOWN" (error code:
7000).
SM242 No.3 CPU resetting
• Goes OFF when reset of the No.3 CPU is cancelled.
• Comes ON when the No.3 CPU is resetting
OFF : CPU No.3 reset cancel
(including the case where the CPU module is removed from
ON : CPU No.3 resetting
the base).
The other CPUs result in "MULTI CPU DOWN" (error code:
7000).
SM243 No.4 CPU resetting
• Goes OFF when reset of the No.4 CPU is cancelled.
• Comes ON when the No.4 CPU is resetting
OFF : CPU No.4 reset cancel
(including the case where the CPU module is removed from
ON : CPU No.4 resetting
the base).
The other CPUs result in "MULTI CPU DOWN" (error code:
7000).
SM244 No.1 CPU error
OFF : CPU No.1 normal
ON : CPU No.1 during stop
error
• Goes OFF when the CPU No.1 is normal. (Including a
continuation error)
(Note-2)
• Comes ON when the CPU No.1 is during stop error.
SM245 No.2 CPU error
OFF : CPU No.2 normal
ON : CPU No.2 during stop
error
• Goes OFF when the CPU No.2 is normal. (Including a
continuation error)
(Note-2)
• Comes ON when the CPU No.2 is during stop error.
SM246 No.3 CPU error
OFF : CPU No.3 normal
ON : CPU No.4 during stop
error
• Goes OFF when the CPU No.3 is normal. (Including a
continuation error)
(Note-2)
• Comes ON when the CPU No.3 is during stop error.
OFF : CPU No.4 normal
ON : CPU No.4 during stop
error
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
• Goes OFF when the CPU No.4 is normal. (Including a
continuation error)
(Note-2)
• Comes ON when the CPU No.4 is during stop error.
SM247 No.4 CPU error
SM400 Always ON
SM401 Always OFF
SM500
PCPU READY
complete
SM501 Test mode ON
SM502
External forced stop
input
Digital oscilloscope
SM503
executing
S (Main processing)
• Normally is OFF.
• When the PLC ready flag (M2000) turn OFF to ON, the
fixed parameters, servo parameters and limit switch output
data, etc., are checked, and if no error is detected, this flag
turns ON.
• Turn OFF with PLC ready flag (M2000) OFF.
ON : TEST mode ON
OFF : Except TEST mode
• Judge whether TEST mode ON or not using
MT Developer2.
• If the TEST mode is not established by TEST mode request
using MT Developer2, the TEST mode request error
(SM510) turns ON.
ON : Forced stop OFF
OFF : Forced stop ON
• Confirm forced stop ON/OFF.
ON : Digital oscilloscope is
stop
OFF : Digital oscilloscope is
executing
• Confirm the execution of digital oscilloscope using
MT Developer2.
Cam data writing flag OFF : Cam data not writing
QDS Ver.!
ON : Cam data writing
SM506
External forced stop
input ON latch Ver.!
ON : External forced stop
input is detected
OFF : External forced stop
input is not detected
S (Change status)
• Normally is ON.
ON : PCPU READY
completion
OFF : PCPU READY
incompletion
SM505
Set by
(When set)
• Turn ON during cam data writing by executing the cam data
write (CAMWR)/cam data write (cam open area: CAMWR2)/
cam auto-generation (CAMMK).
S (Request)
S (Operation cycle)
S (Change status)
• Turn ON when an external forced stop input is detected.
• Remains ON even if the condition is cancelled to thereafter.
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
APP - 3
Remark
APPENDICES
Table 1.1 Special relay list (Continued)
No.
SM508
Name
Amplifier-less
operation status
TEST mode request
SM510
error
SM512
Motion CPU WDT
error
Meaning
Details
ON : During amplifier-less
operation
• Confirm the amplifier-less operation status.
OFF : During normal operation
ON : Abnormal
OFF : Normal
• Turn ON if the TEST mode is not established by TEST mode
request using MT Developer2.
• When this relay is ON, the error content is stored in the
TEST mode request error register (SD510, SD511).
ON : Abnormal
OFF : Normal
• Turn ON when a "watchdog timer error" is detected by the
Motion CPU self-diagnosis function.
When the Motion CPU detects a WDT error, it executes an
immediate stop without deceleration of the operating axes.
• The error cause is stored in the "Motion CPU WDT error
cause (SD512)".
ON
Manual pulse
SM513 generator axis setting
error
OFF
: At least one D714 to
D719 setting is
abnormal.
: All D714 to D719
settings are normal.
• Judge whether normal/abnormal of the register for manual
pulse generator axis setting register (D714 to D719).
• When this relay is ON, the error content is stored in the
manual pulse generator axis setting error register (SD513
to SD515).
ON : Abnormal
OFF : Normal
• Judge whether normal/abnormal of the positioning data of
servo program(K) (SV13/SV22)/Motion program(SV43)
specified with the Motion SFC program, and if error is
detected this flag turns ON.
• The content of an error is stored at SD516, SD517.
Over heat warning
latch
OFF : Normal
ON : Abnormal
• Turn ON when the temperature of Motion CPU module
becomes specified value 85[°C] (185[°F]) or more.
Remains ON even if normal status is restored.
SM527 Over heat warning
OFF : Normal
ON : Abnormal
• Turn ON when the temperature of Motion CPU module
becomes specified value 85[°C] (185[°F]) or more.
Turn OFF when the temperature of Motion CPU module
returns to normal.
Servo program
setting error
SM516 (SV13/SV22)/
Motion program
setting error (SV43)
SM526
SM528
No.1 CPU MULTR
complete
OFF to ON :
CPU No.1 read completion
• Turn ON when the data read from CPU No.1 is normal by
MULTR instruction.
SM529
No.2 CPU MULTR
complete
OFF to ON :
CPU No.2 read completion
• Turn ON when the data read from CPU No.2 is normal by
MULTR instruction.
SM530
No.3 CPU MULTR
complete
OFF to ON :
CPU No.3 read completion
• Turn ON when the data read from CPU No.3 is normal by
MULTR instruction.
SM531
No.4 CPU MULTR
complete
OFF to ON :
CPU No.4 read completion
• Turn ON when the data read from CPU No.4 is normal by
MULTR instruction.
OFF : Search complete
ON : Searching
• Turns ON when searching axes that have been set to line 1
by system setting.
• Turns OFF when all axes that have been set to line 1 by
system setting have been searched.
OFF : Search complete
ON : Searching
• Turns ON when searching axes that have been set to line 2
by system setting.
• Turns OFF when all axes that have been set to line 2 by
system setting have been searched.
OFF : Multiple CPU
synchronous initial
incomplete.
ON : Multiple CPU
synchronous initial
complete.
• Turns ON when the initial processing of Multiple CPU
synchronous control is completed.
SSCNET searching
SM532 flag (Line 1)
QDS
Ver.!
SSCNET searching
SM533 flag (Line 2)
QDS
Ver.!
Multiple CPU
synchronous control
SM561
initial complete flag
QDS
Ver.!
Set by
(When set)
S (Main processing)
S (Occur an error)
S (Read completion)
S (Change status)
S (Initial processing)
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
APP - 4
Remark
APPENDICES
Table 1.1 Special relay list (Continued)
No.
Name
Meaning
Details
SM801
Clock data read
request
OFF : Ignored
ON : Read request
• When this relay is ON, clock data is read to SD210 to
SD213 as BCD values.
SM805
Rapid stop
deceleration time
setting error invalid
flag Ver.!
OFF : Setting error valid
ON : Setting error invalid
• When this relay is ON, the large value than deceleration time
can be set as rapid stop deceleration time. (The servo
program setting error (error code: 51) will not occur.)
Set by
(When set)
Remark
U
(Note-1): It is used for interlock condition of Multiple CPU high speed bus dedicated instruction when a synchronous system
set in Multiple CPU synchronous startup setting of system setting.
(Note-2): The CPU No.1 is reset after the factor of the stop error is removed to cancel a stop error  Resetting is cancelled.
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
APP - 5
APPENDICES
APPENDIX 1.2 Special registers
Special registers are internal registers whose applications are fixed in the
Motion CPU. For this reason, it is not possible to use these registers in Motion
SFC programs (SV13/SV22)/Motion programs (SV43) in the same way that
normal registers are used.
However, data can be written as needed in order to control the Motion CPU.
Data stored in the special registers are stored as BIN values if no special
designation has been made to the contrary.
The headings in the table that follows have the following meanings.
Item
Explanation
Number
• Indicates the No. of the special register.
Name
• Indicates the name of the special register.
Meaning
• Indicates the nature of the special register.
Details
• Indicates detailed information about the nature of the special register.
• Indicates whether the register is set by the system or user, and, if it is set by system,
when setting is performed.
<Set by>
S: Set by system (Motion CPU)
U: Set by user (Motion SFC program/Motion program or test operation using
MT Developer2)
Set by
(When set)
S/U: Set by both system (Motion CPU) and user
<When set>
Indicated only if setting is done by system (Motion CPU).
Main process: Set during each main processing (free time processing of the CPU)
Initial process: Set only during initial processing (when power supply is turned ON, or
when executed the reset)
Status change : Set only when there is a change in status
Error : Set when error is occurred.
Request : Set only when there is a user request (Special relay, etc.)
Operation cycle : Set during each operation cycle of the Motion CPU.
APP - 6
APPENDICES
Table 1.2 Special register list
No.
SD0
Name
Diagnostic errors
Meaning
Diagnostic error
code
Details
Set by
(When set)
• Error codes for errors found by diagnosis are stored as BIN data.
• Refer to "APPENDIX 3" for details of the error code.
• After confirm the error content, except the stop error, it is possible to clear by
ON to OFF of the Motion error detection flag (M2039).
• Clear SD0 to SD26 by ON to OFF of the Motion error detection flag (M2039)
for except the stop error after confirming the error content.
• The year (last two digits) and month that SD0 data was updated is stored as
BCD 2-digit code.
SD1
SD2
B15
to
B8 B7
to
B0
Year(0 to 99) Month(1 to 12)
Clock time for
diagnostic error
occurrence
Clock time for
diagnostic error
occurrence
Example : January 2006
H0601
• The day and hour that SD0 data was updated is stored as BCD 2-digit code.
B15
to
B8 B7
to
B0
Day(1 to 31)
Hour(0 to 23)
Example : 25th, 10 a.m
H2510
• The minute and second that SD0 data was updated is stored as BCD 2-digit
code.
SD3
B15
to
B8 B7
to
B0
Minute(0 to 59) Second(0 to 59)
Example : 35min., 48 sec.
H3548
• Category codes which help indicate what type of information is being stored in
the error common information areas (SD5 to SD15) and error individual
information areas (SD16 to SD26) are stored. The category code for judging
the error information type is stored.
SD4
Error information Error information
categories
category code
SD5
SD6
SD7
SD8
SD9
SD10
SD11
SD12
SD13
Error common
information
Error common
information
B15
to
B8 B7
to
B0
Individual information Common information
category codes
category codes
• The common information category codes store the following codes.
0: No error
1: Module No./CPU No./Base No.
• The individual information category codes store the following codes.
0: No error
5: Parameter No.
13:Parameter No./CPU No.
• Common information corresponding to the diagnostic error (SD0) is stored.
• The error common information type can be judged by SD4 (common
information category code).
1: Module No./CPU No./Base No.
• For the Multiple CPU system, Module No. or CPU No. is stored
depending on the error that occurred.
(Refer to corresponding error code for which No. has been stored.)
CPU No.1: 1, CPU No.2: 2, CPU No.3: 3, CPU No.4: 4
No.
Meaning
SD14
SD5
Module No./CPU No./Base No.
SD6
I/O No.
SD15
SD7
to
SD15
Empty
APP - 7
S (Occur an error)
Remark
APPENDICES
Table 1.2 Special register list (Continued)
No.
Name
Meaning
SD16
Set by
(When set)
Details
• Individual information corresponding to the diagnostic error (SD0) is stored.
• The error individual information type can be judged by SD4 (individual
information category code).
5: Parameter No.
SD17
SD18
SD19
SD20
No.
Meaning
SD21
SD16
Parameter No.
SD22
SD17
to
SD26
Empty
SD23
SD24
SD25
Error individual
information
Error individual
information
SD26
0401H
0406H
0E00H
0E01H
: Base setting
: Motion slot setting
: Multiple CPU setting (Number of Multiple CPU's)
: Multiple CPU setting (Operation mode/Multiple CPU
synchronous startup)
E008H
: Multiple CPU high speed transmission area setting(CPU
specific send range setting/ (System area))
E009H/E00AH : Multiple CPU high speed transmission area setting
(Automatic refresh setting)
E00BH
: Synchronous setting
S (Occur an error)
13: Parameter No./CPU No.
No.
Meaning
SD16
Parameter No.
SD17
CPU No.(1 to 4)
SD18
to
SD26
Empty
SD53
AC/DC DOWN
counter No.
Number of times
for AC/DC DOWN
• Every time the input voltage fails to or below (85[%] AC power/65[%] DC
power) the rating during calculation of the Motion CPU module, the value is
incremented by 1 and stored in BIN code.
SD60
Fuse blown No.
Module No. with
blown fuse
• The lowest station I/O No. of the module with the blown fuse is stored.
• The CPU switch status is stored in the following format.
B15
SD200 Status of switch
B12 B11
Status of CPU
switch
B8 B7
B4 B3
Not used
1) CPU switch status
B0
1)
0: RUN
1: STOP
• The CPU operating status is stored as indicated in the following figure.
B15
SD203
Operating status Operating status
of CPU
of CPU
B12 B11
B8 B7
B4 B3
2)
1) Operating status of CPU
2) STOP cause
APP - 8
0: RUN
2: STOP
0: RUN/STOP switch
4: Error
B0
1)
S (Main processing)
Remark
APPENDICES
Table 1.2 Special register list (Continued)
No.
Name
Meaning
Set by
(When set)
Details
• The year (last two digits) and month are stored as BCD code.
B15
to
B12 B11
to
B8 B7
to
B4 B3
to
B0
Example : July, 2006
H0607
B0
Example : 31st, 10 a.m.
H3110
Clock data
(Year, Month)
SD210
Year
Month
• The day and hour are stored as BCD code.
B15
to
B12 B11
to
B8 B7
to
B4 B3
to
Clock data
(Day, Hour)
SD211
Day
Hour
• The minutes and seconds are stored as BCD code.
SD212
Clock data
Clock data
(Minute, Second)
B15
to
B12 B11
to
B8 B7
to
B4 B3
to
B0
Example : 35 min., 48 sec.
H3548
S/U (Request)
Second
Minute
• The day of week is stored as BCD code.
B15
Clock data
(Day of week)
SD213
to
B12 B11
to
B8 B7
to
B4 B3
to
B0
Example : Friday
H0005
Day of week
Always set to "0".
0
Sunday
1
Monday
2
Tuesday
3
Wednesday
4
Thursday
5
Friday
6
Saturday
SD290
Number of points
assigned for X
• Stores the number of points currently set for X devices.
SD291
Number of points
assigned for Y
• Stores the number of points currently set for Y devices.
SD292
Number of points
assigned for M
• Stores the number of points currently set for M devices.
SD293
Number of points
assigned for L
• Stores the number of points currently set for L devices.
SD294
Number of points
assigned for B
• Stores the number of points currently set for B devices.
SD295
Number of points
assigned for F
• Stores the number of points currently set for F devices.
SD296
Number of points
assigned for SB
• Stores the number of points currently set for SB devices.
Number of points
assigned for V
• Stores the number of points currently set for V devices.
SD298
Number of points
assigned for S
• Stores the number of points currently set for S devices.
SD299
Number of points
assigned for T
• Stores the number of points currently set for T devices.
SD300
Number of points
assigned for ST
• Stores the number of points currently set for ST devices.
SD301
Number of points
assigned for C
• Stores the number of points currently set for C devices.
SD302
Number of points
assigned for D
• Stores the number of points currently set for D devices.
SD303
Number of points
assigned for W
• Stores the number of points currently set for W devices.
SD304
Number of points
assigned for SW
• Stores the number of points currently set for SW devices.
SD297
Device
assignment
APP - 9
S (Initial processing)
Remark
APPENDICES
Table 1.2 Special register list (Continued)
No.
Name
Meaning
SD395 Multiple CPU No. Multiple CPU No.
Details
• CPU No. of the self CPU is stored.
Set by
(When set)
S (Initial processing)
Real mode axis
SD500
information
SD501
register
• The information (Except real mode axis: 0/Real mode axis: 1) used as a real
mode axis at the time of switching from real mode to virtual mode is stored.
Real mode axis
SD500 : b0 to b15 (Axis 1 to 16)
information register SD501 : b0 to b15 (Axis 17 to 32)
• The real mode axis information does not change at the time of switching from
virtual mode to real mode
S (At virtual mode
transition)
Servo amplifier
SD502
loading
SD503
information
• The loading status (loading: 1/non-loading: 0) of the servo amplifier checked,
and stored as the bit data.
Servo amplifier
SD502 : b0 to b15 (Axis 1 to 16)
loading information
SD503 : b0 to b15 (Axis 17 to 32)
• The mounting status of changed axis after the power supply on is stored.
S (Operation cycle)
SD504 Real mode/virtual Real mode /virtual
SD505 mode switching mode switching
SD506 error information error code
• When a mode switching error occurs in real-to-virtual or virtual-to-real
mode switching, or a mode continuation error occurs in the virtual mode, its
error information is stored.
• Connect/
disconnect of
SSCNET
SSCNET control
SD508
communication
(Status)
• Start/release of
amplifier-less
operation
• SD508 stores the executing state for connect/disconnect of SSCNET
communication and start/release of amplifier-less operation.
Test mode
SD510
request error
SD511
information
SD512
Motion CPU
Error meaning of
WDT error cause WDT error occurs
SD513 Manual pulse
SD514 generator axis
SD515 setting error
SD516
It is operating in
requirement error
occurrence of the
test mode, axis
information
Error program
No.
0 : Command accept waiting
-1 : Execute waiting
-2 : Executing
• The following error codes are stored in SD512.
1: S/W fault 1
2: Operation cycle over
4: WDT error
300: S/W fault 3
303: S/W fault 4
304: RIO WDT error
Manual pulse
generator axis
setting error
information
Error program No.
of servo program
(SV13/SV22)/
motion program
(SV43)
• When the servo program setting error (SV13/SV22)/motion program setting
error (SV43) (SM516) turns on, the erroneous servo program No.
(SV13/SV22)/motion program No. (SV43) will be stored.
Error item
SD517
information
Error code of servo
program
• When the servo program setting error (SV13/SV22)/motion program setting
(SV13/SV22)/
error (SV43) (SM516) turns on, the error code corresponding to the
motion program
erroneous setting item will be stored.
(SV43)
SD520 Scan time
Scan time
(1ms units)
• Main cycle is stored in the unit 1ms.
Setting range (0 to 65535[ms])
Maximum scan
time (1ms units)
• The maximum value of the main cycle is stored in the unit 1ms.
Setting range (0 to 65535[ms])
Maximum scan
time
SD522
Motion operation Motion operation
cycle
cycle
S (Main processing)
• Each axis is stopping: 0/Operating: 1, information is stored as a bit data.
SD510 : b0 to b15 (Axis 1 to Axis 16)
SD511 : b0 to b15 (Axis 17 to Axis 32)
• Contents of the manual pulse generator axis setting error is stored when the
manual pulse generator axis setting error (SM513) turn on.
(Normal: 0/Setting error: 1)
SD513 : The manual pulse generator axis setting error is stored in b0 to b2
(P1 to P3).
The smoothing magnification setting is stored in b3 to b5 (P1 to P3).
SD514 : One pulse input magnification setting error is stored in b0 to b15
(axis 1 to axis 16).
SD515 : One pulse input magnification setting error is stored in b0 to b15
(axis 17 to axis 32).
SD521
S (Occur an error)
• The time required for motion operation cycle is stored in the [µs] unit.
APP - 10
S (Occur an error)
S (Main processing)
S (Operation cycle)
Remark
APPENDICES
Table 1.2 Special register list (Continued)
No.
Name
Operation cycle
SD523 of the Motion
CPU setting
Maximum Motion
SD524 operation cycle
QDS
SD550 System setting
error information
SD551 QDS
Meaning
Set by
(When set)
Details
Operation cycle
of the Motion CPU • The setting operation cycle is stored in the [µs] unit.
setting
S (Initial processing)
Maximum Motion
operation cycle
• The maximum time for motion operation is stored every motion operation
cycle in [µs] unit.
S (Operation cycle)
Error code
• The error code indicating the details of system setting error is stored.
Error individual
information
• The individual information of system setting error is stored.
SD552 Servo parameter
Servo parameter
write/read
read value
request QDS
SD553
• The read value of servo parameter which executed "2: Read request" in
SD804 is stored.
• The read value (low 1 word) of servo parameter which executed "4: 2 word
read request" in SD804 is stored.
Operation method
Multiple CPU
synchronous
SD561
control setting
status QDS Ver.!
Multiple CPU
synchronous
control setting
status
• The CPU setting status of Multiple CPU synchronous control is stored.
0: Independent CPU
1: Master CPU
2: Slave CPU
SD700
Number of points
assigned for #
• Stores the number of points for device # used in the Motion CPU.
SD701
Number of points
assigned for CPU • Stores the number of points currently set for CPU No.1 Multiple CPU area
No.1 Multiple CPU
devices.
area devices
QDS
SD702
Ver.!
Device
assignment
S (Read request)
• The read value (high 1 word) of servo parameter which executed "4: 2 word
read request" in SD804 is stored.
• When the operating system software is SV22, the operation method
information is stored.
0: Virtual mode switching method
1: Advanced synchronous control method
Operation
SD560 method
S (Occur an error)
S (Initial processing)
Number of points
assigned for CPU • Stores the number of points currently set for CPU No.2 Multiple CPU area
No.2 Multiple CPU
devices.
area devices
SD703
Number of points
assigned for CPU • Stores the number of points currently set for CPU No.3 Multiple CPU area
No.3 Multiple CPU
devices.
area devices
SD704
Number of points
assigned for CPU • Stores the number of points currently set for CPU No.4 Multiple CPU area
devices.
No.4 Multiple CPU
area devices
• Current value (SD720, SD721) is incremented by 1 per 444µs.
Read SD720 device in 2 word unit.
Item
SD720 444µs coasting
SD721 timer
444µs coasting
timer
Specification
Data size
2 word (-2147483648 to 2147483647)
Latch
Cleared to zero at power-on or reset, a count
rise is continued from now on.
Usable tasks
Normal, event, NMI
Access
Read only enabled
Timer specifications
444µs timer
S (444µs)
Ver.! : Refer to Section 1.5 for the software version that supports this function.
APP - 11
Remark
APPENDICES
Table 1.2 Special register list (Continued)
No.
Name
Meaning
Set by
(When set)
Details
Remark
• Current value (SD722, SD723) is incremented by 1 per 222µs.
Read SD722 device in 2 word unit.
• This register is not updated when the operation cycle is set to other than
0.2ms.
Item
SD722 222µs coasting
SD723 timer QDS
222µs coasting
timer
• Connect/
disconnect of
SSCNET
SSCNET control
SD803
communication
(Command)
• Start/release of
amplifier-less
operation
Data size
Specification
2 word (-2147483648 to 2147483647)
Cleared to zero at power-on or reset, a count
rise is continued from now on.
Latch
Usable tasks
Normal, event, NMI
Access
Read only enabled
Timer specifications
222µs timer
S (222µs)
• SD803 is required for connect/disconnect of SSCNET communication and
start/release of amplifier-less operation.
0 : No command
1 to 32 : Disconnect command of SSCNET communication
-10 : Connect command of SSCNET communication
U
-20 : Start command 1 of amplifier-less operation (EMI invalid)
-21 : Start command 2 of amplifier-less operation (EMI valid)
-25 : Release command of amplifier-less operation
-2 : Execute command
(Note-1)
Servo parameter
write/read request
flag
• The "write/read request" is executed after setting of the axis No. and servo
parameter No.
1: Write request
2: Read request
(Note-2)
3: 2 word write request
(Note-2)
4: 2 word read request
• "0" is automatically set by Motion CPU after completion of servo parameter
write/read request. ("-1" is stored by Motion CPU at write/read error.)
SD805
Axis No.
• The axis No. to write/read servo parameter is stored.
Q173DSCPU: 1 to 32
Q172DSCPU: 1 to 16
SD804
S/U
• The servo parameter No. to be written/read is stored in hexadecimal.
H
Parameter No.
Parameter group No.
0: PA
5: PF
1: PB
9: Po
2: PC
A: PS
3: PD
B: PL (MR-J4(W)- B only)
4: PE
C: PT (MR-J4(W)- B only)
Fixed at 0
Servo parameter
write/read
request QDS
SD806
Servo parameter
No.
• VC series use
U
H
Parameter No.
Parameter group No.
0: Group 0
5: Group 5
1: Group 1
6: Group 6
2: Group 2
7: Group 7
3: Group 3
8: Group 8
4: Group 4
9: Group 9
SD807
SD808
SD809
Servo parameter
value
• The setting value of servo parameter to be written is stored when "1: Write
request" is set in SD804.
Servo parameter
setting value
(2 word)
• The setting value of servo parameter to be written is stored when "3: 2 word
write request" is set in SD804.
(Note-1): Do not execute the automatic refresh.
(Note-2): This can be set only in VC series.
APP - 12
APPENDICES
APPENDIX 1.3 Replacement of special relays/special registers
When a project of Q17 HCPU(-T)/Q17 CPUN(-T)/Q17 CPU is converted into a
project of Q17 D(S)CPU by "File diversion" in MT Developer2, they are automatically
allocated to "Automatically converted to special relays (SM2000 to SM2255), special
registers (SD2000 to SD2255)". (Refer to table 1.3 and table 1.4.)
"Automatically converted to special relays (SM2000 to SM2255), special registers
(SD2000 to SD2255)" output the same statuses and data as the "Special relay, special
register of Q17 D(S)CPU".
When replacing "automatically converted to special relays (SM2000 to SM2255),
special registers (SD2000 to SD2255)" into "Special relay, special register of
Q17 D(S)CPU", confirm the device usage condition by "List of used device" of
MT Developer2. (Refer to table 1.3 and table 1.4.)
Refer to the help of MT Developer2 for operation procedure of the list of used device.
POINT
When a project of Q17 HCPU(-T)/Q17 CPUN(-T)/Q17 CPU are copied from
other project by program editor in MT Developer2, they are not replaced to
"automatically converted to special relays (SM2000 to SM2255), special registers
(SD2000 to SD2255)".
REMARK
Confirm the device usage condition by "List of used device" of MT Developer2" to
change the device number used in a project of Q17 HCPU(-T)/Q17 CPUN(-T)/
Q17 CPU except the special relays or special registers to the device number of
Q17 D(S)CPU. (Refer to "APPENDIX 4.2 Comparison of devices".)
APP - 13
APPENDICES
Table 1.3 Replacement of special relays
Device No.
Q17 HCPU(-T)/
Automatically
Q17 CPUN(-T)/Q17 CPU
converted to
Special relay
special relays
Special relays
allocated device
M9000
M2320
SM2000
Q17 D(S)CPU
Name
Remark
Special relays
SM60
Fuse blown detection
M9005
M2321
SM2005
SM53
AC/DC DOWN detection
M9006
M2322
SM2006
SM52
Battery low
M9007
M2323
SM2007
SM51
Battery low latch
M9008
M2324
SM2008
SM1
Self-diagnostic error
M9010
M2325
SM2010
SM0
Diagnostic error
M9025
M3136
—
—
M9026
M2328
SM2026
SM211
M9028
M3137
SM2028
SM801
Clock data read request
M9036
M2326
SM2036
SM400
Always ON
M9037
M2327
SM2037
SM401
Always OFF
M9060
M3138
SM2060
—
M9073
M2329
SM2073
SM512
Motion CPU WDT error
M9074
M2330
SM2074
SM500
PCPU READY complete
M9075
M2331
SM2075
SM501
Test mode ON
M9076
M2332
SM2076
SM502
External forced stop input
M9077
M2333
SM2077
SM513
Manual pulse generator axis setting error
M9078
M2334
SM2078
SM510
TEST mode request error
M9079
M2335
SM2079
SM516
Servo program setting error (SV13/SV22)/
Motion program setting error (SV43)
M9216
M2345
SM2216
SM528
No.1 CPU MULTR complete
M9217
M2346
SM2217
SM529
No.2 CPU MULTR complete
M9218
M2347
SM2218
SM530
No.3 CPU MULTR complete
M9219
M2348
SM2219
SM531
No.4 CPU MULTR complete
M9240
M2336
SM2240
SM240
No.1 CPU resetting
M9241
M2337
SM2241
SM241
No.2 CPU resetting
M9242
M2338
SM2242
SM242
No.3 CPU resetting
M9243
M2339
SM2243
SM243
No.4 CPU resetting
M9244
M2340
SM2244
SM244
No.1 CPU error
M9245
M2341
SM2245
SM245
No.2 CPU error
M9246
M2342
SM2246
SM246
No.3 CPU error
M9247
M2343
SM2247
SM247
No.4 CPU error
Clock data set request
It operates by the clock
data of CPU No.1
Clock data error
Diagnostic error reset
Use M2039 for error
reset operation.
POINT
(1) The special relay allocated devices (M2320 to M2399, M3136 to M3199) of
Q17 HCPU(-T)/Q17 CPUN(-T)/Q17 CPU are not allocated to "Automatically
converted to special relays". Confirm the device usage condition by "List of
used device" of MT Developer2 to change them. (Refer to table 1.3.)
(2) "Automatically converted to special relays SM2028 (Clock data set request)" is
shown below.
• Device OFF to ON : "Special relay of Q17 D(S)CPU" ON
• Device ON to OFF : "Special relay of Q17 D(S)CPU" OFF
APP - 14
APPENDICES
Table 1.4 Replacement of special registers
Device No.
Q17 HCPU(-T)/
Automatically
Q17 D(S)CPU
Q17 CPUN(-T)/Q17 CPU
converted to
special registers Special registers
Special registers
D9000
D9005
D9008
SD2000
SD2005
SD2008
SD60
SD53
SD0
D9010
SD2010
SD1
D9011
SD2011
SD2
D9012
SD2012
SD3
D9013
D9014
D9015
D9017
D9019
D9025
D9026
D9027
D9028
SD2013
SD2014
SD2015
SD2017
SD2019
SD2025
SD2026
SD2027
SD2028
SD4
SD5
SD203
SD520
SD521
SD210
SD211
SD212
SD213
D9060
SD2060
—
D9061
SD2061
D9112
SD2112
D9182
D9183
D9184
D9185
D9186
D9187
D9188
D9189
D9190
D9191
D9192
D9193
D9194
D9195
SD2182
SD2183
SD2184
SD2185
SD2186
SD2187
SD2188
SD2189
SD2190
SD2191
SD2192
SD2193
SD2194
SD2195
SD395
SD508
SD803
SD510
SD511
SD512
SD513
SD514
SD515
SD522
SD516
SD517
SD502
SD503
SD504
SD505
SD506
D9196
SD2196
—
D9197
D9200
SD2197
SD2200
SD523
SD200
D9201
SD2201
—
Name
Remark
Fuse blown No.
AC/DC DOWN counter No.
Diagnostic errors
Clock time for diagnostic error occurrence
(Year, month)
Clock time for diagnostic error occurrence
(Day, hour)
Clock time for diagnostic error occurrence
(Minute, second)
Error information categories
Error common information
Operating status of CPU
Scan time
Maximum scan time
Clock data (Year, month)
Clock data (Day, hour)
Clock data (Minute, second)
Clock data (Day of week)
Diagnostic error reset error No.
Use M2039 for error
reset operation.
Multiple CPU No.
SSCNET control (Status)
SSCNET control (Command)
Test mode request error
Motion CPU WDT error cause
Manual pulse generator axis setting error
Motion operation cycle
Error program No.
Error item information
Servo amplifier loading information
Real mode/virtual mode switching error
information
PC link communication error codes
Q173D(S)CPU/
Q172D(S)CPU does not
support PC link
communication.
Operation cycle of the Motion CPU setting
State of switch
State of LED
Use 7-segment LED in
Q173D(S)CPU/
Q172D(S)CPU.
POINT
"Automatically converted to special registers SD2112 (SSCNET control)" are
reflected to the Q17 D(S)CPU special registers by setting the data to devices.
APP - 15
APPENDICES
APPENDIX 2 System Setting Errors
Motion CPUs generate a system configuration error under the following conditions.
Table 2.1 System Setting Errors
System setting error
information QDS
Error
Error
individual
code
information
(SD550)
(SD551)
2
3
Base No.,
Slot No.
Error name
QD
Error
LED
code
(Note-1)
(Note-2)
LAY ERROR
(Note-4)
)
(SL
None (0)
AMP NO SETTING
6
Base No.,
Slot No.
SL
UNIT
(Note-4)
ERROR
Axis No.
Error cause
10014
(Note-3)
• The axis No. setting overlaps in the system settings.
• The axis No. (function select switch) setting of servo
amplifier overlaps in the same SSCNET line.
• When the MR-J4W B is used, the axis setting
equal to the number of used axes set in the servo
amplifier is not set in the system setting.
10016
(Note-5)
—
Always
• The setting which cannot use the driver
communication is carried out with the motion
controller and the servo amplifier corresponding to
the driver communication.
Multiple CPU
system's power
supply ON/
At start of
communication
with servo
amplifier
• The number of actual I/O points set in system
settings exceeds 256.
11
AXIS NO. ERROR
• System setting data is not written.
SYS.SET DATA
ERR
14
Axis No.
AMP TYPE
ERROR
: Axis No.1 to
(
32)
Multiple CPU
system's power
supply ON/
Reset
• The module installed in the slot of the motion CPU
control is abnormal.
I/O POINTS OVER
13
Operation at
error
occurrence
• The servo amplifier is not set even by one axis in
the system settings.
10
None (0)
Check timing
• The slot set in system settings is vacant or a
different module is installed.
Axis No. of
AXIS NO.
servo
MULTIDEF
amplifier
4
8
7-segment
Cannot be
started.
(Motion CPU
system
setting error)
Multiple CPU
system's power
supply ON/
• System setting data is not written.
• System setting data is written without relative check. Reset
Or it is written at the state of error occurrence.
"AL" flashes
3- times
"L01" display
10014
• The servo amplifier that cannot be used for the
operating system software is set in the system
settings.
• The servo amplifier series set in the system setting
and installed servo amplifier series is different.
Servo
amplifier's
power supply
ON
The servo
amplifier for
target axis
does not
operate, the
axis does not
start.
Multiple CPU
system's power
supply ON/
Reset
Cannot be
started.
(Motion CPU
system
setting error)
(Note-3)
15
ROM ERROR1
• Type of the operating system software of data
written to ROM is different.
16
ROM ERROR2
• Data is not written to ROM.
• Data size of ROM is abnormal.
17
None (0)
ROM ERROR3
)
(
• Execute the ROM writing again.
• Check the adjustment for the version of
Motion CPU, MT Developer2 and operating
system software.
• Data of ROM is abnormal.
ROM ERROR4
(
)
18
20
Base No.,
Slot No.
CAN'T USE SL
(Note-4)
)
(
• Execute the ROM writing again.
• Check the adjustment for the version of
Motion CPU, MT Developer2 and operating
system software.
• The motion modules that cannot be used are
installed.
• Use the Motion modules (Q172DLX,
Q173DPX, Q172DEX).
APP - 16
APPENDICES
Table 2.1 System Setting Errors (Continued)
System setting error
information QDS
Error
Error
individual
code
information
(SD550)
(SD551)
Error name
QD
7-segment
Error
LED
code
(Note-1)
(Note-2)
Error cause
Check timing
Operation at
error
occurrence
• The system setting data that set the motion modules
that cannot be used are written.
21
Base No.,
Slot No.
UNIT SET ERR
(Note-4)
)
(
• Use the MT Developer2 of version
corresponding to the Motion modules
(Q172DLX, Q173DPX, Q172DEX).
Multiple CPU
system's power
supply ON/
• The safety function parameters are set to the motion
Reset
CPU that does not support the safety observation
function.
• The safety signal monitor parameter is set to other
than CPU No.2.
SAFERY
SYS.ERR.
22
None (0)
24
Fixed parameter
unregistered error
• The fixed parameter is not written.
25
Parameter block
unregistered error
• The parameter block is not written.
Servo parameter
unregistered error
• The servo parameter of the system setting axis is
not written.
Software security
key error
• The software security keys of the motion controller
OS and the user project do not match.
• The software security key is embedded only in
either of the motion controller OS or the user
project.
26
27
28
Axis No.
None (0)
None (0)
29
30
Multiple
CPU No.
(2 to 4)
"AL" flashes
3- times
—
"L01" display
10014
(Note-3)
• The number of SSCNET /H head module stations
exceeds the number of maximum stations which
can be used at operation cycle.
—
• The user setting area of Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area is setting to less than 512 points
in system of Multiple CPU synchronous control.
—
• The operating cycle is not same setting for master
CPU and slave CPU or is setting to less than
0.88ms in system of Multiple CPU synchronous
control.
31
—
32
—
Multiple CPU
system's power
supply ON/
Reset/
M2000 ON
Cannot be
started.
(Motion CPU
system
setting error)
At the initial
process
• Setting multiple master CPU in system of Multiple
complete of
CPU synchronous control.
Multiple CPU
• Master CPU is not setting in system of Multiple CPU synchronous
control after
synchronous control.
power ON of
• Master CPU cannot be detected in system of
Multiple CPU synchronous control, since each CPU Multiple CPU
system.
startup timing is different.
None (0)
• Slave CPU is not setting in system of Multiple CPU
synchronous control.
33
—
• Slave CPU cannot be detected in system of Multiple
CPU synchronous control, since each CPU startup
timing is different.
(Note-1): ""AL" flashes 3-times
"L01" display" (Repetition) Error code is not displayed.
(Note-2): Error code stored in diagnostic error (SD0)
(Note-3): When the error code 10014 occurs, the system setting error flag (M2041) turns ON and the error name of table 2.1 is displayed on the error list monitor
of MT Developer2.
(Note-4): "
" part is indicated the following contents.
)
(Example) For LAY ERROR (SL
LAY ERROR(SL
)
Slot No.
Base No.
(Note-5): When the error code 10016 occurs, the motion slot fault detection flag (M2047) turns ON and the error name of table 2.1 is displayed on the error list
monitor of MT Developer2.
APP - 17
APPENDICES
MEMO
APP - 18
APPENDICES
APPENDIX 3 Self-diagnosis Error
Multiple CPU related errors are stored in the CPU shared memory "self CPU operation
information area (1H to 1CH)" of each module and self diagnostic error information
(SD0 to SD26) of the special register (SD) as the self diagnostic errors.
Error codes (1000 to 9999) of Multiple CPU related errors are common to each CPU
module.
The error code (10000 to 10999) is stored as required at Motion CPU-specific error
occurrence.
Confirm the error codes and contents by "Motion error history" on Motion CPU error
batch monitor of MT Developer2 and remove the error cause if an error occurs.
Confirm operation status and error occurrence of each CPU used in the Multiple CPU
system by PLC diagnosis of GX Works2/GX Developer.
<Screen: GX Works2>
APP - 19
APPENDICES
(1) Multiple CPU related errors which occurs in Motion CPU
Each digit of error code has been described as follows.
Digit
:
Tens digit
: Details code
Hundreds digit :
Thousands digit : Major division (Cause)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Major division
Internal hardware
Handling
Parameter
Program
Watch timer
Redundant system
Multiple CPU
Outside diagnosis
Table 3.1 Multiple CPU related errors which occurs in Motion CPU (1000 to 9999)
Item
Error code
(SD0)
Common information
(SD5 to SD15)
Individual Information
(SD16 to SD26)
MAIN CPU DOWN
—
RAM ERROR
—
Error message
CPU operation
status
Diagnostic
timing
—
Stop
Always
—
Stop
At power ON/
At reset
Stop
Always
7-segment LED display
1000
1001
1002
1003
1004
1005
CPU hard
error
1006
1007
1008
1009
1105
1150
1300
"AL" flashes 3 times
FUSE BREAK OFF
Module No.
—
Steady "A1" display
4 digits error code is
displayed in two flashes
of 2 digits each.
At power ON/
At reset
1401
Module hard
error
SP. UNIT DOWN
Module No.
—
Stop
1403
Base
Always
1413
—
1414
Module No.
1415
1416
CONTROL-BUS. ERR.
Always
Base No. (Note-2)
—
Stop
At power ON/
At reset
CPU No. (Note-1)
(Note-1): CPU No. is stored in slot No. of common information classification.
(Note-2): Base No. stored in "common information classification code" of "error information classification code"
bases.
APP - 20
"0 : Main base, 1 to 7 : Number of extension
APPENDICES
Error code
(SD0)
Error contents and cause
Corrective action
1000
1001
1002
1003
1004
1005
1006
Runaway or failure of CPU module.
(1) Malfunctioning due to noise or other reason
(2) Hardware fault
(1) Take noise reduction measures.
(2) Reset the CPU module and RUN it again. If the same error is
displayed again, this suggests a CPU module hardware fault.
Explain the error symptom and get advice from our sales
representative.
1007
1008
1009
1105
The CPU shared memory in the CPU module is faulty.
1150
The memory of the CPU module in the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission area is faulty.
1300
There is an output module with a blown fuse.
Check FUSE. LED of the output modules and replace the module whose
LED is lit.
1401
(1) There was no response from the Motion module/intelligent
function module in the initial processing.
(2) The size of the buffer memory of the Motion module/intelligent
function module is invalid.
(3) The unsupported module is mounted.
(1) Set the Motion module/intelligent function module used in the Motion
CPU in the system setting.
(2) When the unsupported module is mounted, remove it.
When the corresponding module is supported, this suggests the Motion
module, intelligent function module, CPU module and/or base unit is
expecting a hardware fault.
Explain the error symptom and get advice from our sales
representative.
1403
(1) An error is detected at the intelligent function module.
(2) The I/O module (including intelligent function module) is nearly
removed or completely removed/mounted during running.
The CPU module, base unit and/or the intelligent function module that
was accessed is experiencing a hardware fault.
Explain the error symptom and get advice from our sales representative.
1413
1414
An error is detected on the system bus.
1415
Fault of the main or extension base unit was detected.
1416
System bus fault was detected at power-on or reset.
Reset the CPU module and RUN it again. If the same error is displayed
again, the intelligent function module, CPU module or base unit is faulty.
Explain the error symptom and get advice from our sales representative.
APP - 21
APPENDICES
Table 3.1 Multiple CPU related errors which occurs in Motion CPU (1000 to 9999)
(Continued)
Item
Error code
(SD0)
Error message
1430
Common information
(SD5 to SD15)
Individual Information
(SD16 to SD26)
7-segment LED display
CPU operation
status
Diagnostic
timing
—
1431
At power ON/
At reset
"AL" flashes 3 times
Steady "A1" display
Multiple CPU
high speed
bus
MULTI-C.BUS ERR.
—
CPU No.
1432
Stop
4 digits error code is
displayed in two flashes
of 2 digits each.
1433
1434
Always
1435
Power supply
1500
AC/DC DOWN
Battery
1600
BATTERY ERROR
—
—
Drive name
—
None
Continue
Always
Continue
Always
Stop
At power ON/
At reset
Steady "BT1"
Steady "BT2"
2100
Module No.
2107
Handling the
intelligent
function
module/
Multiple CPU
module
2124
—
"AL" flashes 3 times
SP. UNIT LAY ERR.
Steady "A1" display
—
2125
Module No.
2140
2150
4 digits error code is
displayed in two flashes
of 2 digits each.
SP. UNIT VER. ERR.
APP - 22
APPENDICES
Error code
(SD0)
Error contents and cause
Corrective action
1430
Reset the CPU module and RUN it again. If the same error is displayed
The error of self CPU is detected in the Multiple CPU high speed bus. again, this suggests a CPU module hardware fault.
Explain the error symptom and get advice from our sales representative.
1431
The communication error with other CPU is detected in the Multiple
CPU high speed bus.
(1) Take noise reduction measures.
(2) Check the main base unit mounting status of the CPU module.
(3) Reset the CPU module and RUN it again. If the same error is
displayed again, this suggests a CPU module or base unit hardware
fault.
Explain the error symptom and get advice from our sales
representative.
1432
The communication time out with other CPU is detected in the
Multiple CPU high speed bus.
Reset the CPU module and RUN it again. If the same error is displayed
again, this suggests a CPU module hardware fault.
Explain the error symptom and get advice from our sales representative.
The communication error with other CPU is detected in the Multiple
CPU high speed bus.
(1) Take noise reduction measures.
(2) Check the main base unit mounting status of the CPU module.
(3) Reset the CPU module and RUN it again. If the same error is displayed
again, this suggests a CPU module or base unit hardware fault.
Explain the error symptom and get advice from our sales
representative.
1500
A momentary power supply interruption has occurred.
The power supply went off.
Check the power supply.
1600
(1) The battery voltage in the CPU module has dropped below
(1) Change the battery.
stipulated level.
(2) The battery holder unit that install the battery is not mounted to the (2) Mount the battery holder unit that installs the battery.
CPU module.
2100
In the I/O assignment setting of PLC CPU, the intelligent function
module was allocated to an I/O module or vice versa.
2107
The first I/O No. set in the system settings is overlapped with the one Make the I/O No. setting again so it is consistent with the actual status of
for another module.
the modules.
2124
(1) A module is mounted on the 65th or higher slot.
(2) The extension base unit set to "None" is mounted.
(1) Remove the module mounted on the 65th or later slot.
(2) Remove the extension base unit set to "None".
2125
(1) A module which the CPU cannot recognize has been mounted.
(2) There was no response form the intelligent function module.
(1) Install an usable module.
(2) The intelligent function module is experiencing a hardware fault.
Explain the error symptom and get advice from our sales
representative.
2140
The motion modules (Q172DLX, Q172DEX, Q173DPX, Q172LX,
Q172EX (-S1/-S2/-S3), Q173PX (-S1)) are installed in CPU slot or
I/O 0 to 2 slot.
Remove the Motion modules installed CPU slot or I/O 0 to 2 slot.
2150
(1) Change to the intelligent function module (function version B or later)
In a Multiple CPU system, the control CPU of intelligent function
compatible with the Multiple CPU system.
module incompatible with the Multiple CPU system is set to other than
(2) Change the control CPU of intelligent function module incompatible with
CPU No.1.
the Multiple CPU system to CPU No.1.
1433
1434
1435
Make the PLC parameter's I/O assignment setting again so it is consistent
with the actual status of the intelligent function module and the CPU
module.
APP - 23
APPENDICES
Table 3.1 Multiple CPU related errors which occurs in Motion CPU (1000 to 9999)
(Continued)
Item
Error code
(SD0)
Error message
Common information
(SD5 to SD15)
Individual Information
(SD16 to SD26)
7-segment LED display
CPU operation
status
3001
At power ON/
At reset/
STOP
RUN
3012
Parameter
Diagnostic
timing
Parameter No.
PARAMETER ERROR
Stop
—
3013
At power ON/
At reset
Parameter No./
CPU No.
3015
(Note-1) (Note-3)
MULTI CPU DOWN
Stop
(Note-1)
MULTI EXE. ERROR
—
—
Stop
At power
supply ON/
at reset
—
Continue
Always
—
Stop
At power
supply ON/
at reset
CPU No.
MULTI CPU ERROR
CPU No.
(Note-1)
7030
CPU LAY. ERROR
CPU No.
7031
7035
At power
supply ON/
at reset
CPU No.
7013
7020
Steady "A1" display
4 digits error code is
displayed in two flashes
of 2 digits each.
(Note-1)
7010
7011
—
CPU No.
7002
Multiple CPU
Always
"AL" flashes 3 times
CPU No.
7000
Module No.
(Note-1): CPU No. is stored in slot No. of common information classification.
(Note-3): Because a stop error or CPU No. except CPU No. that it was reset becomes MULTI CPU DOWN simultaneously, a stop error or CPU No. except CPU
No. that it was reset may store in the classification of common error information depending on timing.
APP - 24
APPENDICES
Error code
(SD0)
Error contents and cause
Corrective action
3001
The parameter settings are corrupted.
(1) Check the parameter item corresponding the numerical value
(parameter No.), and correct it.
(2) Rewrite corrected parameters to the CPU module, reload or reset the
Multiple CPU system power supply.
(3) If the same error occurs, it is thought to be a hardware error.
Explain the error symptom and get advice from our sales
representative.
3012
Multiple CPU setting of Multiple CPU setting parameter or control
CPU setting of system setting differs from that of the reference CPU
settings.
Match the Multiple CPU setting of Multiple CPU setting parameter or control
CPU setting of system setting with that of the reference CPU (CPU No.1)
settings.
3013
Multiple CPU automatic refresh setting is any of the following.
(1) When a bit device is specified as a refresh device, a number other
than a multiple of 16 is specified for the refresh start device.
(2) The device specified is other than the one that may be specified.
(3) The number of send points is an odd number.
(4) The total number of send points is greater than the maximum
number of refresh points.
Check the following in the Multiple CPU automatic refresh setting and make
correction.
(1) When specifying the bit device, specify a multiple of 16 for the refresh
start device.
(2) Specify the device that may be specified for the refresh device.
(3) Set the number of send points to an even number.
(4) Set the total number of send points is within the range of the maximum
number of refresh points.
3015
(1) "Use multiple CPU high speed transmission " is not set in the
Multiple CPU setting of Universal module QCPU.
(2) In a Multiple CPU system, the CPU verified is different from the
one set in the parameter setting.
(1) Set "Use multiple CPU high speed transmission " in the Universal
module QCPU.
(2) Check the parameter item corresponding to the numerical value
(parameter No./CPU No.) and parameter of target CPU, and correct
them.
7000
In the operating mode of a Multiple CPU system, a CPU error
occurred at the CPU where "All station stop by stop error of CPU"
was selected.
Check the error of the CPU resulting in CPU module fault, and remove the
In a Multiple CPU system, CPU No.1 resulted in stop error at power- errors.
on and the other CPU cannot start. (This error occurred at CPU No.2
to 4)
7002
There is no response from the target CPU module in a Multiple CPU
system during initial communication.
Reset the CPU module and RUN it again. If the same error is displayed
again, this suggests the hardware fault of any of the CPU modules.
Explain the error symptom and get advice from our sales representative.
7010
In a Multiple CPU system, a faulty CPU module was mounted.
Replace the faulty CPU module.
Either of the following settings was made in a Multiple CPU system.
(1) Multiple CPU automatic refresh setting was made for the
inapplicable CPU module.
(2) "I/O sharing when using multiple CPUs" setting was made for the
inapplicable CPU module.
(1) Correct the Multiple CPU automatic refresh setting.
(2) Correct the "I/O sharing when using multiple CPUs" setting.
The system configuration for using the Multiple CPU high speed
transmission function is not met.
(1) The QnUD CPU is not used for the CPU No.1.
(2) The Multiple CPU high speed main base unit (Q3 DB) is not
used.
Change to the system configuration to meet the conditions for using the
Multiple CPU high speed transmission function.
7013
(1) CPU module which cannot be mounted in QnUD CPU is
mounted. (The module may break down.)
(2) Q173HCPU, Q172HCPU, Q173CPUN, Q172CPUN is mounted.
Remove Q173HCPU, Q172HCPU, Q173CPUN, Q172CPUN.
7020
In the operating mode of a Multiple CPU system, an error occurred in
Check the error of the CPU resulting in CPU module fault, and remove the
the CPU where "system stop" was not selected. (The CPU module
error.
where no error occurred was used to detect an error.)
7011
7030
7031
7035
An assignment error occurred in the CPU-mountable slot (CPU slot, (1) Set the same value to the number of CPU modules specified in the
I/O slot 0 to 2) in excess of the number of CPU slot (with in the range
Multiple CPU setting of the PLC parameter and the number of mounted
of CPU number setting parameter).
CPU modules (including CPU (empty)).
An assignment error occurred in the CPU slot (within the range of the (2) Make the same as the state of the installation of CPU module set in the
system setting.
CPU number setting parameter).
The CPU module has been mounted on the inapplicable slot.
Mount the CPU module on the applicable slot.
APP - 25
APPENDICES
(2) Motion CPU-specific errors
Each digit of error code has been described as follows.
Refer to programming manuals for error details.
1
0
Digit
Tens digit
Hundreds digit
Thousands digit
:
: Details code
:
: Positioning CPU division
(0 : Motion CPU)
Ten thousands digit : Except PLC CPU
002
003
004
005
006
007
008
009
010
011
014
015
016
020
021
022
023
030
040
041
042
050
051
Details code
Minor/major error (Command generation axis)(SV22)
Minor/major error
Minor/major error (Virtual servo motor axis)(SV22)
Minor/major error (Synchronous encoder axis)(SV22)
Servo error (MR-J3- B, MR-J3- B compatibility mode)
Servo program setting error (SV13/SV22)/
Motion program setting error (SV43)
Mode switching error (SV22)
Manual pulse generator axis setting error
TEST mode request error
WDT error
System setting error
Servo error (MR-J4- B)
Motion slot fault
Motion SFC control error (F/FS)
Motion SFC control error (G)
Motion SFC control error (K or others (Not F/FS, G))
Motion SFC control error (Motion SFC chart)
Motion CPU internal bus error
Inverter error
VC error
SSCNET /H head module error
Safety observation error (Alarm)
Safety observation error (Warning)
Table 3.2 Motion CPU-specific errors (10000 to 10999)
Error code
(SD0)
Error messages
Common information
(SD5 to SD15)
Individual information
(SD16 to SD26)
7-segment LED display
CPU operation status
10002
10003
None
10004
10005
"AL" flashes 3 times
10006
Steady "S01" display
Continue
10007
MC.UNIT ERROR
—
—
10008
None
10009
10010
10011
Steady ". . . " display
"AL" flashes 3 times
10014
Steady "L01" display
APP - 26
Stop
APPENDICES
Error code
(SD0)
Error contents and cause
Corrective action
10002
Minor/major errors had occurred in command generation axis.
(SV22)
10003
Minor/major errors had occurred.
Check the Motion error history of MT Developer2 and the minor/major error
codes of minor/major error code of minor/major error code storage device,
and remove the error cause.
Refer to the error codes for error details.
10004
Minor/major errors had occurred in virtual servomotor axis. (SV22)
10005
Minor/major errors had occurred in synchronous encoder axis.
(SV22)
10006
The servo errors had occurred in the servo amplifier (MR-J3- B,
MR-J3- B compatibility mode) connected to the Motion CPU.
Check the Motion error history of MT Developer2 and the servo error codes
of servo error code storage device, and remove the error cause of servo
amplifier.
Refer to the servo error code for details.
10007
Servo program setting (SV13/SV22)/Motion program setting error
(SV43) error occurred.
Check the Motion error history of MT Developer2 and the servo program
setting error (SV13/SV22)/Motion program setting error (SV43) storage
device (error program No., error item information), and remove the error
cause.
Refer to the error codes for details.
10008
Real mode/virtual mode switching error occurred. (SV22)
Check the Motion error history of MT Developer2 and the real mode/virtual
mode switching error storage device, and remove the error cause.
Refer to the real mode/virtual mode switching error codes for details.
10009
Manual pulse generator axis setting error occurred.
Check the Motion error history of MT Developer2 and the manual pulse
generator axis setting error storage device, and remove the error cause.
Refer to the manual pulse generator axis setting error codes for details.
10010
Test mode request error occurred.
Check the Motion error history of MT Developer2 and the test mode request
error storage device, and remove the error cause.
10011
WDT error occurred at Motion CPU.
Check the Motion error history of MT Developer2 and the Motion CPU WDT
error factors, and remove the error cause.
10014
System setting error occurred at Motion CPU.
Check the error message on error monitor screen of MT Developer2, and
remove the error cause. And then, turn on the power supply again or reset
the Multiple CPU system.
APP - 27
APPENDICES
Table 3.2 Motion CPU-specific errors (10000 to 10999) (Continued)
Error code
(SD0)
Error messages
Common information
(SD5 to SD15)
Individual information
(SD16 to SD26)
10015
7-segment LED display
CPU operation status
None
Continue
"AL" flashes 3 times
10016
Stop
Steady "L01" display
10020
10021
Continue
10022
None
10023
10030
10040
Stop
MC.UNIT ERROR
—
—
"AL" flashes 3 times
10041
Steady "S01" display
Continue
10042
10050
None
10051
APP - 28
APPENDICES
Error code
(SD0)
Error contents and cause
Corrective action
10015
The servo errors had occurred in the servo amplifier (MR-J4- B)
connected to the Motion CPU.
Check the Motion error history of MT Developer2 and the servo error codes
of servo error code storage device, and remove the error cause of servo
amplifier.
Refer to the servo error code for details.
10016
Motion slot fault occurred at Motion CPU.
Check the error message on error monitor screen of MT Developer2, and
remove the error cause. And then, turn on the power supply again or reset
the Multiple CPU system.
Motion SFC error occurred at Motion SFC program.
Check the Motion error history of MT Developer2, and remove the error
cause.
Refer to the Motion SFC error code for details.
10030
Motion CPU internal bus error occurred.
Motion CPU module hardware fault.
Explain the error symptom and get advice from our sales representative.
10040
Inverter error occurred in the inverter connected with Motion CPU.
Check the Motion error history of MT Developer2 and the error code of the
servo error code storage device. After that, remove the inverter error cause.
For the detailed contents of the errors, check the servo error code.
10041
An error occurred in VC (Nikki Denso) with the Motion CPU
connected.
Check the Motion error history of MT Developer2 and the error code of the
servo error code storage device. After that, remove the error cause of
VC (Nikki Denso).
For the detailed contents of the errors, check the servo error code.
10042
The errors had occurred in the SSCNET /H head module
connected to the Motion CPU.
Check the Motion error history of MT Developer2 or the error codes of the
SSCNET /H head module error storage device, then release the error
cause of the SSCNET /H head module.
For the details of the error definition, check the SSCNET /H head module
error code.
10050
Safety observation error (alarm) occurred.
10051
Safety observation error (warning) occurred.
10020
10021
10022
10023
Check the Motion error history of MT Developer2 or the Safety observation
error code storage device, then release the error cause.
For the details of the error definition, check the Safety observation error
code.
APP - 29
APPENDICES
(3) Self-diagnostic error information
No.
SD0
Name
Meaning
Diagnostic error
Diagnostic errors
code
Details
• Error codes for errors found by diagnosis are stored as BIN data.
• The year (last two digits) and month that SD0 data was updated is stored as BCD 2-digit code.
B15
to
B8 B7
to
B0
Year(0 to 99) Month(1 to 12)
SD1
SD2
Clock time for
diagnostic error
occurrence
Clock time for
diagnostic error
occurrence
Example : January 2006
H0601
• The day and hour that SD0 data was updated is stored as BCD 2-digit code.
B15
to
B8 B7
to
B0
Day(1 to 31)
Hour(0 to 23)
Example : 25st, 10 a.m
H2510
• The minute and second that SD0 data was updated is stored as BCD 2-digit code.
B15
to
B8 B7
to
B0
Minute(0 to 59) Second(0 to 59)
SD3
Example : 35min., 48 sec.
H3548
• Category codes which help indicate what type of information is being stored in the error common information
areas (SD5 to SD15) and error individual information areas (SD16 to SD26) are stored. The category code for
judging the error information type is stored.
B0
B15
to
B8 B7
to
Individual information Common information
category codes
category codes
SD4
Error information Error information
categories
category code
• The common information category codes store the following codes.
0: No error
1: Module No./CPU No./Base No.
• The individual information category codes store the following codes.
0: No error
5: Parameter No.
13:Parameter No./CPU No.
• Common information corresponding to the diagnostic error (SD0) is stored.
• The error common information type can be judged by SD4(common information category code).
1: Module No./CPU No./Base No.
SD5
Error common
to
information
SD15
Error common
information
No.
Meaning
SD5
Module No./CPU No./Base No.
SD6
SD7
to
SD15
I/O No.
Empty
• Individual information corresponding to the diagnostic error (SD0) is stored.
• The error individual information type can be judged by SD4(individual information category code).
5: Parameter No.
SD16
Error individual
to
information
SD26
Error individual
information
No.
Meaning
SD16
Parameter No.
SD17
to
SD26
Empty
0401H
0406H
0E00H
0E01H
E008H
: Base setting
: Motion slot setting
: Multiple CPU setting (Number of Multiple CPU's)
: Multiple CPU setting (Operation mode/ Multiple CPU synchronous startup)
: Multiple CPU high speed transmission area setting
(CPU specific send range setting / (System area))
E009H/E00AH : Multiple CPU high speed transmission area setting(Automatic refresh setting)
E00BH
: Synchronous setting
13: Parameter No./CPU No.
No.
Meaning
SD16
Parameter No.
SD17
CPU No.(1 to 4)
SD18
to
SD26
Empty
APP - 30
APPENDICES
(4) Release of Multiple CPU related error
The release operation of errors that continues operation for CPU can be
executed.
Release the errors in the following procedure.
1) Remove the error cause.
2) Turn off the Motion error detection flag (M2039).
The special relays, special registers and 7-segment LED for the errors are
returned to the status before error occurs after release of errors.
If the same error is displayed again after release of errors, an error is set again,
and the Motion error detection flag (M2039) turns on.
(5) Error setting on servo warning
QDS
Setting whether to output error on servo warning to the motion error history or
self-diagnosis error of MT Developer2 is possible.
Set this parameter in the system basic setting of system setting.
(Refer to Section 3.1.3.)
APP - 31
APPENDICES
APPENDIX 4 Differences Between Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU/Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)/Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU
APPENDIX 4.1 Differences between Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU/Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)/Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU
Common differences to the operating system software are shown in Table 4.1.
Refer to "APPENDIX 4.3 Differences of the operating system software " for
characteristic differences to the operating system software. And, refer to "APPENDIX
4.2 Comparison of devices " for detailed differences of devices.
Table 4.1 Differences between Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU/Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)/Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU
Item
Peripheral I/F
Battery
Forced stop input
Multiple CPU high speed
transmission memory for
data transfer between CPU
modules
Number of real I/O points
(PX/PY)
Internal relays (M)
Latch relays (L)
Device
Special relays (M)
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU
USB/RS-232/Ethernet
(Via PLC CPU)
PERIPHERAL I/F
(Motion CPU)
USB/RS-232/Ethernet
(Via PLC CPU)
PERIPHERAL I/F
(Note-1)
(Motion CPU)
USB/SSCNET
Add Q6BAT at continuous power
failure for 1 month or more.
Demand
• Use EMI terminal of Motion CPU module.
• Use device set by forced stop input setting in the system setting.
Included
256 points
(Built-in interface in Motion CPU
(Input 4 points) + I/O module +
Intelligent function module)
—
256 points
(I/O module)
12288 points
None (Latch for M is possible by latch setting)
—
Use device set by forced stop
input setting in the system setting.
256 points
(I/O module)
Total 8192 points
256 points
Special relays (SM)
2256 points
—
Special registers (D)
—
256 points
Special registers (SD)
2256 points
—
Motion registers (#)
12288 points
8192 points
Multiple CPU area
devices (U \G)
Up to 14336 points
—
(Note-1): Q173DCPU-S1/Q172DCPU-S1 only
APP - 32
APPENDICES
Table 4.1 Differences between Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU/Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)/Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU (Continued)
Item
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
SV13/
SV22
Motion dedicated
PLC instructions
Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU
D(P).DDRD, D(P).DDWR,
D(P).SFCS, D(P).SVST,
D(P).CHGT, D(P).CHGV,
D(P).CHGA, D(P).GINT
S(P).DDRD, S(P).DDWR,
S(P).SFCS, S(P).SVST,
S(P).CHGT, S(P).CHGV,
S(P).CHGA, S(P).GINT
D(P).DDRD, D(P).DDWR,
D(P).SFCS, D(P).SVST,
D(P).CHGT, D(P).CHGV,
D(P).CHGA
S(P).DDRD, S(P).DDWR,
S(P).SFCS, S(P).SVST,
S(P).CHGT, S(P).CHGV,
S(P).CHGA
D(P).GINT
SV43
Interlock condition
Motion modules
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
D(P).DDRD, D(P).DDWR,
D(P).SFCS, D(P).SVST,
D(P).CHGT, D(P).CHGT2,
(Note-2)
D(P).CHGV, D(P).CHGVS
,
(Note-2)
D(P).CHGA, D(P).CHGAS
,
—
Interlock condition by the to self
Multiple instructions are executable continuously without interlock
condition by the self CPU high speed interrupt accept flag from CPU . CPU high speed interrupt accept
flag from CPU is necessary.
:CPU No.
SV13
Q172DLX, Q173DPX, Q173DSXY
Q172DLX, Q173DPX,
(Note-1)
Q173DSXY
Q172LX, Q173PX
SV22
Q172DLX, Q172DEX, Q173DPX,
Q173DSXY
Q172DLX, Q172DEX, Q173DPX,
(Note-1)
Q173DSXY
Q172LX, Q172EX, Q173PX
SV43
—
Q172DLX, Q173DPX
System setting
• QnUD(E)(H)CPU/QnUDVCPU is set as CPU No.1.
• Only Multiple CPU high speed main base unit
(Q35DB/Q38DB/Q312DB) can be used as main base unit.
• Q172DLX, Q172DEX and Q173DPX cannot be installed to I/O 0 to 2
slot.
Q172LX, Q173PX
• QnUD(H)CPU is set to CPU
No.1.
• Q3 B can be used as a main
base unit.
• Q172LX, Q172EX and Q173PX
can be mounted to I/O 0 to 2 slot.
Latch clear
Remote operation
L.CLR switch
RUN/STOP
Remote operation, RUN/STOP switch
RUN/STOP switch
ROM operation
SV13/
Model of operating
SV22
system software
SV43
CPU module No.1
Installation orders CPU No.2
or later
Combination of Motion CPU
modules
SW8DNC-SV Q
—
SW6RN-SV Q
SW7DNC-SV Q
QnUD(E)(H)CPU/QnUDVCPU
SW5RN-SV Q
Qn(H)CPU
Install Motion CPU module on the
right-hand side of PLC CPU
module.
No restriction
Combination with
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172D(-S1)CPU
Rom writing is executed with
installation mode/ mode written in
ROM.
Combination with
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
Combination with
Q173CPUN(-T)/Q172CPUN(-T).
Settable between CPU modules
Not settable between CPU
modules
Multiple CPU
high speed
transmission
area
Provided
None
Access by
Multiple CPU
shared memory
Possible
Impossible
CPU empty slot
CPU
shared
memory
• ROM writing is executed with mode operated by RAM/ mode
operated by ROM.
• ROM writing can be executed for the data of MT Developer2.
(Note-1): Q173DCPU-S1/Q172DCPU-S1 only
(Note-2): SV22 advanced synchronous control only
APP - 33
APPENDICES
Table 4.1 Differences between Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU/Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)/Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU (Continued)
Item
Memory
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU
Automatic refresh area in CPU
shared memory
Multiple CPU high speed transmission area in CPU shared memory
Automatic
Automatic
refresh setting
refresh
Multiple CPU
high speed
refresh function
LED display
Latch
range
setting
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
32 range possible
4 range possible
Provided
None
7-segment LED display
Each LED of MODE, RUN, ERR,
M.RUN, BAT and BOOT
Latch (1)
It is possible to clear with latch clear(1) and latch clear (1)(2) of remote Range which can be cleared with
latch clear.
the latch clear key.
Latch (2)
It is possible to clear with lath clear(1)(2) of remote latch clear.
All clear function
Execute with installation mode
Turn off the PLC ready flag
(M2000) and test mode ON flag
(M9075) to execute all clear.
Turn off M2039.
Store the error code to be
released in the special register
D9060 and turn off to on the
special relay M9060.
Release of Multiple CPU
related error
Self-diagnosis error
Motion error detection flag
(M2039)
Software stroke limit
Range which cannot be cleared
with the latch clear key.
When the Motion CPU-specific errors occur, "10000 to 10999" is set in
diagnostic errors (SD0) depending on the type of error.
At this time, the self-diagnostic error flag (SM1) and diagnostic error
flag (SM0) also turn ON.
When the Motion CPU-specific
errors occur, 10000 is set in
diagnostic errors (D9008).
At this time, the self-diagnostic
error flag (M9008) and diagnostic
error flag (M9010) do not turn ON.
M2039 turns ON even if any errors occur in the Motion CPU module.
When the Motion CPU-specific
errors occur, M2039 turn ON.
M2039 dose not turn ON at the
Multiple CPU related errors (Error
code of D9008: less then 10000)
occurrence. (SV13/SV22)
(Note): Unusable for SV43 use.
Invalid setting (All units) possible
Invalid setting (degree axis only) possible
Invalid setting possible
Anytime valid
Error setting on servo
warning
Selectable whether or not output
error
Anytime output error
Servo external signal
Q172DLX signal, Amplifier input,
DI signal, Bit device
Q172DLX signal, Amplifier input
Optional data monitor
function
Up to 6 data
(Up to 3 data in SSCNET )
Up to 3 data
32 characters
None
Up to 32
None
Battery error check of Motion
CPU
Axis label
Mark detection function
Speed-torque control function
Torque limit value
Acceleration/deceleration
time change function
Provided
None
Individual change/monitoring of
positive/negative direction torque
limit value
Batch change/monitoring of positive/negative direction torque limit value
Provided
None
APP - 34
APPENDICES
Table 4.1 Differences between Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU/Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)/Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU (Continued)
Item
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU
Home position return function
Proximity dog type (2 types),
Count type (3 types),
Data set type (2 types),
Dog cradle type,
Stopper type (2 types),
Limit switch combined type,
Scale home position signal
detection type,
Dogless home position signal
reference type
Proximity dog type (2 types),
Count type (3 types),
Data set type (2 types),
Dog cradle type,
Stopper type (2 types),
Limit switch combined type,
Scale home position signal
detection type
Proximity dog type (2 types),
Count type (3 types),
Data set type (2 types),
Dog cradle type,
Stopper type (2 types),
Limit switch combined type
PI-PID switching command
Provided
None
Servo parameter
read/change function
Provided
None
Protection by software security
key or password
Protection by password
Word 16CH, Bit 16CH
Real-time display possible
Word 4CH, Bit 8CH
Real-time display possible
Security function
Digital oscilloscope function
Communication speed
SSCNET
Standard
cable
Transmission
Long
distance
distance
cable
Up to 20m (65.62ft.) between stations
Maximum overall distance 320m(1049.87ft.) (20m (65.62ft.) ×16 axes)
Up to 50m (164.04ft.) between stations
Maximum overall distance 800m (2624.67ft.) (50m (164.04ft.) ×16 axes)
MR-J3- B, MR-J3W- B, MR-J3- B-RJ004, MR-J3- B-RJ006,
MR-J3- B-RJ080W, MR-J3- B Safety, FR-A700, VC (Nikki Denso)
Servo amplifier
Communication speed
SSCNET /H
50Mbps
150Mbps
Standard
cable
Up to 20m (65.62ft.) between
stations
Maximum overall distance
320m(1049.87ft.)
(20m (65.62ft.) ×16 axes)
Long
distance
cable
Up to 100m (328.08ft.) between
stations
Maximum overall distance
1600m (5249.34ft.)
(100m (328.08ft.) ×16 axes)
Transmission
distance
Servo amplifier
Driver communication
function
MR-J3- B, MR-J3W- B,
MR-J3- B-RJ004,
MR-J3- B-RJ006,
MR-J3- B Safety
Unusable
MR-J4- B, MR-J4- B-RJ,
MR-J4W- B, VC (Nikki Denso)
Provided
None
SSCNET /H head module
connection
Can connect
Cannot connect
Multiple CPU synchronous
control
Provided
None
APP - 35
APPENDICES
APPENDIX 4.2 Comparison of devices
(1) Motion registers
(a) Monitor devices
Table 4.2 Motion registers (Monitor devices) list
Device No.
Q173DSCPU/
Q172DSCPU
Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)
Name
Q173HCPU/
Q172HCPU
#8000 to #8019
#8064 to #8067
Axis 1 monitor device
#8020 to #8039
#8068 to #8071
Axis 2 monitor device
#8040 to #8059
#8072 to #8075
Axis 3 monitor device
#8060 to #8079
#8076 to #8079
Axis 4 monitor device
#8080 to #8099
#8080 to #8083
Axis 5 monitor device
#8100 to #8119
#8084 to #8087
Axis 6 monitor device
#8120 to #8139
#8088 to #8091
Axis 7 monitor device
#8140 to #8159
#8092 to #8095
Axis 8 monitor device
#8160 to #8179
#8096 to #8099
Axis 9 monitor device
#8180 to #8199
#8100 to #8103
Axis 10 monitor device
#8200 to #8219
#8104 to #8107
Axis 11 monitor device
#8220 to #8239
#8108 to #8111
Axis 12 monitor device
#8240 to #8259
#8112 to #8115
Axis 13 monitor device
#8260 to #8279
#8116 to #8119
Axis 14 monitor device
#8280 to #8299
#8120 to #8123
Axis 15 monitor device
#8300 to #8319
#8124 to #8127
Axis 16 monitor device
#8320 to #8339
#8128 to #8131
Axis 17 monitor device
#8340 to #8359
#8132 to #8135
Axis 18 monitor device
#8360 to #8379
#8136 to #8139
Axis 19 monitor device
#8380 to #8399
#8140 to #8143
Axis 20 monitor device
#8400 to #8419
#8144 to #8147
Axis 21 monitor device
#8420 to #8439
#8148 to #8151
Axis 22 monitor device
#8440 to #8459
#8152 to #8155
Axis 23 monitor device
#8460 to #8479
#8156 to #8159
Axis 24 monitor device
#8480 to #8499
#8160 to #8163
Axis 25 monitor device
#8500 to #8519
#8164 to #8167
Axis 26 monitor device
#8520 to #8539
#8168 to #8171
Axis 27 monitor device
#8540 to #8559
#8172 to #8175
Axis 28 monitor device
#8560 to #8579
#8176 to #8179
Axis 29 monitor device
#8580 to #8599
#8180 to #8183
Axis 30 monitor device
#8600 to #8619
#8184 to #8187
Axis 31 monitor device
#8620 to #8639
#8188 to #8191
Axis 32 monitor device
APP - 36
Remark
APPENDICES
Table 4.3 Monitor devices list
Device No.
Q173DSCPU/
Q172DSCPU
(Note)
Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)
Name
Q173HCPU/
Q172HCPU
#8000 + 20n
#8064 + 4n
Servo amplifier type
#8001 + 20n
#8065 + 4n
Motor current
#8002 + 20n
#8003 + 20n
#8066 + 4n
#8067 + 4n
Motor speed
#8004 + 20n
#8005 + 20n
—
Command speed
#8006 + 20n
#8007 + 20n
—
Home position return re-travel value
—
Servo amplifier display servo error code
#8009 + 20n
#8008 + 20n
—
—
Parameter error No.
#8010 + 20n
—
—
Servo status 1
#8011 + 20n
—
—
Servo status 2
#8012 + 20n
—
—
Servo status 3
Remark
New device in
Q173DCPU/Q172DCPU
New device in
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
(Note): "n" in the device No. indicates the numerical value (axis No.1 to 32 : n= 0 to 31) which correspond to axis No.
(b) Motion error history
Table 4.4 Motion registers (Motion error history) list
Device No.
Q173DSCPU/
Q172DSCPU
Name
Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q173HCPU/
(Note)
Q172DCPU(-S1) Q172HCPU
#8640 to #8651
#8000 to #8007
Seventh error information in past
(Oldest error information)
#8652 to #8663
#8008 to #8015
Sixth error information in past
#8664 to #8675
#8016 to #8023
Fifth error information in past
#8676 to #8687
#8024 to #8031
Fourth error information in past
#8688 to #8699
#8032 to #8039
Third error information in past
#8700 to #8711
#8040 to #8047
Second error information in past
#8712 to #8723
#8048 to #8055
First error information in past
#8724 to #8735
#8056 to #8063
Latest error information
Remark
(Note): Unusable for SV43 use.
APP - 37
APPENDICES
Table 4.5 Motion error history list (SV13/SV22)
Device No.
Q173DSCPU/
Q172DSCPU
(Note)
Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)
Name
Q173HCPU/
Q172HCPU
#8640 + 12n
#8000 + 8n
Error Motion SFC program No.
#8641 + 12n
#8001 + 8n
Error type
#8642 + 12n
#8002 + 8n
Error program No.
#8643 + 12n
#8003 + 8n
Error block No./Motion SFC list/Line No./Axis No.
#8644 + 12n
#8004 + 8n
Error code
#8645 + 12n
#8005 + 8n
Error occurrence time (Year/month)
#8646 + 12n
#8006 + 8n
Error occurrence time (Day/hour)
#8647 + 12n
#8007 + 8n
Error occurrence time (Minute/second)
#8648 + 12n
—
Error setting data information
#8649 + 12n
—
Unusable
#8650 + 12n
#8651 + 12n
—
Error setting data
Remark
New device in
Q173DCPU/Q172DCPU
(Note): "n" in the device No. indicates the numerical value (n=0 to 7) which correspond to motion error history.
Table 4.6 Motion error history list (SV43)
Device No.
(Note)
Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)
Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU
#8640 + 12n
—
Name
Remark
Error type
#8641 + 12n
—
Axis No.
#8642 + 12n
—
Error code
#8643 + 12n
—
Program No.
#8644 + 12n
—
Sequence No.
#8645 + 12n
—
Error block No.
#8646 + 12n
—
Error occurrence time (Year/month)
#8647 + 12n
—
Error occurrence time (Day/hour)
#8648 + 12n
—
Error occurrence time (Minute/second)
#8649 + 12n
—
Error setting data information
#8650 + 12n
#8651 + 12n
—
Error setting data
New device in
Q173DCPU/Q172DCPU
(Note) : "n" in the device No. indicates the numerical value (n=0 to 7) which correspond to motion error history.
(c) Product information list device
Table 4.7 Motion register (Product information list device) list
Device No.
Q173DSCPU/
Q172DSCPU
(Note)
Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)
Name
Q173HCPU/
Q172HCPU
#8736 to #8743
—
Operating system software version
#8744 to #8751
—
Motion CPU module serial number
APP - 38
Remark
New device in
Q173D(S)CPU/
Q172D(S)CPU
APPENDICES
(2) Special relays
Table 4.8 Special relay list
Device No.
Q173DSCPU/
Q172DSCPU
Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)
Name
Q173HCPU/
Q172HCPU
Remark
SM60
M9000/M2320
Fuse blown detection
SM53
M9005/M2321
AC/DC DOWN detection
SM52
M9006/M2322
Battery low
SM51
M9007/M2323
Battery low latch
SM1
M9008/M2324
Self-diagnostic error
SM0
M9010/M2325
Diagnostic error
—
M9025/M3136
Clock data set request
SM211
M9026/M2338
Clock data error
SM801
M9028/M3137
Clock data read request
SM400
M9036/M2326
Always ON
SM401
M9037/M2327
Always OFF
—
M9060/M3138
Diagnostic error reset
SM512
M9073/M2329
Motion CPU WDT error
SM500
M9074/M2330
PCPU READY complete
SM501
M9075/M2331
Test mode ON
SM502
M9076/M2332
External forced stop input
SM513
M9077/M2333
Manual pulse generator axis setting error
SM510
M9078/M2334
TEST mode request error
SM516
M9079/M2335
Servo program setting error (SV13/SV22)/
Motion program setting error (SV43)
SM528
M9216/M2345
No.1 CPU MULTR complete
SM529
M9217/M2346
No.2 CPU MULTR complete
SM530
M9218/M2347
No.3 CPU MULTR complete
SM531
M9219/M2348
No.4 CPU MULTR complete
SM240
M9240/M2336
No.1 CPU resetting
SM241
M9241/M2337
No.2 CPU resetting
SM242
M9242/M2338
No.3 CPU resetting
SM243
M9243/M2339
No.4 CPU resetting
SM244
M9244/M2340
No.1 CPU error
SM245
M9245/M2341
No.2 CPU error
SM246
M9246/M2342
No.3 CPU error
SM247
M9247/M2343
No.4 CPU error
SM58
—
SM59
—
Battery low warning
SM220
—
CPU No.1 READY complete
SM221
—
CPU No.2 READY complete
SM222
—
CPU No.3 READY complete
SM223
—
CPU No.4 READY complete
SM503
—
Digital oscilloscope executing
—
Cam data writing
New device in
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
—
External forced stop input ON latch
New device in
Q173D(S)CPU/
Q172D(S)CPU
SM505
—
SM506
Use M2039 for error reset
operation.
Battery low warning latch
APP - 39
New device in
Q173DCPU/Q172DCPU
APPENDICES
Table 4.8 Special relay list (Continued)
Device No.
Q173DSCPU/
Q172DSCPU
Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)
Name
Q173HCPU/
Q172HCPU
SM508
—
Amplifier-less operation status flag
SM526
—
Over heat warning latch
—
Over heat warning
SM532
SM527
—
—
SSCNET
searching flag (Line 1)
SM533
—
—
SSCNET
searching flag (Line 2)
SM561
—
—
Multiple CPU synchronous control initial
complete flag
SM805
—
—
Rapid stop deceleration time setting error invalid
flag
APP - 40
Remark
New device in
Q173DCPU/Q172DCPU
New device in
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
APPENDICES
(3) Special registers
Table 4.9 Special registers list
Device No.
Q173DSCPU/
Q172DSCPU
Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)
Name
Q173HCPU/
Q172HCPU
SD60
D9000
Fuse blown No.
SD53
D9005
AC/DC DOWN counter No.
SD0
D9008
Diagnostic errors
SD1
D9010
Clock time for diagnostic error occurrence
(Year, month)
SD2
D9011
Clock time for diagnostic error occurrence
(Day, hour)
SD3
D9012
Clock time for diagnostic error occurrence
(Minute, second)
SD4
D9013
Error information categories
SD5
D9014
SD6
—
SD7
—
SD8
—
SD9
—
SD10
—
SD11
—
SD12
—
SD13
—
SD14
—
SD15
—
SD16
—
SD17
—
SD18
—
SD19
—
SD20
—
SD21
—
SD22
—
SD23
—
SD24
—
SD25
—
Error common information
New device in
Q173DCPU/Q172DCPU
Error individual information
SD26
—
SD203
D9015
Operating status of CPU
SD520
D9017
Scan time
SD521
D9019
Maximum scan time
SD210
D9025
Clock data (Year, month)
SD211
D9026
Clock data (Day, hour)
SD212
D9027
Clock data (Minute, second)
SD213
D9028
Clock data (Day of week)
—
D9060
Diagnostic error reset error No.
SD395
D9061
Multiple CPU No.
SD508
SD803
D9112
SD510
D9182
SD511
D9183
Remark
SSCNET control (Status)
SSCNET control (Command)
Test mode request error
APP - 41
Use M2039 for error reset
operation.
APPENDICES
Table 4.9 Special registers list (Continued)
Device No.
Q173DSCPU/
Q172DSCPU
Q173DCPU(-S1)/
Q172DCPU(-S1)
Name
Q173HCPU/
Q172HCPU
SD512
D9184
SD513
D9185
SD514
D9186
SD515
D9187
SD522
D9188
Motion operation cycle
SD516
D9189
Error program No.
SD517
D9190
Error item information
SD502
D9191
SD503
D9192
SD504
D9193
SD505
D9194
SD506
D9195
—
D9196
Motion CPU WDT error cause
Manual pulse generator axis setting error
Servo amplifier loading information
Real mode/virtual mode switching error
information
PC link communication error codes
SD523
D9197
Operation cycle of the Motion CPU setting
SD200
D9200
State of switch
—
D9201
State of LED
SD524
—
—
SD550
—
—
SD551
—
—
SD552
—
—
SD553
—
—
System setting error information
—
—
Operation method
—
—
Multiple CPU synchronous control setting status
—
—
SD702
—
SD703
—
SD704
—
SD720
—
SD721
—
SD722
—
—
SD723
—
—
SD804
—
—
SD805
—
—
SD806
—
—
SD807
—
—
SD808
—
—
SD809
—
—
Use 7-segment LED in
Q173D(S)CPU/
Q172D(S)CPU.
New device in
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
Servo parameter write/read request
SD561
SD701
Q173D(S)CPU/
Q172D(S)CPU does not
support PC link
communication.
Maximum Motion operation cycle
SD560
SD700
Remark
Device assignment
New device in
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
New device in
Q173DCPU/Q172DCPU
444µs coasting timer
222µs coasting timer
Servo parameter write/read request
Servo parameter write/read request (2 word)
APP - 42
New device in
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
APPENDICES
(4) Other devices
Table 4.10 Other devices list
Item
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
M2320 to M2399
Internal
relays/
Data
registers
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
Unusable
Device area of 17 axes or more is
M2400 to M3039 usable as user devices in
Q172DSCPU.
M3136 to M3199
Personal computer link
communication error flag
PI-PID switching command
Travel value change registers
Device area of 9 axes or more is
usable as user devices in
Q172DCPU(-S1).
—
M3217 + 20n
—
D9 + 20n (Data shortened to 1 word)
(Note-1)
D16 + 20n, D17 + 20n
D0 to D8191
D800 to D8191
W0 to W1FFF
#0 to #7999
(Note-3)
(Note-2)
X0 to X1FFF
(Note-1)
#0 to #7999
—
X0 to X1FFFF
Y0 to Y1FFF
Y0 to Y1FFF
M0 to M8191
M/L0 to M/L8191
—
M9000 to M9255
B0 to B1FFF
B0 to B1FFF
U \G10000.0 to U \G(10000 + p – 1).F
Optional data monitor
function settable devices
(Note-1)
W0 to W1FFF
F0 to F2047
High-speed reading function
settable devices
—
D759
D9 + 20n
Optional device
(Set for D16 + 20n, D17 + 20n are also usable.)
U \G10000 to U \G(10000 + p – 1)
Indirect setting devices
(Bit devices)
(Note-1)
#8006 + 20n, #8007 + 20n
(Note-1)
(Referring at monitoring)
X0 to X1FFF
Device area of 9 axes or more is
unusable in Q172HCPU.
M2034
SM500
Indirect setting devices
(Word devices)
Device area of 9 axes or more is
unusable as user devices in
Q172HCPU.
Special relay allocated devices
(Command signal)
(Note-1)
PCPU READY complete
Home position return retravel value
Device area of 9 axes or more is
usable as user devices in
Q172DCPU(-S1).
Unusable
M3200 to M3839 Device area of 17 axes or more is
usable as user devices in
D0 to D639
Q172DSCPU.
D640 to D703
Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU
Special relay allocated devices
(Status)
(Note-2)
D0 to D8191
W0 to W1FFF
U \G10000 to U \G(10000 + p – 1)
F0 to F2047
—
D800 to D3069, D3080 to D8191
(Note-2)
W0 to W1FFF
—
D0 to D8191
D0 to D8191
W0 to W1FFF
W0 to W1FFF
#0 to #7999
U \G10000 to U \G(10000 + p – 1)
#0 to #7999
(Note-2)
—
(Note-1): "n" in the above device No. indicates the numerical value (axis No.1 to 32 : n= 0 to 31) which correspond to axis No.
(Note-2): "p" indicates the user setting area points of Multiple CPU high speed transmission area in each CPU.
(Note-3): The range of "PXn+4 to PXn+F" cannot be used (fixed at 0) for the input device (PXn+0 to PXn+F) allocated to the
built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI). (n: First input No.)
APP - 43
APPENDICES
Table 4.10 Other devices list (Continued)
Item
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
X0 to X1FFF
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU
X0 to X1FFF
X0 to X1FFF
(Note-3)
Output device
Y0 to Y1FFF
Y0 to Y1FFF
M0 to M8191
M0 to M8191
—
L0 to L8191
B0 to B1FFF
Limit switch output data
U \G10000.0 to U \G(10000 + p –1).F
Watch data
(Note-2)
D0 to D8191
W0 to W1FFF
W0 to W1FFF
#0 to #8191
U \G10000 to U \G(10000 + p –1)
(Note-2)
D0 to D8191
W0 to W1FFF
W0 to W1FFF
Constant (Hn/Kn)
Forced output bit
#0 to #8191
(Note-4)
U \G10000 to U \G(10000 + p – 1)
Output enable/disable bit
—
D0 to D8191
#0 to #9215
X0 to X1FFF
—
D0 to D8191
#0 to #9215
ON section setting
B0 to B1FFF
(Note-3)
Constant (Hn/Kn)
(Note-2)
X0 to X1FFF
(Note-4)
—
X0 to X1FFF
Y0 to Y1FFF
Y0 to Y1FFF
M0 to M8191
M0 to M8191
—
L0 to L8191
B0 to B1FFF
B0 to B1FFF
F0 to F2047
F0 to F2047
SM0 to SM1999
M9000 to M9255
U \G10000.0 to U \G(10000 + p – 1).F
(Note-2)
—
(Note-1): "n" in the above device No. indicates the numerical value (axis No.1 to 32 : n= 0 to 31) which correspond to axis No.
(Note-2): "p" indicates the user setting area points of Multiple CPU high speed transmission area in each CPU.
(Note-3): The range of "PXn+4 to PXn+F" cannot be used (fixed at 0) for the input device (PXn+0 to PXn+F) allocated to the
built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI). (n: First input No.)
(Note-4): Setting range varies depending on the setting units.
POINT
Refer to Chapter 2 for number of user setting area points of Multiple CPU high
speed transmission area.
APP - 44
APPENDICES
APPENDIX 4.3 Differences of the operating system software
(1) Motion SFC (SV13/SV22)
Item
Code total
(Motion SFC chart
Motion
+ Operation control
SFC
program + Transition)
Text total
capacity
(Operation control +
Transition)
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU
652k bytes
543k bytes
543k bytes
668k bytes
484k bytes
484k bytes
Motion SFC program
executing flag
Motion SFC program event
task
X, Y, M, B, U \G
—
Fixed cycle (0.44ms, 0.88ms,
1.77 ms, 3.55 ms, 7.11 ms,
14.2 ms)
Fixed cycle (0.22ms/0.44ms,
0.88ms, 1.77 ms, 3.55 ms,
7.11 ms, 14.2 ms)
Fixed cycle (0.88ms, 1.77 ms,
3.55 ms, 7.11 ms, 14.2 ms)
Normal task : 1 to 100000
Event task : 1 to 10000
NMI task
: 1 to 10000
—
Operation control/transition
control usable device
(Word device)
D, W, U \G, SD, #, FT
D, W, Special D, #, FT
Operation control/transition
control usable device
(Bit device)
X, PX, Y, PY, M, U \G . , B, F, SM
X, PX, Y, PY, M, L, B, F,
Special M
Task Parameter
Limited count of repeat
control
Motion dedicated
function
Others
Vision system
Instruction dedicated
(Note-2)
function
Data control
CHGV, CHGVS
(Note-1)
,
CHGV, CHGT
CHGV, CHGT
EI, DI, NOP, BMOV, FMOV,
MULTW, MULTR, TO, FROM,
TIME
EI, DI, NOP, BMOV, FMOV,
MULTW, MULTR, TO, FROM,
TIME
CHGT, CHGT2, CHGP
EI, DI, NOP, BMOV, FMOV,
MULTW, MULTR, TO, FROM,
RTO, RFROM, TIME
MVOPEN, MVLOAD, MVTRG, MVPST, MVIN, MVOUT,
MVFIN, MVCLOSE, MVCOM
—
SCL, DSCL
—
Program control
IF - ELSE - IEND, SELECT - CASE - SEND, FOR - NEXT, BREAK
—
Synchronous
control dedicated
(Note-1)
function
CAMRD, CAMWR, CAMWR2,
CAMMK, CAMPSCL
—
—
(Note-1): SV22 advanced synchronous control only.
(Note-2): Unusable in Q173DCPU/Q172DCPU.
APP - 45
APPENDICES
(2) Virtual mode (SV22)
Item
Internal
relay/
Data
register
Q173DSCPU/Q172DSCPU
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
M4640 to M4687
M5440 to M5487
Device area of 9 axes or more is
usable as user devices in the
Q172DCPU.
Unusable as user devices
D1120 to D1239
Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU
Device area of 9 axes or more is
unusable in the Q172HCPU.
Clutch status
Optional device
(Set for M2160 to M2223 are also usable.)
M2160 to M2223
Cam axis command signals
(Cam/ball screw switching
command)
Optional device
(Set for M5488 to M5519 are also usable.)
M5488 to M5519
Smoothing clutch complete
signals
Optional device
(Set for M5520 to M5583 are also usable.)
M5520 to M5583
Real mode axis information
register
SD500, SD501
D790, D791
D0 to D8191
D800 to D3069, D3080 to D8191
W0 to W1FFF
W0 to W1FFF
Indirect setting devices of
mechanical system program
(Word device)
#0 to #7999
U \G10000 to U \G(10000 + p –1)
X0 to X1FFF
(Note-2)
Indirect setting devices of
mechanical system program
(Bit device)
(Note-1)
X0 to X1FFF
Y0 to Y1FFF
M0 to M8191
M/L0 to M/L8191
—
M9000 to M9255
B0 to B1FFF
B0 to B1FFF
U \G10000.0 to U \G(10000 + p –1).F
Cam
Number of pulses
per cam shaft
revolution
Output unit
X0 to X1FFF
Y0 to Y1FFF
F0 to F2047
Virtual servo motor
Command in-position range
—
—
(Note-1)
F0 to F2047
—
1 to 2147483647
1 to 32767
1 to 32767
1 to 1073741824[PLS]/
Word device (D, W, #, U \G)
1 to 1073741824[PLS]
1 to 1073741824[PLS]
mm, inch, PLS, degree
mm, inch, PLS
Speed change ratio of speed
change gear
Permissible droop pulse
value of output module
mm, inch, PLS
Upper limit value : 0 to 65535
Lower limit value : 0 to 65535
Upper limit value : 1 to 10000
Lower limit value : 1 to 10000
1 to 1073741824 [PLS]
1 to 65535[ 100PLS]
(Note-1): "p" indicates user setting area points of Multiple CPU high speed transmission area in each CPU.
(Note-2): The range of "PXn+4 to PXn+F" cannot be used (fixed at 0) for the input device (PXn+0 to PXn+F)
allocated to the built-in interface in Motion CPU (DI). (n: First input No.)
POINT
Refer to Chapter 2 for number of user setting area points of Multiple CPU high
speed transmission area.
APP - 46
APPENDICES
(3) Motion program (SV43)
Item
DNC operation
Internal relay/
Data register
M4320 to M4335
Motion program capacity
Q173DCPU(-S1)/Q172DCPU(-S1)
Q173HCPU/Q172HCPU
None
Provided
Unusable
DNC status
504k bytes
248k bytes
Variable
Device variable
X, Y, M, B, F, D, W, #, U \G
X, Y, M, B, F, D, W, #
Instructions
Jump/repetition
processing
CALL, GOSUB, GOSUBE, IF…GOTO,
IF…THEN…ELSE IF...ELSE...END,
WHILE…DO…BREAK...CONTINUE...END
CALL, GOSUB, GOSUBE, IF…GOTO,
IF…THEN…ELSE...END, WHILE…DO… END
AT (Acceleration): 1 to 65535[ 0.001s]
Instructions symbol
BT (Deceleration): 1 to 65535[ 0.001s]
—
AND (Conditional branch using word device)
—
Multiprogramming depth of IF
statement/WHILE statement
Up to eight levels including IF statement and
While statement
Up to three levels including IF statement and
While statement
BSET, BRST
Bit set and reset for word devices is possible.
—
0 to 32767
(32762 except special M-codes)
0 to 9999
(9993 except special M-codes)
Setting range of M-code
APP - 47
APPENDICES
MEMO
APP - 48
WARRANTY
Please confirm the following product warranty details before using this product.
1. Gratis Warranty Term and Gratis Warranty Range
We will repair any failure or defect hereinafter referred to as "failure" in our FA equipment hereinafter referred to as
the "Product" arisen during warranty period at no charge due to causes for which we are responsible through the
distributor from which you purchased the Product or our service provider. However, we will charge the actual cost
of dispatching our engineer for an on-site repair work on request by customer in Japan or overseas countries. We
are not responsible for any on-site readjustment and/or trial run that may be required after a defective unit is
repaired or replaced.
[Gratis Warranty Term]
The term of warranty for Product is thirty six (36) months after your purchase or delivery of the Product to a place
designated by you or forty two (42) months from the date of manufacture whichever comes first "Warranty Period".
Warranty period for repaired Product cannot exceed beyond the original warranty period before any repair work.
[Gratis Warranty Range]
(1) You are requested to conduct an initial failure diagnosis by yourself, as a general rule.
It can also be carried out by us or our service company upon your request and the actual cost will be charged.
However, it will not be charged if we are responsible for the cause of the failure.
(2) This limited warranty applies only when the condition, method, environment, etc. of use are in compliance with
the terms and conditions and instructions that are set forth in the instruction manual and user manual for the
Product and the caution label affixed to the Product.
(3) Even during the term of warranty, the repair cost will be charged on you in the following cases;
1) A failure caused by your improper storing or handling, carelessness or negligence, etc., and a failure
caused by your hardware or software problem
2) A failure caused by any alteration, etc. to the Product made on your side without our approval
3) A failure which may be regarded as avoidable, if your equipment in which the Product is incorporated is
equipped with a safety device required by applicable laws and has any function or structure considered to
be indispensable according to a common sense in the industry
4) A failure which may be regarded as avoidable if consumable parts designated in the instruction manual, etc.
are duly maintained and replaced
5) Any replacement of consumable parts (battery, fan, etc.)
6) A failure caused by external factors such as inevitable accidents, including without limitation fire and
abnormal fluctuation of voltage, and acts of God, including without limitation earthquake, lightning and
natural disasters
7) A failure generated by an unforeseeable cause with a scientific technology that was not available at the
time of the shipment of the Product from our company
8) Any other failures which we are not responsible for or which you acknowledge we are not responsible for
2. Onerous Repair Term after Discontinuation of Production
(1) We may accept the repair at charge for another seven (7) years after the production of the product is
discontinued.
The announcement of the stop of production for each model can be seen in our Sales and Service, etc.
(2) Please note that the Product (including its spare parts) cannot be ordered after its stop of production.
3. Service in overseas countries
Our regional FA Center in overseas countries will accept the repair work of the Product; However, the terms and
conditions of the repair work may differ depending on each FA Center. Please ask your local FA center for details.
4. Exclusion of Loss in Opportunity and Secondary Loss from Warranty Liability
Whether under or after the term of warranty, we assume no responsibility for any damages arisen from causes for
which we are not responsible, any losses of opportunity and/or profit incurred by you due to a failure of the Product,
any damages, secondary damages or compensation for accidents arisen under a specific circumstance that are
foreseen or unforeseen by our company, any damages to products other than the Product, and also compensation
for any replacement work, readjustment, start-up test run of local machines and the Product and any other
operations conducted by you.
5. Change of Product specifications
Specifications listed in our catalogs, manuals or technical documents may be changed without notice.
6. Precautions for Choosing the Products
(1) For the use of our Motion controller, its applications should be those that may not result in a serious damage
even if any failure or malfunction occurs in Motion controller, and a backup or fail-safe function should operate
on an external system to Motion controller when any failure or malfunction occurs.
(2) Our Motion controller is designed and manufactured as a general purpose product for use at general industries.
Therefore, applications substantially influential on the public interest for such as atomic power plants and other
power plants of electric power companies, and also which require a special quality assurance system, including
applications for railway companies and government or public offices are not recommended, and we assume no
responsibility for any failure caused by these applications when used.
In addition, applications which may be substantially influential to human lives or properties for such as airlines,
medical treatments, railway service, incineration and fuel systems, man-operated material handling equipment,
entertainment machines, safety machines, etc. are not recommended, and we assume no responsibility for any
failure caused by these applications when used.
We will review the acceptability of the abovementioned applications, if you agree not to require a specific quality
for a specific application. Please contact us for consultation.
Microsoft, Windows, Windows NT, and Windows Vista are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in
the United States and other countries.
Ethernet is a trademark of Xerox Corporation.
All other company names and product names used in this manual are trademarks or registered trademarks
of their respective companies.
IB(NA)-0300134-G

Similar documents

×

Report this document